c-decl.c (merge_decls): Use DECL_USER_ALIGN() on olddecl to update the respective...
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / combine.c
blobb812b33ac41da965ed9c346bd1cf7f6cbf2ade58
1 /* Optimize by combining instructions for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1987, 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
3 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GCC.
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22 /* This module is essentially the "combiner" phase of the U. of Arizona
23 Portable Optimizer, but redone to work on our list-structured
24 representation for RTL instead of their string representation.
26 The LOG_LINKS of each insn identify the most recent assignment
27 to each REG used in the insn. It is a list of previous insns,
28 each of which contains a SET for a REG that is used in this insn
29 and not used or set in between. LOG_LINKs never cross basic blocks.
30 They were set up by the preceding pass (lifetime analysis).
32 We try to combine each pair of insns joined by a logical link.
33 We also try to combine triples of insns A, B and C when
34 C has a link back to B and B has a link back to A.
36 LOG_LINKS does not have links for use of the CC0. They don't
37 need to, because the insn that sets the CC0 is always immediately
38 before the insn that tests it. So we always regard a branch
39 insn as having a logical link to the preceding insn. The same is true
40 for an insn explicitly using CC0.
42 We check (with use_crosses_set_p) to avoid combining in such a way
43 as to move a computation to a place where its value would be different.
45 Combination is done by mathematically substituting the previous
46 insn(s) values for the regs they set into the expressions in
47 the later insns that refer to these regs. If the result is a valid insn
48 for our target machine, according to the machine description,
49 we install it, delete the earlier insns, and update the data flow
50 information (LOG_LINKS and REG_NOTES) for what we did.
52 There are a few exceptions where the dataflow information isn't
53 completely updated (however this is only a local issue since it is
54 regenerated before the next pass that uses it):
56 - reg_live_length is not updated
57 - reg_n_refs is not adjusted in the rare case when a register is
58 no longer required in a computation
59 - there are extremely rare cases (see distribute_notes) when a
60 REG_DEAD note is lost
61 - a LOG_LINKS entry that refers to an insn with multiple SETs may be
62 removed because there is no way to know which register it was
63 linking
65 To simplify substitution, we combine only when the earlier insn(s)
66 consist of only a single assignment. To simplify updating afterward,
67 we never combine when a subroutine call appears in the middle.
69 Since we do not represent assignments to CC0 explicitly except when that
70 is all an insn does, there is no LOG_LINKS entry in an insn that uses
71 the condition code for the insn that set the condition code.
72 Fortunately, these two insns must be consecutive.
73 Therefore, every JUMP_INSN is taken to have an implicit logical link
74 to the preceding insn. This is not quite right, since non-jumps can
75 also use the condition code; but in practice such insns would not
76 combine anyway. */
78 #include "config.h"
79 #include "system.h"
80 #include "coretypes.h"
81 #include "tm.h"
82 #include "rtl.h"
83 #include "tree.h"
84 #include "tm_p.h"
85 #include "flags.h"
86 #include "regs.h"
87 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
88 #include "basic-block.h"
89 #include "insn-config.h"
90 #include "function.h"
91 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
92 #include "expr.h"
93 #include "insn-attr.h"
94 #include "recog.h"
95 #include "real.h"
96 #include "toplev.h"
97 #include "target.h"
98 #include "optabs.h"
99 #include "insn-codes.h"
100 #include "rtlhooks-def.h"
101 /* Include output.h for dump_file. */
102 #include "output.h"
103 #include "params.h"
104 #include "timevar.h"
105 #include "tree-pass.h"
106 #include "df.h"
107 #include "cgraph.h"
109 /* Number of attempts to combine instructions in this function. */
111 static int combine_attempts;
113 /* Number of attempts that got as far as substitution in this function. */
115 static int combine_merges;
117 /* Number of instructions combined with added SETs in this function. */
119 static int combine_extras;
121 /* Number of instructions combined in this function. */
123 static int combine_successes;
125 /* Totals over entire compilation. */
127 static int total_attempts, total_merges, total_extras, total_successes;
129 /* combine_instructions may try to replace the right hand side of the
130 second instruction with the value of an associated REG_EQUAL note
131 before throwing it at try_combine. That is problematic when there
132 is a REG_DEAD note for a register used in the old right hand side
133 and can cause distribute_notes to do wrong things. This is the
134 second instruction if it has been so modified, null otherwise. */
136 static rtx i2mod;
138 /* When I2MOD is nonnull, this is a copy of the old right hand side. */
140 static rtx i2mod_old_rhs;
142 /* When I2MOD is nonnull, this is a copy of the new right hand side. */
144 static rtx i2mod_new_rhs;
146 typedef struct reg_stat_struct {
147 /* Record last point of death of (hard or pseudo) register n. */
148 rtx last_death;
150 /* Record last point of modification of (hard or pseudo) register n. */
151 rtx last_set;
153 /* The next group of fields allows the recording of the last value assigned
154 to (hard or pseudo) register n. We use this information to see if an
155 operation being processed is redundant given a prior operation performed
156 on the register. For example, an `and' with a constant is redundant if
157 all the zero bits are already known to be turned off.
159 We use an approach similar to that used by cse, but change it in the
160 following ways:
162 (1) We do not want to reinitialize at each label.
163 (2) It is useful, but not critical, to know the actual value assigned
164 to a register. Often just its form is helpful.
166 Therefore, we maintain the following fields:
168 last_set_value the last value assigned
169 last_set_label records the value of label_tick when the
170 register was assigned
171 last_set_table_tick records the value of label_tick when a
172 value using the register is assigned
173 last_set_invalid set to nonzero when it is not valid
174 to use the value of this register in some
175 register's value
177 To understand the usage of these tables, it is important to understand
178 the distinction between the value in last_set_value being valid and
179 the register being validly contained in some other expression in the
180 table.
182 (The next two parameters are out of date).
184 reg_stat[i].last_set_value is valid if it is nonzero, and either
185 reg_n_sets[i] is 1 or reg_stat[i].last_set_label == label_tick.
187 Register I may validly appear in any expression returned for the value
188 of another register if reg_n_sets[i] is 1. It may also appear in the
189 value for register J if reg_stat[j].last_set_invalid is zero, or
190 reg_stat[i].last_set_label < reg_stat[j].last_set_label.
192 If an expression is found in the table containing a register which may
193 not validly appear in an expression, the register is replaced by
194 something that won't match, (clobber (const_int 0)). */
196 /* Record last value assigned to (hard or pseudo) register n. */
198 rtx last_set_value;
200 /* Record the value of label_tick when an expression involving register n
201 is placed in last_set_value. */
203 int last_set_table_tick;
205 /* Record the value of label_tick when the value for register n is placed in
206 last_set_value. */
208 int last_set_label;
210 /* These fields are maintained in parallel with last_set_value and are
211 used to store the mode in which the register was last set, the bits
212 that were known to be zero when it was last set, and the number of
213 sign bits copies it was known to have when it was last set. */
215 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT last_set_nonzero_bits;
216 char last_set_sign_bit_copies;
217 ENUM_BITFIELD(machine_mode) last_set_mode : 8;
219 /* Set nonzero if references to register n in expressions should not be
220 used. last_set_invalid is set nonzero when this register is being
221 assigned to and last_set_table_tick == label_tick. */
223 char last_set_invalid;
225 /* Some registers that are set more than once and used in more than one
226 basic block are nevertheless always set in similar ways. For example,
227 a QImode register may be loaded from memory in two places on a machine
228 where byte loads zero extend.
230 We record in the following fields if a register has some leading bits
231 that are always equal to the sign bit, and what we know about the
232 nonzero bits of a register, specifically which bits are known to be
233 zero.
235 If an entry is zero, it means that we don't know anything special. */
237 unsigned char sign_bit_copies;
239 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nonzero_bits;
241 /* Record the value of the label_tick when the last truncation
242 happened. The field truncated_to_mode is only valid if
243 truncation_label == label_tick. */
245 int truncation_label;
247 /* Record the last truncation seen for this register. If truncation
248 is not a nop to this mode we might be able to save an explicit
249 truncation if we know that value already contains a truncated
250 value. */
252 ENUM_BITFIELD(machine_mode) truncated_to_mode : 8;
253 } reg_stat_type;
255 DEF_VEC_O(reg_stat_type);
256 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(reg_stat_type,heap);
258 static VEC(reg_stat_type,heap) *reg_stat;
260 /* Record the luid of the last insn that invalidated memory
261 (anything that writes memory, and subroutine calls, but not pushes). */
263 static int mem_last_set;
265 /* Record the luid of the last CALL_INSN
266 so we can tell whether a potential combination crosses any calls. */
268 static int last_call_luid;
270 /* When `subst' is called, this is the insn that is being modified
271 (by combining in a previous insn). The PATTERN of this insn
272 is still the old pattern partially modified and it should not be
273 looked at, but this may be used to examine the successors of the insn
274 to judge whether a simplification is valid. */
276 static rtx subst_insn;
278 /* This is the lowest LUID that `subst' is currently dealing with.
279 get_last_value will not return a value if the register was set at or
280 after this LUID. If not for this mechanism, we could get confused if
281 I2 or I1 in try_combine were an insn that used the old value of a register
282 to obtain a new value. In that case, we might erroneously get the
283 new value of the register when we wanted the old one. */
285 static int subst_low_luid;
287 /* This contains any hard registers that are used in newpat; reg_dead_at_p
288 must consider all these registers to be always live. */
290 static HARD_REG_SET newpat_used_regs;
292 /* This is an insn to which a LOG_LINKS entry has been added. If this
293 insn is the earlier than I2 or I3, combine should rescan starting at
294 that location. */
296 static rtx added_links_insn;
298 /* Basic block in which we are performing combines. */
299 static basic_block this_basic_block;
302 /* Length of the currently allocated uid_insn_cost array. */
304 static int max_uid_known;
306 /* The following array records the insn_rtx_cost for every insn
307 in the instruction stream. */
309 static int *uid_insn_cost;
311 /* The following array records the LOG_LINKS for every insn in the
312 instruction stream as an INSN_LIST rtx. */
314 static rtx *uid_log_links;
316 #define INSN_COST(INSN) (uid_insn_cost[INSN_UID (INSN)])
317 #define LOG_LINKS(INSN) (uid_log_links[INSN_UID (INSN)])
319 /* Incremented for each basic block. */
321 static int label_tick;
323 /* Reset to label_tick for each label. */
325 static int label_tick_ebb_start;
327 /* Mode used to compute significance in reg_stat[].nonzero_bits. It is the
328 largest integer mode that can fit in HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT. */
330 static enum machine_mode nonzero_bits_mode;
332 /* Nonzero when reg_stat[].nonzero_bits and reg_stat[].sign_bit_copies can
333 be safely used. It is zero while computing them and after combine has
334 completed. This former test prevents propagating values based on
335 previously set values, which can be incorrect if a variable is modified
336 in a loop. */
338 static int nonzero_sign_valid;
341 /* Record one modification to rtl structure
342 to be undone by storing old_contents into *where. */
344 struct undo
346 struct undo *next;
347 enum { UNDO_RTX, UNDO_INT, UNDO_MODE } kind;
348 union { rtx r; int i; enum machine_mode m; } old_contents;
349 union { rtx *r; int *i; } where;
352 /* Record a bunch of changes to be undone, up to MAX_UNDO of them.
353 num_undo says how many are currently recorded.
355 other_insn is nonzero if we have modified some other insn in the process
356 of working on subst_insn. It must be verified too. */
358 struct undobuf
360 struct undo *undos;
361 struct undo *frees;
362 rtx other_insn;
365 static struct undobuf undobuf;
367 /* Number of times the pseudo being substituted for
368 was found and replaced. */
370 static int n_occurrences;
372 static rtx reg_nonzero_bits_for_combine (const_rtx, enum machine_mode, const_rtx,
373 enum machine_mode,
374 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
375 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *);
376 static rtx reg_num_sign_bit_copies_for_combine (const_rtx, enum machine_mode, const_rtx,
377 enum machine_mode,
378 unsigned int, unsigned int *);
379 static void do_SUBST (rtx *, rtx);
380 static void do_SUBST_INT (int *, int);
381 static void init_reg_last (void);
382 static void setup_incoming_promotions (rtx);
383 static void set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
384 static int cant_combine_insn_p (rtx);
385 static int can_combine_p (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx *, rtx *);
386 static int combinable_i3pat (rtx, rtx *, rtx, rtx, int, rtx *);
387 static int contains_muldiv (rtx);
388 static rtx try_combine (rtx, rtx, rtx, int *);
389 static void undo_all (void);
390 static void undo_commit (void);
391 static rtx *find_split_point (rtx *, rtx);
392 static rtx subst (rtx, rtx, rtx, int, int);
393 static rtx combine_simplify_rtx (rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
394 static rtx simplify_if_then_else (rtx);
395 static rtx simplify_set (rtx);
396 static rtx simplify_logical (rtx);
397 static rtx expand_compound_operation (rtx);
398 static const_rtx expand_field_assignment (const_rtx);
399 static rtx make_extraction (enum machine_mode, rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
400 rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, int, int, int);
401 static rtx extract_left_shift (rtx, int);
402 static rtx make_compound_operation (rtx, enum rtx_code);
403 static int get_pos_from_mask (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
404 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *);
405 static rtx canon_reg_for_combine (rtx, rtx);
406 static rtx force_to_mode (rtx, enum machine_mode,
407 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, int);
408 static rtx if_then_else_cond (rtx, rtx *, rtx *);
409 static rtx known_cond (rtx, enum rtx_code, rtx, rtx);
410 static int rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (rtx, rtx);
411 static rtx make_field_assignment (rtx);
412 static rtx apply_distributive_law (rtx);
413 static rtx distribute_and_simplify_rtx (rtx, int);
414 static rtx simplify_and_const_int_1 (enum machine_mode, rtx,
415 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
416 static rtx simplify_and_const_int (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx,
417 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
418 static int merge_outer_ops (enum rtx_code *, HOST_WIDE_INT *, enum rtx_code,
419 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode, int *);
420 static rtx simplify_shift_const_1 (enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode, rtx, int);
421 static rtx simplify_shift_const (rtx, enum rtx_code, enum machine_mode, rtx,
422 int);
423 static int recog_for_combine (rtx *, rtx, rtx *);
424 static rtx gen_lowpart_for_combine (enum machine_mode, rtx);
425 static enum rtx_code simplify_comparison (enum rtx_code, rtx *, rtx *);
426 static void update_table_tick (rtx);
427 static void record_value_for_reg (rtx, rtx, rtx);
428 static void check_conversions (rtx, rtx);
429 static void record_dead_and_set_regs_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
430 static void record_dead_and_set_regs (rtx);
431 static int get_last_value_validate (rtx *, rtx, int, int);
432 static rtx get_last_value (const_rtx);
433 static int use_crosses_set_p (const_rtx, int);
434 static void reg_dead_at_p_1 (rtx, const_rtx, void *);
435 static int reg_dead_at_p (rtx, rtx);
436 static void move_deaths (rtx, rtx, int, rtx, rtx *);
437 static int reg_bitfield_target_p (rtx, rtx);
438 static void distribute_notes (rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx, rtx);
439 static void distribute_links (rtx);
440 static void mark_used_regs_combine (rtx);
441 static void record_promoted_value (rtx, rtx);
442 static int unmentioned_reg_p_1 (rtx *, void *);
443 static bool unmentioned_reg_p (rtx, rtx);
444 static void record_truncated_value (rtx);
445 static bool reg_truncated_to_mode (enum machine_mode, const_rtx);
446 static rtx gen_lowpart_or_truncate (enum machine_mode, rtx);
449 /* It is not safe to use ordinary gen_lowpart in combine.
450 See comments in gen_lowpart_for_combine. */
451 #undef RTL_HOOKS_GEN_LOWPART
452 #define RTL_HOOKS_GEN_LOWPART gen_lowpart_for_combine
454 /* Our implementation of gen_lowpart never emits a new pseudo. */
455 #undef RTL_HOOKS_GEN_LOWPART_NO_EMIT
456 #define RTL_HOOKS_GEN_LOWPART_NO_EMIT gen_lowpart_for_combine
458 #undef RTL_HOOKS_REG_NONZERO_REG_BITS
459 #define RTL_HOOKS_REG_NONZERO_REG_BITS reg_nonzero_bits_for_combine
461 #undef RTL_HOOKS_REG_NUM_SIGN_BIT_COPIES
462 #define RTL_HOOKS_REG_NUM_SIGN_BIT_COPIES reg_num_sign_bit_copies_for_combine
464 #undef RTL_HOOKS_REG_TRUNCATED_TO_MODE
465 #define RTL_HOOKS_REG_TRUNCATED_TO_MODE reg_truncated_to_mode
467 static const struct rtl_hooks combine_rtl_hooks = RTL_HOOKS_INITIALIZER;
470 /* Try to split PATTERN found in INSN. This returns NULL_RTX if
471 PATTERN can not be split. Otherwise, it returns an insn sequence.
472 This is a wrapper around split_insns which ensures that the
473 reg_stat vector is made larger if the splitter creates a new
474 register. */
476 static rtx
477 combine_split_insns (rtx pattern, rtx insn)
479 rtx ret;
480 unsigned int nregs;
482 ret = split_insns (pattern, insn);
483 nregs = max_reg_num ();
484 if (nregs > VEC_length (reg_stat_type, reg_stat))
485 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (reg_stat_type, heap, reg_stat, nregs);
486 return ret;
489 /* This is used by find_single_use to locate an rtx in LOC that
490 contains exactly one use of DEST, which is typically either a REG
491 or CC0. It returns a pointer to the innermost rtx expression
492 containing DEST. Appearances of DEST that are being used to
493 totally replace it are not counted. */
495 static rtx *
496 find_single_use_1 (rtx dest, rtx *loc)
498 rtx x = *loc;
499 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
500 rtx *result = NULL;
501 rtx *this_result;
502 int i;
503 const char *fmt;
505 switch (code)
507 case CONST_INT:
508 case CONST:
509 case LABEL_REF:
510 case SYMBOL_REF:
511 case CONST_DOUBLE:
512 case CONST_VECTOR:
513 case CLOBBER:
514 return 0;
516 case SET:
517 /* If the destination is anything other than CC0, PC, a REG or a SUBREG
518 of a REG that occupies all of the REG, the insn uses DEST if
519 it is mentioned in the destination or the source. Otherwise, we
520 need just check the source. */
521 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) != CC0
522 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) != PC
523 && !REG_P (SET_DEST (x))
524 && ! (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
525 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x)))
526 && (((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x))))
527 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
528 == ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)))
529 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD))))
530 break;
532 return find_single_use_1 (dest, &SET_SRC (x));
534 case MEM:
535 case SUBREG:
536 return find_single_use_1 (dest, &XEXP (x, 0));
538 default:
539 break;
542 /* If it wasn't one of the common cases above, check each expression and
543 vector of this code. Look for a unique usage of DEST. */
545 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
546 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
548 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
550 if (dest == XEXP (x, i)
551 || (REG_P (dest) && REG_P (XEXP (x, i))
552 && REGNO (dest) == REGNO (XEXP (x, i))))
553 this_result = loc;
554 else
555 this_result = find_single_use_1 (dest, &XEXP (x, i));
557 if (result == NULL)
558 result = this_result;
559 else if (this_result)
560 /* Duplicate usage. */
561 return NULL;
563 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
565 int j;
567 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
569 if (XVECEXP (x, i, j) == dest
570 || (REG_P (dest)
571 && REG_P (XVECEXP (x, i, j))
572 && REGNO (XVECEXP (x, i, j)) == REGNO (dest)))
573 this_result = loc;
574 else
575 this_result = find_single_use_1 (dest, &XVECEXP (x, i, j));
577 if (result == NULL)
578 result = this_result;
579 else if (this_result)
580 return NULL;
585 return result;
589 /* See if DEST, produced in INSN, is used only a single time in the
590 sequel. If so, return a pointer to the innermost rtx expression in which
591 it is used.
593 If PLOC is nonzero, *PLOC is set to the insn containing the single use.
595 If DEST is cc0_rtx, we look only at the next insn. In that case, we don't
596 care about REG_DEAD notes or LOG_LINKS.
598 Otherwise, we find the single use by finding an insn that has a
599 LOG_LINKS pointing at INSN and has a REG_DEAD note for DEST. If DEST is
600 only referenced once in that insn, we know that it must be the first
601 and last insn referencing DEST. */
603 static rtx *
604 find_single_use (rtx dest, rtx insn, rtx *ploc)
606 rtx next;
607 rtx *result;
608 rtx link;
610 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
611 if (dest == cc0_rtx)
613 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
614 if (next == 0
615 || (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (next) && !JUMP_P (next)))
616 return 0;
618 result = find_single_use_1 (dest, &PATTERN (next));
619 if (result && ploc)
620 *ploc = next;
621 return result;
623 #endif
625 if (!REG_P (dest))
626 return 0;
628 for (next = next_nonnote_insn (insn);
629 next != 0 && !LABEL_P (next);
630 next = next_nonnote_insn (next))
631 if (INSN_P (next) && dead_or_set_p (next, dest))
633 for (link = LOG_LINKS (next); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
634 if (XEXP (link, 0) == insn)
635 break;
637 if (link)
639 result = find_single_use_1 (dest, &PATTERN (next));
640 if (ploc)
641 *ploc = next;
642 return result;
646 return 0;
649 /* Substitute NEWVAL, an rtx expression, into INTO, a place in some
650 insn. The substitution can be undone by undo_all. If INTO is already
651 set to NEWVAL, do not record this change. Because computing NEWVAL might
652 also call SUBST, we have to compute it before we put anything into
653 the undo table. */
655 static void
656 do_SUBST (rtx *into, rtx newval)
658 struct undo *buf;
659 rtx oldval = *into;
661 if (oldval == newval)
662 return;
664 /* We'd like to catch as many invalid transformations here as
665 possible. Unfortunately, there are way too many mode changes
666 that are perfectly valid, so we'd waste too much effort for
667 little gain doing the checks here. Focus on catching invalid
668 transformations involving integer constants. */
669 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (oldval)) == MODE_INT
670 && GET_CODE (newval) == CONST_INT)
672 /* Sanity check that we're replacing oldval with a CONST_INT
673 that is a valid sign-extension for the original mode. */
674 gcc_assert (INTVAL (newval)
675 == trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (newval), GET_MODE (oldval)));
677 /* Replacing the operand of a SUBREG or a ZERO_EXTEND with a
678 CONST_INT is not valid, because after the replacement, the
679 original mode would be gone. Unfortunately, we can't tell
680 when do_SUBST is called to replace the operand thereof, so we
681 perform this test on oldval instead, checking whether an
682 invalid replacement took place before we got here. */
683 gcc_assert (!(GET_CODE (oldval) == SUBREG
684 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (oldval)) == CONST_INT));
685 gcc_assert (!(GET_CODE (oldval) == ZERO_EXTEND
686 && GET_CODE (XEXP (oldval, 0)) == CONST_INT));
689 if (undobuf.frees)
690 buf = undobuf.frees, undobuf.frees = buf->next;
691 else
692 buf = XNEW (struct undo);
694 buf->kind = UNDO_RTX;
695 buf->where.r = into;
696 buf->old_contents.r = oldval;
697 *into = newval;
699 buf->next = undobuf.undos, undobuf.undos = buf;
702 #define SUBST(INTO, NEWVAL) do_SUBST(&(INTO), (NEWVAL))
704 /* Similar to SUBST, but NEWVAL is an int expression. Note that substitution
705 for the value of a HOST_WIDE_INT value (including CONST_INT) is
706 not safe. */
708 static void
709 do_SUBST_INT (int *into, int newval)
711 struct undo *buf;
712 int oldval = *into;
714 if (oldval == newval)
715 return;
717 if (undobuf.frees)
718 buf = undobuf.frees, undobuf.frees = buf->next;
719 else
720 buf = XNEW (struct undo);
722 buf->kind = UNDO_INT;
723 buf->where.i = into;
724 buf->old_contents.i = oldval;
725 *into = newval;
727 buf->next = undobuf.undos, undobuf.undos = buf;
730 #define SUBST_INT(INTO, NEWVAL) do_SUBST_INT(&(INTO), (NEWVAL))
732 /* Similar to SUBST, but just substitute the mode. This is used when
733 changing the mode of a pseudo-register, so that any other
734 references to the entry in the regno_reg_rtx array will change as
735 well. */
737 static void
738 do_SUBST_MODE (rtx *into, enum machine_mode newval)
740 struct undo *buf;
741 enum machine_mode oldval = GET_MODE (*into);
743 if (oldval == newval)
744 return;
746 if (undobuf.frees)
747 buf = undobuf.frees, undobuf.frees = buf->next;
748 else
749 buf = XNEW (struct undo);
751 buf->kind = UNDO_MODE;
752 buf->where.r = into;
753 buf->old_contents.m = oldval;
754 adjust_reg_mode (*into, newval);
756 buf->next = undobuf.undos, undobuf.undos = buf;
759 #define SUBST_MODE(INTO, NEWVAL) do_SUBST_MODE(&(INTO), (NEWVAL))
761 /* Subroutine of try_combine. Determine whether the combine replacement
762 patterns NEWPAT, NEWI2PAT and NEWOTHERPAT are cheaper according to
763 insn_rtx_cost that the original instruction sequence I1, I2, I3 and
764 undobuf.other_insn. Note that I1 and/or NEWI2PAT may be NULL_RTX.
765 NEWOTHERPAT and undobuf.other_insn may also both be NULL_RTX. This
766 function returns false, if the costs of all instructions can be
767 estimated, and the replacements are more expensive than the original
768 sequence. */
770 static bool
771 combine_validate_cost (rtx i1, rtx i2, rtx i3, rtx newpat, rtx newi2pat,
772 rtx newotherpat)
774 int i1_cost, i2_cost, i3_cost;
775 int new_i2_cost, new_i3_cost;
776 int old_cost, new_cost;
778 /* Lookup the original insn_rtx_costs. */
779 i2_cost = INSN_COST (i2);
780 i3_cost = INSN_COST (i3);
782 if (i1)
784 i1_cost = INSN_COST (i1);
785 old_cost = (i1_cost > 0 && i2_cost > 0 && i3_cost > 0)
786 ? i1_cost + i2_cost + i3_cost : 0;
788 else
790 old_cost = (i2_cost > 0 && i3_cost > 0) ? i2_cost + i3_cost : 0;
791 i1_cost = 0;
794 /* Calculate the replacement insn_rtx_costs. */
795 new_i3_cost = insn_rtx_cost (newpat);
796 if (newi2pat)
798 new_i2_cost = insn_rtx_cost (newi2pat);
799 new_cost = (new_i2_cost > 0 && new_i3_cost > 0)
800 ? new_i2_cost + new_i3_cost : 0;
802 else
804 new_cost = new_i3_cost;
805 new_i2_cost = 0;
808 if (undobuf.other_insn)
810 int old_other_cost, new_other_cost;
812 old_other_cost = INSN_COST (undobuf.other_insn);
813 new_other_cost = insn_rtx_cost (newotherpat);
814 if (old_other_cost > 0 && new_other_cost > 0)
816 old_cost += old_other_cost;
817 new_cost += new_other_cost;
819 else
820 old_cost = 0;
823 /* Disallow this recombination if both new_cost and old_cost are
824 greater than zero, and new_cost is greater than old cost. */
825 if (old_cost > 0
826 && new_cost > old_cost)
828 if (dump_file)
830 if (i1)
832 fprintf (dump_file,
833 "rejecting combination of insns %d, %d and %d\n",
834 INSN_UID (i1), INSN_UID (i2), INSN_UID (i3));
835 fprintf (dump_file, "original costs %d + %d + %d = %d\n",
836 i1_cost, i2_cost, i3_cost, old_cost);
838 else
840 fprintf (dump_file,
841 "rejecting combination of insns %d and %d\n",
842 INSN_UID (i2), INSN_UID (i3));
843 fprintf (dump_file, "original costs %d + %d = %d\n",
844 i2_cost, i3_cost, old_cost);
847 if (newi2pat)
849 fprintf (dump_file, "replacement costs %d + %d = %d\n",
850 new_i2_cost, new_i3_cost, new_cost);
852 else
853 fprintf (dump_file, "replacement cost %d\n", new_cost);
856 return false;
859 /* Update the uid_insn_cost array with the replacement costs. */
860 INSN_COST (i2) = new_i2_cost;
861 INSN_COST (i3) = new_i3_cost;
862 if (i1)
863 INSN_COST (i1) = 0;
865 return true;
869 /* Delete any insns that copy a register to itself. */
871 static void
872 delete_noop_moves (void)
874 rtx insn, next;
875 basic_block bb;
877 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
879 for (insn = BB_HEAD (bb); insn != NEXT_INSN (BB_END (bb)); insn = next)
881 next = NEXT_INSN (insn);
882 if (INSN_P (insn) && noop_move_p (insn))
884 rtx note;
886 /* If we're about to remove the first insn of a libcall
887 then move the libcall note to the next real insn and
888 update the retval note. */
889 if ((note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX))
890 && XEXP (note, 0) != insn)
892 rtx new_libcall_insn = next_real_insn (insn);
893 rtx retval_note = find_reg_note (XEXP (note, 0),
894 REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX);
895 REG_NOTES (new_libcall_insn)
896 = gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (REG_LIBCALL, XEXP (note, 0),
897 REG_NOTES (new_libcall_insn));
898 XEXP (retval_note, 0) = new_libcall_insn;
901 if (dump_file)
902 fprintf (dump_file, "deleting noop move %d\n", INSN_UID (insn));
904 delete_insn_and_edges (insn);
911 /* Fill in log links field for all insns. */
913 static void
914 create_log_links (void)
916 basic_block bb;
917 rtx *next_use, insn;
918 struct df_ref **def_vec, **use_vec;
920 next_use = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_reg_num ());
922 /* Pass through each block from the end, recording the uses of each
923 register and establishing log links when def is encountered.
924 Note that we do not clear next_use array in order to save time,
925 so we have to test whether the use is in the same basic block as def.
927 There are a few cases below when we do not consider the definition or
928 usage -- these are taken from original flow.c did. Don't ask me why it is
929 done this way; I don't know and if it works, I don't want to know. */
931 FOR_EACH_BB (bb)
933 FOR_BB_INSNS_REVERSE (bb, insn)
935 if (!INSN_P (insn))
936 continue;
938 /* Log links are created only once. */
939 gcc_assert (!LOG_LINKS (insn));
941 for (def_vec = DF_INSN_DEFS (insn); *def_vec; def_vec++)
943 struct df_ref *def = *def_vec;
944 int regno = DF_REF_REGNO (def);
945 rtx use_insn;
947 if (!next_use[regno])
948 continue;
950 /* Do not consider if it is pre/post modification in MEM. */
951 if (DF_REF_FLAGS (def) & DF_REF_PRE_POST_MODIFY)
952 continue;
954 /* Do not make the log link for frame pointer. */
955 if ((regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
956 && (! reload_completed || frame_pointer_needed))
957 #if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
958 || (regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
959 && (! reload_completed || frame_pointer_needed))
960 #endif
961 #if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
962 || (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && fixed_regs[regno])
963 #endif
965 continue;
967 use_insn = next_use[regno];
968 if (BLOCK_FOR_INSN (use_insn) == bb)
970 /* flow.c claimed:
972 We don't build a LOG_LINK for hard registers contained
973 in ASM_OPERANDs. If these registers get replaced,
974 we might wind up changing the semantics of the insn,
975 even if reload can make what appear to be valid
976 assignments later. */
977 if (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
978 || asm_noperands (PATTERN (use_insn)) < 0)
979 LOG_LINKS (use_insn) =
980 alloc_INSN_LIST (insn, LOG_LINKS (use_insn));
982 next_use[regno] = NULL_RTX;
985 for (use_vec = DF_INSN_USES (insn); *use_vec; use_vec++)
987 struct df_ref *use = *use_vec;
988 int regno = DF_REF_REGNO (use);
990 /* Do not consider the usage of the stack pointer
991 by function call. */
992 if (DF_REF_FLAGS (use) & DF_REF_CALL_STACK_USAGE)
993 continue;
995 next_use[regno] = insn;
1000 free (next_use);
1003 /* Clear LOG_LINKS fields of insns. */
1005 static void
1006 clear_log_links (void)
1008 rtx insn;
1010 for (insn = get_insns (); insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1011 if (INSN_P (insn))
1012 free_INSN_LIST_list (&LOG_LINKS (insn));
1018 /* Main entry point for combiner. F is the first insn of the function.
1019 NREGS is the first unused pseudo-reg number.
1021 Return nonzero if the combiner has turned an indirect jump
1022 instruction into a direct jump. */
1023 static int
1024 combine_instructions (rtx f, unsigned int nregs)
1026 rtx insn, next;
1027 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
1028 rtx prev;
1029 #endif
1030 rtx links, nextlinks;
1031 rtx first;
1033 int new_direct_jump_p = 0;
1035 for (first = f; first && !INSN_P (first); )
1036 first = NEXT_INSN (first);
1037 if (!first)
1038 return 0;
1040 combine_attempts = 0;
1041 combine_merges = 0;
1042 combine_extras = 0;
1043 combine_successes = 0;
1045 rtl_hooks = combine_rtl_hooks;
1047 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (reg_stat_type, heap, reg_stat, nregs);
1049 init_recog_no_volatile ();
1051 /* Allocate array for insn info. */
1052 max_uid_known = get_max_uid ();
1053 uid_log_links = XCNEWVEC (rtx, max_uid_known + 1);
1054 uid_insn_cost = XCNEWVEC (int, max_uid_known + 1);
1056 nonzero_bits_mode = mode_for_size (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, MODE_INT, 0);
1058 /* Don't use reg_stat[].nonzero_bits when computing it. This can cause
1059 problems when, for example, we have j <<= 1 in a loop. */
1061 nonzero_sign_valid = 0;
1063 /* Scan all SETs and see if we can deduce anything about what
1064 bits are known to be zero for some registers and how many copies
1065 of the sign bit are known to exist for those registers.
1067 Also set any known values so that we can use it while searching
1068 for what bits are known to be set. */
1070 label_tick = label_tick_ebb_start = 1;
1072 setup_incoming_promotions (first);
1074 create_log_links ();
1075 FOR_EACH_BB (this_basic_block)
1077 last_call_luid = 0;
1078 mem_last_set = -1;
1079 label_tick++;
1080 FOR_BB_INSNS (this_basic_block, insn)
1081 if (INSN_P (insn) && BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn))
1083 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (insn);
1084 subst_insn = insn;
1086 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies,
1087 insn);
1088 record_dead_and_set_regs (insn);
1090 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1091 for (links = REG_NOTES (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1092 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (links) == REG_INC)
1093 set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies (XEXP (links, 0), NULL_RTX,
1094 insn);
1095 #endif
1097 /* Record the current insn_rtx_cost of this instruction. */
1098 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn))
1099 INSN_COST (insn) = insn_rtx_cost (PATTERN (insn));
1100 if (dump_file)
1101 fprintf(dump_file, "insn_cost %d: %d\n",
1102 INSN_UID (insn), INSN_COST (insn));
1104 else if (LABEL_P (insn))
1105 label_tick_ebb_start = label_tick;
1108 nonzero_sign_valid = 1;
1110 /* Now scan all the insns in forward order. */
1112 label_tick = label_tick_ebb_start = 1;
1113 init_reg_last ();
1114 setup_incoming_promotions (first);
1116 FOR_EACH_BB (this_basic_block)
1118 last_call_luid = 0;
1119 mem_last_set = -1;
1120 label_tick++;
1121 for (insn = BB_HEAD (this_basic_block);
1122 insn != NEXT_INSN (BB_END (this_basic_block));
1123 insn = next ? next : NEXT_INSN (insn))
1125 next = 0;
1126 if (INSN_P (insn))
1128 /* See if we know about function return values before this
1129 insn based upon SUBREG flags. */
1130 check_conversions (insn, PATTERN (insn));
1132 /* Try this insn with each insn it links back to. */
1134 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1135 if ((next = try_combine (insn, XEXP (links, 0),
1136 NULL_RTX, &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1137 goto retry;
1139 /* Try each sequence of three linked insns ending with this one. */
1141 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1143 rtx link = XEXP (links, 0);
1145 /* If the linked insn has been replaced by a note, then there
1146 is no point in pursuing this chain any further. */
1147 if (NOTE_P (link))
1148 continue;
1150 for (nextlinks = LOG_LINKS (link);
1151 nextlinks;
1152 nextlinks = XEXP (nextlinks, 1))
1153 if ((next = try_combine (insn, link,
1154 XEXP (nextlinks, 0),
1155 &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1156 goto retry;
1159 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
1160 /* Try to combine a jump insn that uses CC0
1161 with a preceding insn that sets CC0, and maybe with its
1162 logical predecessor as well.
1163 This is how we make decrement-and-branch insns.
1164 We need this special code because data flow connections
1165 via CC0 do not get entered in LOG_LINKS. */
1167 if (JUMP_P (insn)
1168 && (prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
1169 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
1170 && sets_cc0_p (PATTERN (prev)))
1172 if ((next = try_combine (insn, prev,
1173 NULL_RTX, &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1174 goto retry;
1176 for (nextlinks = LOG_LINKS (prev); nextlinks;
1177 nextlinks = XEXP (nextlinks, 1))
1178 if ((next = try_combine (insn, prev,
1179 XEXP (nextlinks, 0),
1180 &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1181 goto retry;
1184 /* Do the same for an insn that explicitly references CC0. */
1185 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn)
1186 && (prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn)) != 0
1187 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
1188 && sets_cc0_p (PATTERN (prev))
1189 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET
1190 && reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, SET_SRC (PATTERN (insn))))
1192 if ((next = try_combine (insn, prev,
1193 NULL_RTX, &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1194 goto retry;
1196 for (nextlinks = LOG_LINKS (prev); nextlinks;
1197 nextlinks = XEXP (nextlinks, 1))
1198 if ((next = try_combine (insn, prev,
1199 XEXP (nextlinks, 0),
1200 &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1201 goto retry;
1204 /* Finally, see if any of the insns that this insn links to
1205 explicitly references CC0. If so, try this insn, that insn,
1206 and its predecessor if it sets CC0. */
1207 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1208 if (NONJUMP_INSN_P (XEXP (links, 0))
1209 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (XEXP (links, 0))) == SET
1210 && reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, SET_SRC (PATTERN (XEXP (links, 0))))
1211 && (prev = prev_nonnote_insn (XEXP (links, 0))) != 0
1212 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
1213 && sets_cc0_p (PATTERN (prev))
1214 && (next = try_combine (insn, XEXP (links, 0),
1215 prev, &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1216 goto retry;
1217 #endif
1219 /* Try combining an insn with two different insns whose results it
1220 uses. */
1221 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1222 for (nextlinks = XEXP (links, 1); nextlinks;
1223 nextlinks = XEXP (nextlinks, 1))
1224 if ((next = try_combine (insn, XEXP (links, 0),
1225 XEXP (nextlinks, 0),
1226 &new_direct_jump_p)) != 0)
1227 goto retry;
1229 /* Try this insn with each REG_EQUAL note it links back to. */
1230 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links; links = XEXP (links, 1))
1232 rtx set, note;
1233 rtx temp = XEXP (links, 0);
1234 if ((set = single_set (temp)) != 0
1235 && (note = find_reg_equal_equiv_note (temp)) != 0
1236 && (note = XEXP (note, 0), GET_CODE (note)) != EXPR_LIST
1237 /* Avoid using a register that may already been marked
1238 dead by an earlier instruction. */
1239 && ! unmentioned_reg_p (note, SET_SRC (set))
1240 && (GET_MODE (note) == VOIDmode
1241 ? SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
1242 : GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)) == GET_MODE (note)))
1244 /* Temporarily replace the set's source with the
1245 contents of the REG_EQUAL note. The insn will
1246 be deleted or recognized by try_combine. */
1247 rtx orig = SET_SRC (set);
1248 SET_SRC (set) = note;
1249 i2mod = temp;
1250 i2mod_old_rhs = copy_rtx (orig);
1251 i2mod_new_rhs = copy_rtx (note);
1252 next = try_combine (insn, i2mod, NULL_RTX,
1253 &new_direct_jump_p);
1254 i2mod = NULL_RTX;
1255 if (next)
1256 goto retry;
1257 SET_SRC (set) = orig;
1261 if (!NOTE_P (insn))
1262 record_dead_and_set_regs (insn);
1264 retry:
1267 else if (LABEL_P (insn))
1268 label_tick_ebb_start = label_tick;
1272 clear_log_links ();
1273 clear_bb_flags ();
1274 new_direct_jump_p |= purge_all_dead_edges ();
1275 delete_noop_moves ();
1277 /* Clean up. */
1278 free (uid_log_links);
1279 free (uid_insn_cost);
1280 VEC_free (reg_stat_type, heap, reg_stat);
1283 struct undo *undo, *next;
1284 for (undo = undobuf.frees; undo; undo = next)
1286 next = undo->next;
1287 free (undo);
1289 undobuf.frees = 0;
1292 total_attempts += combine_attempts;
1293 total_merges += combine_merges;
1294 total_extras += combine_extras;
1295 total_successes += combine_successes;
1297 nonzero_sign_valid = 0;
1298 rtl_hooks = general_rtl_hooks;
1300 /* Make recognizer allow volatile MEMs again. */
1301 init_recog ();
1303 return new_direct_jump_p;
1306 /* Wipe the last_xxx fields of reg_stat in preparation for another pass. */
1308 static void
1309 init_reg_last (void)
1311 unsigned int i;
1312 reg_stat_type *p;
1314 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, i, p); ++i)
1315 memset (p, 0, offsetof (reg_stat_type, sign_bit_copies));
1318 /* Set up any promoted values for incoming argument registers. */
1320 static void
1321 setup_incoming_promotions (rtx first)
1323 tree arg;
1324 bool strictly_local = false;
1326 if (!targetm.calls.promote_function_args (TREE_TYPE (cfun->decl)))
1327 return;
1329 for (arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (current_function_decl); arg;
1330 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1332 rtx reg = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (arg);
1333 int uns1, uns3;
1334 enum machine_mode mode1, mode2, mode3, mode4;
1336 /* Only continue if the incoming argument is in a register. */
1337 if (!REG_P (reg))
1338 continue;
1340 /* Determine, if possible, whether all call sites of the current
1341 function lie within the current compilation unit. (This does
1342 take into account the exporting of a function via taking its
1343 address, and so forth.) */
1344 if (flag_unit_at_a_time)
1345 strictly_local = cgraph_local_info (current_function_decl)->local;
1347 /* The mode and signedness of the argument before any promotions happen
1348 (equal to the mode of the pseudo holding it at that stage). */
1349 mode1 = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (arg));
1350 uns1 = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (arg));
1352 /* The mode and signedness of the argument after any source language and
1353 TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES-driven promotions. */
1354 mode2 = TYPE_MODE (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg));
1355 uns3 = TYPE_UNSIGNED (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg));
1357 /* The mode and signedness of the argument as it is actually passed,
1358 after any TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_ARGS-driven ABI promotions. */
1359 mode3 = promote_mode (DECL_ARG_TYPE (arg), mode2, &uns3, 1);
1361 /* The mode of the register in which the argument is being passed. */
1362 mode4 = GET_MODE (reg);
1364 /* Eliminate sign extensions in the callee when possible. Only
1365 do this when:
1366 (a) a mode promotion has occurred;
1367 (b) the mode of the register is the same as the mode of
1368 the argument as it is passed; and
1369 (c) the signedness does not change across any of the promotions; and
1370 (d) when no language-level promotions (which we cannot guarantee
1371 will have been done by an external caller) are necessary,
1372 unless we know that this function is only ever called from
1373 the current compilation unit -- all of whose call sites will
1374 do the mode1 --> mode2 promotion. */
1375 if (mode1 != mode3
1376 && mode3 == mode4
1377 && uns1 == uns3
1378 && (mode1 == mode2 || strictly_local))
1380 /* Record that the value was promoted from mode1 to mode3,
1381 so that any sign extension at the head of the current
1382 function may be eliminated. */
1383 rtx x;
1384 x = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (mode1, const0_rtx);
1385 x = gen_rtx_fmt_e ((uns3 ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND), mode3, x);
1386 record_value_for_reg (reg, first, x);
1391 /* Called via note_stores. If X is a pseudo that is narrower than
1392 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and is being set, record what bits are known zero.
1394 If we are setting only a portion of X and we can't figure out what
1395 portion, assume all bits will be used since we don't know what will
1396 be happening.
1398 Similarly, set how many bits of X are known to be copies of the sign bit
1399 at all locations in the function. This is the smallest number implied
1400 by any set of X. */
1402 static void
1403 set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies (rtx x, const_rtx set, void *data)
1405 rtx insn = (rtx) data;
1406 unsigned int num;
1408 if (REG_P (x)
1409 && REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1410 /* If this register is undefined at the start of the file, we can't
1411 say what its contents were. */
1412 && ! REGNO_REG_SET_P
1413 (DF_LR_IN (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb), REGNO (x))
1414 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
1416 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, REGNO (x));
1418 if (set == 0 || GET_CODE (set) == CLOBBER)
1420 rsp->nonzero_bits = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x));
1421 rsp->sign_bit_copies = 1;
1422 return;
1425 /* If this register is being initialized using itself, and the
1426 register is uninitialized in this basic block, and there are
1427 no LOG_LINKS which set the register, then part of the
1428 register is uninitialized. In that case we can't assume
1429 anything about the number of nonzero bits.
1431 ??? We could do better if we checked this in
1432 reg_{nonzero_bits,num_sign_bit_copies}_for_combine. Then we
1433 could avoid making assumptions about the insn which initially
1434 sets the register, while still using the information in other
1435 insns. We would have to be careful to check every insn
1436 involved in the combination. */
1438 if (insn
1439 && reg_referenced_p (x, PATTERN (insn))
1440 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P (DF_LR_IN (BLOCK_FOR_INSN (insn)),
1441 REGNO (x)))
1443 rtx link;
1445 for (link = LOG_LINKS (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
1447 if (dead_or_set_p (XEXP (link, 0), x))
1448 break;
1450 if (!link)
1452 rsp->nonzero_bits = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x));
1453 rsp->sign_bit_copies = 1;
1454 return;
1458 /* If this is a complex assignment, see if we can convert it into a
1459 simple assignment. */
1460 set = expand_field_assignment (set);
1462 /* If this is a simple assignment, or we have a paradoxical SUBREG,
1463 set what we know about X. */
1465 if (SET_DEST (set) == x
1466 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set)) == SUBREG
1467 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)))
1468 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (set)))))
1469 && SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (set)) == x))
1471 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
1473 #ifdef SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
1474 /* If X is narrower than a word and SRC is a non-negative
1475 constant that would appear negative in the mode of X,
1476 sign-extend it for use in reg_stat[].nonzero_bits because some
1477 machines (maybe most) will actually do the sign-extension
1478 and this is the conservative approach.
1480 ??? For 2.5, try to tighten up the MD files in this regard
1481 instead of this kludge. */
1483 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) < BITS_PER_WORD
1484 && GET_CODE (src) == CONST_INT
1485 && INTVAL (src) > 0
1486 && 0 != (INTVAL (src)
1487 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
1488 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - 1))))
1489 src = GEN_INT (INTVAL (src)
1490 | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1)
1491 << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
1492 #endif
1494 /* Don't call nonzero_bits if it cannot change anything. */
1495 if (rsp->nonzero_bits != ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0)
1496 rsp->nonzero_bits |= nonzero_bits (src, nonzero_bits_mode);
1497 num = num_sign_bit_copies (SET_SRC (set), GET_MODE (x));
1498 if (rsp->sign_bit_copies == 0
1499 || rsp->sign_bit_copies > num)
1500 rsp->sign_bit_copies = num;
1502 else
1504 rsp->nonzero_bits = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x));
1505 rsp->sign_bit_copies = 1;
1510 /* See if INSN can be combined into I3. PRED and SUCC are optionally
1511 insns that were previously combined into I3 or that will be combined
1512 into the merger of INSN and I3.
1514 Return 0 if the combination is not allowed for any reason.
1516 If the combination is allowed, *PDEST will be set to the single
1517 destination of INSN and *PSRC to the single source, and this function
1518 will return 1. */
1520 static int
1521 can_combine_p (rtx insn, rtx i3, rtx pred ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx succ,
1522 rtx *pdest, rtx *psrc)
1524 int i;
1525 const_rtx set = 0;
1526 rtx src, dest;
1527 rtx p;
1528 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1529 rtx link;
1530 #endif
1531 int all_adjacent = (succ ? (next_active_insn (insn) == succ
1532 && next_active_insn (succ) == i3)
1533 : next_active_insn (insn) == i3);
1535 /* Can combine only if previous insn is a SET of a REG, a SUBREG or CC0.
1536 or a PARALLEL consisting of such a SET and CLOBBERs.
1538 If INSN has CLOBBER parallel parts, ignore them for our processing.
1539 By definition, these happen during the execution of the insn. When it
1540 is merged with another insn, all bets are off. If they are, in fact,
1541 needed and aren't also supplied in I3, they may be added by
1542 recog_for_combine. Otherwise, it won't match.
1544 We can also ignore a SET whose SET_DEST is mentioned in a REG_UNUSED
1545 note.
1547 Get the source and destination of INSN. If more than one, can't
1548 combine. */
1550 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1551 set = PATTERN (insn);
1552 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1553 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, 0)) == SET)
1555 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0); i++)
1557 rtx elt = XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i);
1558 rtx note;
1560 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
1562 /* This is important to combine floating point insns
1563 for the SH4 port. */
1564 case USE:
1565 /* Combining an isolated USE doesn't make sense.
1566 We depend here on combinable_i3pat to reject them. */
1567 /* The code below this loop only verifies that the inputs of
1568 the SET in INSN do not change. We call reg_set_between_p
1569 to verify that the REG in the USE does not change between
1570 I3 and INSN.
1571 If the USE in INSN was for a pseudo register, the matching
1572 insn pattern will likely match any register; combining this
1573 with any other USE would only be safe if we knew that the
1574 used registers have identical values, or if there was
1575 something to tell them apart, e.g. different modes. For
1576 now, we forgo such complicated tests and simply disallow
1577 combining of USES of pseudo registers with any other USE. */
1578 if (REG_P (XEXP (elt, 0))
1579 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == PARALLEL)
1581 rtx i3pat = PATTERN (i3);
1582 int i = XVECLEN (i3pat, 0) - 1;
1583 unsigned int regno = REGNO (XEXP (elt, 0));
1587 rtx i3elt = XVECEXP (i3pat, 0, i);
1589 if (GET_CODE (i3elt) == USE
1590 && REG_P (XEXP (i3elt, 0))
1591 && (REGNO (XEXP (i3elt, 0)) == regno
1592 ? reg_set_between_p (XEXP (elt, 0),
1593 PREV_INSN (insn), i3)
1594 : regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
1595 return 0;
1597 while (--i >= 0);
1599 break;
1601 /* We can ignore CLOBBERs. */
1602 case CLOBBER:
1603 break;
1605 case SET:
1606 /* Ignore SETs whose result isn't used but not those that
1607 have side-effects. */
1608 if (find_reg_note (insn, REG_UNUSED, SET_DEST (elt))
1609 && (!(note = find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX))
1610 || INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0)) <= 0)
1611 && ! side_effects_p (elt))
1612 break;
1614 /* If we have already found a SET, this is a second one and
1615 so we cannot combine with this insn. */
1616 if (set)
1617 return 0;
1619 set = elt;
1620 break;
1622 default:
1623 /* Anything else means we can't combine. */
1624 return 0;
1628 if (set == 0
1629 /* If SET_SRC is an ASM_OPERANDS we can't throw away these CLOBBERs,
1630 so don't do anything with it. */
1631 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == ASM_OPERANDS)
1632 return 0;
1634 else
1635 return 0;
1637 if (set == 0)
1638 return 0;
1640 set = expand_field_assignment (set);
1641 src = SET_SRC (set), dest = SET_DEST (set);
1643 /* Don't eliminate a store in the stack pointer. */
1644 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx
1645 /* Don't combine with an insn that sets a register to itself if it has
1646 a REG_EQUAL note. This may be part of a REG_NO_CONFLICT sequence. */
1647 || (rtx_equal_p (src, dest) && find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
1648 /* Can't merge an ASM_OPERANDS. */
1649 || GET_CODE (src) == ASM_OPERANDS
1650 /* Can't merge a function call. */
1651 || GET_CODE (src) == CALL
1652 /* Don't eliminate a function call argument. */
1653 || (CALL_P (i3)
1654 && (find_reg_fusage (i3, USE, dest)
1655 || (REG_P (dest)
1656 && REGNO (dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1657 && global_regs[REGNO (dest)])))
1658 /* Don't substitute into an incremented register. */
1659 || FIND_REG_INC_NOTE (i3, dest)
1660 || (succ && FIND_REG_INC_NOTE (succ, dest))
1661 /* Don't substitute into a non-local goto, this confuses CFG. */
1662 || (JUMP_P (i3) && find_reg_note (i3, REG_NON_LOCAL_GOTO, NULL_RTX))
1663 #if 0
1664 /* Don't combine the end of a libcall into anything. */
1665 /* ??? This gives worse code, and appears to be unnecessary, since no
1666 pass after flow uses REG_LIBCALL/REG_RETVAL notes. Local-alloc does
1667 use REG_RETVAL notes for noconflict blocks, but other code here
1668 makes sure that those insns don't disappear. */
1669 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX)
1670 #endif
1671 /* Make sure that DEST is not used after SUCC but before I3. */
1672 || (succ && ! all_adjacent
1673 && reg_used_between_p (dest, succ, i3))
1674 /* Make sure that the value that is to be substituted for the register
1675 does not use any registers whose values alter in between. However,
1676 If the insns are adjacent, a use can't cross a set even though we
1677 think it might (this can happen for a sequence of insns each setting
1678 the same destination; last_set of that register might point to
1679 a NOTE). If INSN has a REG_EQUIV note, the register is always
1680 equivalent to the memory so the substitution is valid even if there
1681 are intervening stores. Also, don't move a volatile asm or
1682 UNSPEC_VOLATILE across any other insns. */
1683 || (! all_adjacent
1684 && (((!MEM_P (src)
1685 || ! find_reg_note (insn, REG_EQUIV, src))
1686 && use_crosses_set_p (src, DF_INSN_LUID (insn)))
1687 || (GET_CODE (src) == ASM_OPERANDS && MEM_VOLATILE_P (src))
1688 || GET_CODE (src) == UNSPEC_VOLATILE))
1689 /* If there is a REG_NO_CONFLICT note for DEST in I3 or SUCC, we get
1690 better register allocation by not doing the combine. */
1691 || find_reg_note (i3, REG_NO_CONFLICT, dest)
1692 || (succ && find_reg_note (succ, REG_NO_CONFLICT, dest))
1693 /* Don't combine across a CALL_INSN, because that would possibly
1694 change whether the life span of some REGs crosses calls or not,
1695 and it is a pain to update that information.
1696 Exception: if source is a constant, moving it later can't hurt.
1697 Accept that as a special case. */
1698 || (DF_INSN_LUID (insn) < last_call_luid && ! CONSTANT_P (src)))
1699 return 0;
1701 /* DEST must either be a REG or CC0. */
1702 if (REG_P (dest))
1704 /* If register alignment is being enforced for multi-word items in all
1705 cases except for parameters, it is possible to have a register copy
1706 insn referencing a hard register that is not allowed to contain the
1707 mode being copied and which would not be valid as an operand of most
1708 insns. Eliminate this problem by not combining with such an insn.
1710 Also, on some machines we don't want to extend the life of a hard
1711 register. */
1713 if (REG_P (src)
1714 && ((REGNO (dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1715 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (dest), GET_MODE (dest)))
1716 /* Don't extend the life of a hard register unless it is
1717 user variable (if we have few registers) or it can't
1718 fit into the desired register (meaning something special
1719 is going on).
1720 Also avoid substituting a return register into I3, because
1721 reload can't handle a conflict with constraints of other
1722 inputs. */
1723 || (REGNO (src) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1724 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (src), GET_MODE (src)))))
1725 return 0;
1727 else if (GET_CODE (dest) != CC0)
1728 return 0;
1731 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == PARALLEL)
1732 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (i3), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1733 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i3), 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
1735 /* Don't substitute for a register intended as a clobberable
1736 operand. */
1737 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i3), 0, i), 0);
1738 if (rtx_equal_p (reg, dest))
1739 return 0;
1741 /* If the clobber represents an earlyclobber operand, we must not
1742 substitute an expression containing the clobbered register.
1743 As we do not analyze the constraint strings here, we have to
1744 make the conservative assumption. However, if the register is
1745 a fixed hard reg, the clobber cannot represent any operand;
1746 we leave it up to the machine description to either accept or
1747 reject use-and-clobber patterns. */
1748 if (!REG_P (reg)
1749 || REGNO (reg) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1750 || !fixed_regs[REGNO (reg)])
1751 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, src))
1752 return 0;
1755 /* If INSN contains anything volatile, or is an `asm' (whether volatile
1756 or not), reject, unless nothing volatile comes between it and I3 */
1758 if (GET_CODE (src) == ASM_OPERANDS || volatile_refs_p (src))
1760 /* Make sure succ doesn't contain a volatile reference. */
1761 if (succ != 0 && volatile_refs_p (PATTERN (succ)))
1762 return 0;
1764 for (p = NEXT_INSN (insn); p != i3; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
1765 if (INSN_P (p) && p != succ && volatile_refs_p (PATTERN (p)))
1766 return 0;
1769 /* If INSN is an asm, and DEST is a hard register, reject, since it has
1770 to be an explicit register variable, and was chosen for a reason. */
1772 if (GET_CODE (src) == ASM_OPERANDS
1773 && REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1774 return 0;
1776 /* If there are any volatile insns between INSN and I3, reject, because
1777 they might affect machine state. */
1779 for (p = NEXT_INSN (insn); p != i3; p = NEXT_INSN (p))
1780 if (INSN_P (p) && p != succ && volatile_insn_p (PATTERN (p)))
1781 return 0;
1783 /* If INSN contains an autoincrement or autodecrement, make sure that
1784 register is not used between there and I3, and not already used in
1785 I3 either. Neither must it be used in PRED or SUCC, if they exist.
1786 Also insist that I3 not be a jump; if it were one
1787 and the incremented register were spilled, we would lose. */
1789 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
1790 for (link = REG_NOTES (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
1791 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_INC
1792 && (JUMP_P (i3)
1793 || reg_used_between_p (XEXP (link, 0), insn, i3)
1794 || (pred != NULL_RTX
1795 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (link, 0), PATTERN (pred)))
1796 || (succ != NULL_RTX
1797 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (link, 0), PATTERN (succ)))
1798 || reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (link, 0), PATTERN (i3))))
1799 return 0;
1800 #endif
1802 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
1803 /* Don't combine an insn that follows a CC0-setting insn.
1804 An insn that uses CC0 must not be separated from the one that sets it.
1805 We do, however, allow I2 to follow a CC0-setting insn if that insn
1806 is passed as I1; in that case it will be deleted also.
1807 We also allow combining in this case if all the insns are adjacent
1808 because that would leave the two CC0 insns adjacent as well.
1809 It would be more logical to test whether CC0 occurs inside I1 or I2,
1810 but that would be much slower, and this ought to be equivalent. */
1812 p = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1813 if (p && p != pred && NONJUMP_INSN_P (p) && sets_cc0_p (PATTERN (p))
1814 && ! all_adjacent)
1815 return 0;
1816 #endif
1818 /* If we get here, we have passed all the tests and the combination is
1819 to be allowed. */
1821 *pdest = dest;
1822 *psrc = src;
1824 return 1;
1827 /* LOC is the location within I3 that contains its pattern or the component
1828 of a PARALLEL of the pattern. We validate that it is valid for combining.
1830 One problem is if I3 modifies its output, as opposed to replacing it
1831 entirely, we can't allow the output to contain I2DEST or I1DEST as doing
1832 so would produce an insn that is not equivalent to the original insns.
1834 Consider:
1836 (set (reg:DI 101) (reg:DI 100))
1837 (set (subreg:SI (reg:DI 101) 0) <foo>)
1839 This is NOT equivalent to:
1841 (parallel [(set (subreg:SI (reg:DI 100) 0) <foo>)
1842 (set (reg:DI 101) (reg:DI 100))])
1844 Not only does this modify 100 (in which case it might still be valid
1845 if 100 were dead in I2), it sets 101 to the ORIGINAL value of 100.
1847 We can also run into a problem if I2 sets a register that I1
1848 uses and I1 gets directly substituted into I3 (not via I2). In that
1849 case, we would be getting the wrong value of I2DEST into I3, so we
1850 must reject the combination. This case occurs when I2 and I1 both
1851 feed into I3, rather than when I1 feeds into I2, which feeds into I3.
1852 If I1_NOT_IN_SRC is nonzero, it means that finding I1 in the source
1853 of a SET must prevent combination from occurring.
1855 Before doing the above check, we first try to expand a field assignment
1856 into a set of logical operations.
1858 If PI3_DEST_KILLED is nonzero, it is a pointer to a location in which
1859 we place a register that is both set and used within I3. If more than one
1860 such register is detected, we fail.
1862 Return 1 if the combination is valid, zero otherwise. */
1864 static int
1865 combinable_i3pat (rtx i3, rtx *loc, rtx i2dest, rtx i1dest,
1866 int i1_not_in_src, rtx *pi3dest_killed)
1868 rtx x = *loc;
1870 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
1872 rtx set = x ;
1873 rtx dest = SET_DEST (set);
1874 rtx src = SET_SRC (set);
1875 rtx inner_dest = dest;
1876 rtx subdest;
1878 while (GET_CODE (inner_dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
1879 || GET_CODE (inner_dest) == SUBREG
1880 || GET_CODE (inner_dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
1881 inner_dest = XEXP (inner_dest, 0);
1883 /* Check for the case where I3 modifies its output, as discussed
1884 above. We don't want to prevent pseudos from being combined
1885 into the address of a MEM, so only prevent the combination if
1886 i1 or i2 set the same MEM. */
1887 if ((inner_dest != dest &&
1888 (!MEM_P (inner_dest)
1889 || rtx_equal_p (i2dest, inner_dest)
1890 || (i1dest && rtx_equal_p (i1dest, inner_dest)))
1891 && (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i2dest, inner_dest)
1892 || (i1dest && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i1dest, inner_dest))))
1894 /* This is the same test done in can_combine_p except we can't test
1895 all_adjacent; we don't have to, since this instruction will stay
1896 in place, thus we are not considering increasing the lifetime of
1897 INNER_DEST.
1899 Also, if this insn sets a function argument, combining it with
1900 something that might need a spill could clobber a previous
1901 function argument; the all_adjacent test in can_combine_p also
1902 checks this; here, we do a more specific test for this case. */
1904 || (REG_P (inner_dest)
1905 && REGNO (inner_dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1906 && (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (inner_dest),
1907 GET_MODE (inner_dest))))
1908 || (i1_not_in_src && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i1dest, src)))
1909 return 0;
1911 /* If DEST is used in I3, it is being killed in this insn, so
1912 record that for later. We have to consider paradoxical
1913 subregs here, since they kill the whole register, but we
1914 ignore partial subregs, STRICT_LOW_PART, etc.
1915 Never add REG_DEAD notes for the FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM or the
1916 STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, since these are always considered to be
1917 live. Similarly for ARG_POINTER_REGNUM if it is fixed. */
1918 subdest = dest;
1919 if (GET_CODE (subdest) == SUBREG
1920 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (subdest))
1921 >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subdest)))))
1922 subdest = SUBREG_REG (subdest);
1923 if (pi3dest_killed
1924 && REG_P (subdest)
1925 && reg_referenced_p (subdest, PATTERN (i3))
1926 && REGNO (subdest) != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1927 #if HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1928 && REGNO (subdest) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1929 #endif
1930 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1931 && (REGNO (subdest) != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
1932 || ! fixed_regs [REGNO (subdest)])
1933 #endif
1934 && REGNO (subdest) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1936 if (*pi3dest_killed)
1937 return 0;
1939 *pi3dest_killed = subdest;
1943 else if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
1945 int i;
1947 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (x, 0); i++)
1948 if (! combinable_i3pat (i3, &XVECEXP (x, 0, i), i2dest, i1dest,
1949 i1_not_in_src, pi3dest_killed))
1950 return 0;
1953 return 1;
1956 /* Return 1 if X is an arithmetic expression that contains a multiplication
1957 and division. We don't count multiplications by powers of two here. */
1959 static int
1960 contains_muldiv (rtx x)
1962 switch (GET_CODE (x))
1964 case MOD: case DIV: case UMOD: case UDIV:
1965 return 1;
1967 case MULT:
1968 return ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
1969 && exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))) >= 0);
1970 default:
1971 if (BINARY_P (x))
1972 return contains_muldiv (XEXP (x, 0))
1973 || contains_muldiv (XEXP (x, 1));
1975 if (UNARY_P (x))
1976 return contains_muldiv (XEXP (x, 0));
1978 return 0;
1982 /* Determine whether INSN can be used in a combination. Return nonzero if
1983 not. This is used in try_combine to detect early some cases where we
1984 can't perform combinations. */
1986 static int
1987 cant_combine_insn_p (rtx insn)
1989 rtx set;
1990 rtx src, dest;
1992 /* If this isn't really an insn, we can't do anything.
1993 This can occur when flow deletes an insn that it has merged into an
1994 auto-increment address. */
1995 if (! INSN_P (insn))
1996 return 1;
1998 /* Never combine loads and stores involving hard regs that are likely
1999 to be spilled. The register allocator can usually handle such
2000 reg-reg moves by tying. If we allow the combiner to make
2001 substitutions of likely-spilled regs, reload might die.
2002 As an exception, we allow combinations involving fixed regs; these are
2003 not available to the register allocator so there's no risk involved. */
2005 set = single_set (insn);
2006 if (! set)
2007 return 0;
2008 src = SET_SRC (set);
2009 dest = SET_DEST (set);
2010 if (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG)
2011 src = SUBREG_REG (src);
2012 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
2013 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
2014 if (REG_P (src) && REG_P (dest)
2015 && ((REGNO (src) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2016 && ! fixed_regs[REGNO (src)]
2017 && CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (src))))
2018 || (REGNO (dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2019 && ! fixed_regs[REGNO (dest)]
2020 && CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (REGNO_REG_CLASS (REGNO (dest))))))
2021 return 1;
2023 return 0;
2026 struct likely_spilled_retval_info
2028 unsigned regno, nregs;
2029 unsigned mask;
2032 /* Called via note_stores by likely_spilled_retval_p. Remove from info->mask
2033 hard registers that are known to be written to / clobbered in full. */
2034 static void
2035 likely_spilled_retval_1 (rtx x, const_rtx set, void *data)
2037 struct likely_spilled_retval_info *info = data;
2038 unsigned regno, nregs;
2039 unsigned new_mask;
2041 if (!REG_P (XEXP (set, 0)))
2042 return;
2043 regno = REGNO (x);
2044 if (regno >= info->regno + info->nregs)
2045 return;
2046 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)];
2047 if (regno + nregs <= info->regno)
2048 return;
2049 new_mask = (2U << (nregs - 1)) - 1;
2050 if (regno < info->regno)
2051 new_mask >>= info->regno - regno;
2052 else
2053 new_mask <<= regno - info->regno;
2054 info->mask &= ~new_mask;
2057 /* Return nonzero iff part of the return value is live during INSN, and
2058 it is likely spilled. This can happen when more than one insn is needed
2059 to copy the return value, e.g. when we consider to combine into the
2060 second copy insn for a complex value. */
2062 static int
2063 likely_spilled_retval_p (rtx insn)
2065 rtx use = BB_END (this_basic_block);
2066 rtx reg, p;
2067 unsigned regno, nregs;
2068 /* We assume here that no machine mode needs more than
2069 32 hard registers when the value overlaps with a register
2070 for which FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P is true. */
2071 unsigned mask;
2072 struct likely_spilled_retval_info info;
2074 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (use) || GET_CODE (PATTERN (use)) != USE || insn == use)
2075 return 0;
2076 reg = XEXP (PATTERN (use), 0);
2077 if (!REG_P (reg) || !FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (REGNO (reg)))
2078 return 0;
2079 regno = REGNO (reg);
2080 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (reg)];
2081 if (nregs == 1)
2082 return 0;
2083 mask = (2U << (nregs - 1)) - 1;
2085 /* Disregard parts of the return value that are set later. */
2086 info.regno = regno;
2087 info.nregs = nregs;
2088 info.mask = mask;
2089 for (p = PREV_INSN (use); info.mask && p != insn; p = PREV_INSN (p))
2090 if (INSN_P (p))
2091 note_stores (PATTERN (p), likely_spilled_retval_1, &info);
2092 mask = info.mask;
2094 /* Check if any of the (probably) live return value registers is
2095 likely spilled. */
2096 nregs --;
2099 if ((mask & 1 << nregs)
2100 && CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (REGNO_REG_CLASS (regno + nregs)))
2101 return 1;
2102 } while (nregs--);
2103 return 0;
2106 /* Adjust INSN after we made a change to its destination.
2108 Changing the destination can invalidate notes that say something about
2109 the results of the insn and a LOG_LINK pointing to the insn. */
2111 static void
2112 adjust_for_new_dest (rtx insn)
2114 /* For notes, be conservative and simply remove them. */
2115 remove_reg_equal_equiv_notes (insn);
2117 /* The new insn will have a destination that was previously the destination
2118 of an insn just above it. Call distribute_links to make a LOG_LINK from
2119 the next use of that destination. */
2120 distribute_links (gen_rtx_INSN_LIST (VOIDmode, insn, NULL_RTX));
2122 df_insn_rescan (insn);
2125 /* Return TRUE if combine can reuse reg X in mode MODE.
2126 ADDED_SETS is nonzero if the original set is still required. */
2127 static bool
2128 can_change_dest_mode (rtx x, int added_sets, enum machine_mode mode)
2130 unsigned int regno;
2132 if (!REG_P(x))
2133 return false;
2135 regno = REGNO (x);
2136 /* Allow hard registers if the new mode is legal, and occupies no more
2137 registers than the old mode. */
2138 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2139 return (HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode)
2140 && (hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)]
2141 >= hard_regno_nregs[regno][mode]));
2143 /* Or a pseudo that is only used once. */
2144 return (REG_N_SETS (regno) == 1 && !added_sets
2145 && !REG_USERVAR_P (x));
2149 /* Check whether X, the destination of a set, refers to part of
2150 the register specified by REG. */
2152 static bool
2153 reg_subword_p (rtx x, rtx reg)
2155 /* Check that reg is an integer mode register. */
2156 if (!REG_P (reg) || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (reg)) != MODE_INT)
2157 return false;
2159 if (GET_CODE (x) == STRICT_LOW_PART
2160 || GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
2161 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2163 return GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
2164 && SUBREG_REG (x) == reg
2165 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) == MODE_INT;
2169 /* Try to combine the insns I1 and I2 into I3.
2170 Here I1 and I2 appear earlier than I3.
2171 I1 can be zero; then we combine just I2 into I3.
2173 If we are combining three insns and the resulting insn is not recognized,
2174 try splitting it into two insns. If that happens, I2 and I3 are retained
2175 and I1 is pseudo-deleted by turning it into a NOTE. Otherwise, I1 and I2
2176 are pseudo-deleted.
2178 Return 0 if the combination does not work. Then nothing is changed.
2179 If we did the combination, return the insn at which combine should
2180 resume scanning.
2182 Set NEW_DIRECT_JUMP_P to a nonzero value if try_combine creates a
2183 new direct jump instruction. */
2185 static rtx
2186 try_combine (rtx i3, rtx i2, rtx i1, int *new_direct_jump_p)
2188 /* New patterns for I3 and I2, respectively. */
2189 rtx newpat, newi2pat = 0;
2190 rtvec newpat_vec_with_clobbers = 0;
2191 int substed_i2 = 0, substed_i1 = 0;
2192 /* Indicates need to preserve SET in I1 or I2 in I3 if it is not dead. */
2193 int added_sets_1, added_sets_2;
2194 /* Total number of SETs to put into I3. */
2195 int total_sets;
2196 /* Nonzero if I2's body now appears in I3. */
2197 int i2_is_used;
2198 /* INSN_CODEs for new I3, new I2, and user of condition code. */
2199 int insn_code_number, i2_code_number = 0, other_code_number = 0;
2200 /* Contains I3 if the destination of I3 is used in its source, which means
2201 that the old life of I3 is being killed. If that usage is placed into
2202 I2 and not in I3, a REG_DEAD note must be made. */
2203 rtx i3dest_killed = 0;
2204 /* SET_DEST and SET_SRC of I2 and I1. */
2205 rtx i2dest, i2src, i1dest = 0, i1src = 0;
2206 /* PATTERN (I1) and PATTERN (I2), or a copy of it in certain cases. */
2207 rtx i1pat = 0, i2pat = 0;
2208 /* Indicates if I2DEST or I1DEST is in I2SRC or I1_SRC. */
2209 int i2dest_in_i2src = 0, i1dest_in_i1src = 0, i2dest_in_i1src = 0;
2210 int i2dest_killed = 0, i1dest_killed = 0;
2211 int i1_feeds_i3 = 0;
2212 /* Notes that must be added to REG_NOTES in I3 and I2. */
2213 rtx new_i3_notes, new_i2_notes;
2214 /* Notes that we substituted I3 into I2 instead of the normal case. */
2215 int i3_subst_into_i2 = 0;
2216 /* Notes that I1, I2 or I3 is a MULT operation. */
2217 int have_mult = 0;
2218 int swap_i2i3 = 0;
2220 int maxreg;
2221 rtx temp;
2222 rtx link;
2223 rtx other_pat = 0;
2224 rtx new_other_notes;
2225 int i;
2227 /* Exit early if one of the insns involved can't be used for
2228 combinations. */
2229 if (cant_combine_insn_p (i3)
2230 || cant_combine_insn_p (i2)
2231 || (i1 && cant_combine_insn_p (i1))
2232 || likely_spilled_retval_p (i3)
2233 /* We also can't do anything if I3 has a
2234 REG_LIBCALL note since we don't want to disrupt the contiguity of a
2235 libcall. */
2236 #if 0
2237 /* ??? This gives worse code, and appears to be unnecessary, since no
2238 pass after flow uses REG_LIBCALL/REG_RETVAL notes. */
2239 || find_reg_note (i3, REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX)
2240 #endif
2242 return 0;
2244 combine_attempts++;
2245 undobuf.other_insn = 0;
2247 /* Reset the hard register usage information. */
2248 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (newpat_used_regs);
2250 /* If I1 and I2 both feed I3, they can be in any order. To simplify the
2251 code below, set I1 to be the earlier of the two insns. */
2252 if (i1 && DF_INSN_LUID (i1) > DF_INSN_LUID (i2))
2253 temp = i1, i1 = i2, i2 = temp;
2255 added_links_insn = 0;
2257 /* First check for one important special-case that the code below will
2258 not handle. Namely, the case where I1 is zero, I2 is a PARALLEL
2259 and I3 is a SET whose SET_SRC is a SET_DEST in I2. In that case,
2260 we may be able to replace that destination with the destination of I3.
2261 This occurs in the common code where we compute both a quotient and
2262 remainder into a structure, in which case we want to do the computation
2263 directly into the structure to avoid register-register copies.
2265 Note that this case handles both multiple sets in I2 and also
2266 cases where I2 has a number of CLOBBER or PARALLELs.
2268 We make very conservative checks below and only try to handle the
2269 most common cases of this. For example, we only handle the case
2270 where I2 and I3 are adjacent to avoid making difficult register
2271 usage tests. */
2273 if (i1 == 0 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (i3) && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == SET
2274 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)))
2275 && REGNO (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3))) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2276 && find_reg_note (i3, REG_DEAD, SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)))
2277 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i2)) == PARALLEL
2278 && ! side_effects_p (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)))
2279 /* If the dest of I3 is a ZERO_EXTRACT or STRICT_LOW_PART, the code
2280 below would need to check what is inside (and reg_overlap_mentioned_p
2281 doesn't support those codes anyway). Don't allow those destinations;
2282 the resulting insn isn't likely to be recognized anyway. */
2283 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3))) != ZERO_EXTRACT
2284 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3))) != STRICT_LOW_PART
2285 && ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)),
2286 SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)))
2287 && next_real_insn (i2) == i3)
2289 rtx p2 = PATTERN (i2);
2291 /* Make sure that the destination of I3,
2292 which we are going to substitute into one output of I2,
2293 is not used within another output of I2. We must avoid making this:
2294 (parallel [(set (mem (reg 69)) ...)
2295 (set (reg 69) ...)])
2296 which is not well-defined as to order of actions.
2297 (Besides, reload can't handle output reloads for this.)
2299 The problem can also happen if the dest of I3 is a memory ref,
2300 if another dest in I2 is an indirect memory ref. */
2301 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (p2, 0); i++)
2302 if ((GET_CODE (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)) == SET
2303 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
2304 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)),
2305 SET_DEST (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i))))
2306 break;
2308 if (i == XVECLEN (p2, 0))
2309 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (p2, 0); i++)
2310 if ((GET_CODE (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)) == SET
2311 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
2312 && SET_DEST (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)) == SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)))
2314 combine_merges++;
2316 subst_insn = i3;
2317 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i2);
2319 added_sets_2 = added_sets_1 = 0;
2320 i2dest = SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3));
2321 i2dest_killed = dead_or_set_p (i2, i2dest);
2323 /* Replace the dest in I2 with our dest and make the resulting
2324 insn the new pattern for I3. Then skip to where we
2325 validate the pattern. Everything was set up above. */
2326 SUBST (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (p2, 0, i)),
2327 SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)));
2329 newpat = p2;
2330 i3_subst_into_i2 = 1;
2331 goto validate_replacement;
2335 /* If I2 is setting a pseudo to a constant and I3 is setting some
2336 sub-part of it to another constant, merge them by making a new
2337 constant. */
2338 if (i1 == 0
2339 && (temp = single_set (i2)) != 0
2340 && (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (temp)) == CONST_INT
2341 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (temp)) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2342 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == SET
2343 && (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3))) == CONST_INT
2344 || GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3))) == CONST_DOUBLE)
2345 && reg_subword_p (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)), SET_DEST (temp)))
2347 rtx dest = SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3));
2348 int offset = -1;
2349 int width = 0;
2351 if (GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
2353 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 1)) == CONST_INT
2354 && GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 2)) == CONST_INT)
2356 width = INTVAL (XEXP (dest, 1));
2357 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (dest, 2));
2358 dest = XEXP (dest, 0);
2359 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
2360 offset = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) - width - offset;
2363 else
2365 if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
2366 dest = XEXP (dest, 0);
2367 width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2368 offset = 0;
2371 if (offset >= 0)
2373 /* If this is the low part, we're done. */
2374 if (subreg_lowpart_p (dest))
2376 /* Handle the case where inner is twice the size of outer. */
2377 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (temp)))
2378 == 2 * GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)))
2379 offset += GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2380 /* Otherwise give up for now. */
2381 else
2382 offset = -1;
2385 if (offset >= 0
2386 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (temp)))
2387 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT * 2))
2389 HOST_WIDE_INT mhi, ohi, ihi;
2390 HOST_WIDE_INT mlo, olo, ilo;
2391 rtx inner = SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3));
2392 rtx outer = SET_SRC (temp);
2394 if (GET_CODE (outer) == CONST_INT)
2396 olo = INTVAL (outer);
2397 ohi = olo < 0 ? -1 : 0;
2399 else
2401 olo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (outer);
2402 ohi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (outer);
2405 if (GET_CODE (inner) == CONST_INT)
2407 ilo = INTVAL (inner);
2408 ihi = ilo < 0 ? -1 : 0;
2410 else
2412 ilo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (inner);
2413 ihi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (inner);
2416 if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
2418 mlo = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
2419 mhi = 0;
2421 else if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT * 2)
2423 mhi = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
2424 << (width - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)) - 1;
2425 mlo = -1;
2427 else
2429 mlo = -1;
2430 mhi = -1;
2433 ilo &= mlo;
2434 ihi &= mhi;
2436 if (offset >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
2438 mhi = mlo << (offset - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
2439 mlo = 0;
2440 ihi = ilo << (offset - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
2441 ilo = 0;
2443 else if (offset > 0)
2445 mhi = (mhi << offset) | ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) mlo
2446 >> (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - offset));
2447 mlo = mlo << offset;
2448 ihi = (ihi << offset) | ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) ilo
2449 >> (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - offset));
2450 ilo = ilo << offset;
2453 olo = (olo & ~mlo) | ilo;
2454 ohi = (ohi & ~mhi) | ihi;
2456 combine_merges++;
2457 subst_insn = i3;
2458 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i2);
2459 added_sets_2 = added_sets_1 = 0;
2460 i2dest = SET_DEST (temp);
2461 i2dest_killed = dead_or_set_p (i2, i2dest);
2463 SUBST (SET_SRC (temp),
2464 immed_double_const (olo, ohi, GET_MODE (SET_DEST (temp))));
2466 newpat = PATTERN (i2);
2467 goto validate_replacement;
2471 #ifndef HAVE_cc0
2472 /* If we have no I1 and I2 looks like:
2473 (parallel [(set (reg:CC X) (compare:CC OP (const_int 0)))
2474 (set Y OP)])
2475 make up a dummy I1 that is
2476 (set Y OP)
2477 and change I2 to be
2478 (set (reg:CC X) (compare:CC Y (const_int 0)))
2480 (We can ignore any trailing CLOBBERs.)
2482 This undoes a previous combination and allows us to match a branch-and-
2483 decrement insn. */
2485 if (i1 == 0 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i2)) == PARALLEL
2486 && XVECLEN (PATTERN (i2), 0) >= 2
2487 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0)) == SET
2488 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0))))
2489 == MODE_CC)
2490 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0))) == COMPARE
2491 && XEXP (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0)), 1) == const0_rtx
2492 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 1)) == SET
2493 && REG_P (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 1)))
2494 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0)), 0),
2495 SET_SRC (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 1))))
2497 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (i2), 0) - 1; i >= 2; i--)
2498 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i)) != CLOBBER)
2499 break;
2501 if (i == 1)
2503 /* We make I1 with the same INSN_UID as I2. This gives it
2504 the same DF_INSN_LUID for value tracking. Our fake I1 will
2505 never appear in the insn stream so giving it the same INSN_UID
2506 as I2 will not cause a problem. */
2508 i1 = gen_rtx_INSN (VOIDmode, INSN_UID (i2), NULL_RTX, i2,
2509 BLOCK_FOR_INSN (i2), INSN_LOCATOR (i2),
2510 XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 1), -1, NULL_RTX);
2512 SUBST (PATTERN (i2), XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, 0));
2513 SUBST (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i2)), 0),
2514 SET_DEST (PATTERN (i1)));
2517 #endif
2519 /* Verify that I2 and I1 are valid for combining. */
2520 if (! can_combine_p (i2, i3, i1, NULL_RTX, &i2dest, &i2src)
2521 || (i1 && ! can_combine_p (i1, i3, NULL_RTX, i2, &i1dest, &i1src)))
2523 undo_all ();
2524 return 0;
2527 /* Record whether I2DEST is used in I2SRC and similarly for the other
2528 cases. Knowing this will help in register status updating below. */
2529 i2dest_in_i2src = reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i2dest, i2src);
2530 i1dest_in_i1src = i1 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i1dest, i1src);
2531 i2dest_in_i1src = i1 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i2dest, i1src);
2532 i2dest_killed = dead_or_set_p (i2, i2dest);
2533 i1dest_killed = i1 && dead_or_set_p (i1, i1dest);
2535 /* See if I1 directly feeds into I3. It does if I1DEST is not used
2536 in I2SRC. */
2537 i1_feeds_i3 = i1 && ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i1dest, i2src);
2539 /* Ensure that I3's pattern can be the destination of combines. */
2540 if (! combinable_i3pat (i3, &PATTERN (i3), i2dest, i1dest,
2541 i1 && i2dest_in_i1src && i1_feeds_i3,
2542 &i3dest_killed))
2544 undo_all ();
2545 return 0;
2548 /* See if any of the insns is a MULT operation. Unless one is, we will
2549 reject a combination that is, since it must be slower. Be conservative
2550 here. */
2551 if (GET_CODE (i2src) == MULT
2552 || (i1 != 0 && GET_CODE (i1src) == MULT)
2553 || (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == SET
2554 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3))) == MULT))
2555 have_mult = 1;
2557 /* If I3 has an inc, then give up if I1 or I2 uses the reg that is inc'd.
2558 We used to do this EXCEPT in one case: I3 has a post-inc in an
2559 output operand. However, that exception can give rise to insns like
2560 mov r3,(r3)+
2561 which is a famous insn on the PDP-11 where the value of r3 used as the
2562 source was model-dependent. Avoid this sort of thing. */
2564 #if 0
2565 if (!(GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == SET
2566 && REG_P (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)))
2567 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)))
2568 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)), 0)) == POST_INC
2569 || GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (PATTERN (i3)), 0)) == POST_DEC)))
2570 /* It's not the exception. */
2571 #endif
2572 #ifdef AUTO_INC_DEC
2573 for (link = REG_NOTES (i3); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
2574 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_INC
2575 && (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (link, 0), PATTERN (i2))
2576 || (i1 != 0
2577 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (link, 0), PATTERN (i1)))))
2579 undo_all ();
2580 return 0;
2582 #endif
2584 /* See if the SETs in I1 or I2 need to be kept around in the merged
2585 instruction: whenever the value set there is still needed past I3.
2586 For the SETs in I2, this is easy: we see if I2DEST dies or is set in I3.
2588 For the SET in I1, we have two cases: If I1 and I2 independently
2589 feed into I3, the set in I1 needs to be kept around if I1DEST dies
2590 or is set in I3. Otherwise (if I1 feeds I2 which feeds I3), the set
2591 in I1 needs to be kept around unless I1DEST dies or is set in either
2592 I2 or I3. We can distinguish these cases by seeing if I2SRC mentions
2593 I1DEST. If so, we know I1 feeds into I2. */
2595 added_sets_2 = ! dead_or_set_p (i3, i2dest);
2597 added_sets_1
2598 = i1 && ! (i1_feeds_i3 ? dead_or_set_p (i3, i1dest)
2599 : (dead_or_set_p (i3, i1dest) || dead_or_set_p (i2, i1dest)));
2601 /* If the set in I2 needs to be kept around, we must make a copy of
2602 PATTERN (I2), so that when we substitute I1SRC for I1DEST in
2603 PATTERN (I2), we are only substituting for the original I1DEST, not into
2604 an already-substituted copy. This also prevents making self-referential
2605 rtx. If I2 is a PARALLEL, we just need the piece that assigns I2SRC to
2606 I2DEST. */
2608 if (added_sets_2)
2610 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i2)) == PARALLEL)
2611 i2pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, i2dest, copy_rtx (i2src));
2612 else
2613 i2pat = copy_rtx (PATTERN (i2));
2616 if (added_sets_1)
2618 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i1)) == PARALLEL)
2619 i1pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, i1dest, copy_rtx (i1src));
2620 else
2621 i1pat = copy_rtx (PATTERN (i1));
2624 combine_merges++;
2626 /* Substitute in the latest insn for the regs set by the earlier ones. */
2628 maxreg = max_reg_num ();
2630 subst_insn = i3;
2632 #ifndef HAVE_cc0
2633 /* Many machines that don't use CC0 have insns that can both perform an
2634 arithmetic operation and set the condition code. These operations will
2635 be represented as a PARALLEL with the first element of the vector
2636 being a COMPARE of an arithmetic operation with the constant zero.
2637 The second element of the vector will set some pseudo to the result
2638 of the same arithmetic operation. If we simplify the COMPARE, we won't
2639 match such a pattern and so will generate an extra insn. Here we test
2640 for this case, where both the comparison and the operation result are
2641 needed, and make the PARALLEL by just replacing I2DEST in I3SRC with
2642 I2SRC. Later we will make the PARALLEL that contains I2. */
2644 if (i1 == 0 && added_sets_2 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (i3)) == SET
2645 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3))) == COMPARE
2646 && XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)), 1) == const0_rtx
2647 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (SET_SRC (PATTERN (i3)), 0), i2dest))
2649 #ifdef SELECT_CC_MODE
2650 rtx *cc_use;
2651 enum machine_mode compare_mode;
2652 #endif
2654 newpat = PATTERN (i3);
2655 SUBST (XEXP (SET_SRC (newpat), 0), i2src);
2657 i2_is_used = 1;
2659 #ifdef SELECT_CC_MODE
2660 /* See if a COMPARE with the operand we substituted in should be done
2661 with the mode that is currently being used. If not, do the same
2662 processing we do in `subst' for a SET; namely, if the destination
2663 is used only once, try to replace it with a register of the proper
2664 mode and also replace the COMPARE. */
2665 if (undobuf.other_insn == 0
2666 && (cc_use = find_single_use (SET_DEST (newpat), i3,
2667 &undobuf.other_insn))
2668 && ((compare_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (GET_CODE (*cc_use),
2669 i2src, const0_rtx))
2670 != GET_MODE (SET_DEST (newpat))))
2672 if (can_change_dest_mode(SET_DEST (newpat), added_sets_2,
2673 compare_mode))
2675 unsigned int regno = REGNO (SET_DEST (newpat));
2676 rtx new_dest;
2678 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2679 new_dest = gen_rtx_REG (compare_mode, regno);
2680 else
2682 SUBST_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[regno], compare_mode);
2683 new_dest = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
2686 SUBST (SET_DEST (newpat), new_dest);
2687 SUBST (XEXP (*cc_use, 0), new_dest);
2688 SUBST (SET_SRC (newpat),
2689 gen_rtx_COMPARE (compare_mode, i2src, const0_rtx));
2691 else
2692 undobuf.other_insn = 0;
2694 #endif
2696 else
2697 #endif
2699 /* It is possible that the source of I2 or I1 may be performing
2700 an unneeded operation, such as a ZERO_EXTEND of something
2701 that is known to have the high part zero. Handle that case
2702 by letting subst look at the innermost one of them.
2704 Another way to do this would be to have a function that tries
2705 to simplify a single insn instead of merging two or more
2706 insns. We don't do this because of the potential of infinite
2707 loops and because of the potential extra memory required.
2708 However, doing it the way we are is a bit of a kludge and
2709 doesn't catch all cases.
2711 But only do this if -fexpensive-optimizations since it slows
2712 things down and doesn't usually win.
2714 This is not done in the COMPARE case above because the
2715 unmodified I2PAT is used in the PARALLEL and so a pattern
2716 with a modified I2SRC would not match. */
2718 if (flag_expensive_optimizations)
2720 /* Pass pc_rtx so no substitutions are done, just
2721 simplifications. */
2722 if (i1)
2724 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i1);
2725 i1src = subst (i1src, pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
2727 else
2729 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i2);
2730 i2src = subst (i2src, pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
2734 n_occurrences = 0; /* `subst' counts here */
2736 /* If I1 feeds into I2 (not into I3) and I1DEST is in I1SRC, we
2737 need to make a unique copy of I2SRC each time we substitute it
2738 to avoid self-referential rtl. */
2740 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i2);
2741 newpat = subst (PATTERN (i3), i2dest, i2src, 0,
2742 ! i1_feeds_i3 && i1dest_in_i1src);
2743 substed_i2 = 1;
2745 /* Record whether i2's body now appears within i3's body. */
2746 i2_is_used = n_occurrences;
2749 /* If we already got a failure, don't try to do more. Otherwise,
2750 try to substitute in I1 if we have it. */
2752 if (i1 && GET_CODE (newpat) != CLOBBER)
2754 /* Check that an autoincrement side-effect on I1 has not been lost.
2755 This happens if I1DEST is mentioned in I2 and dies there, and
2756 has disappeared from the new pattern. */
2757 if ((FIND_REG_INC_NOTE (i1, NULL_RTX) != 0
2758 && !i1_feeds_i3
2759 && dead_or_set_p (i2, i1dest)
2760 && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i1dest, newpat))
2761 /* Before we can do this substitution, we must redo the test done
2762 above (see detailed comments there) that ensures that I1DEST
2763 isn't mentioned in any SETs in NEWPAT that are field assignments. */
2764 || !combinable_i3pat (NULL_RTX, &newpat, i1dest, NULL_RTX, 0, 0))
2766 undo_all ();
2767 return 0;
2770 n_occurrences = 0;
2771 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (i1);
2772 newpat = subst (newpat, i1dest, i1src, 0, 0);
2773 substed_i1 = 1;
2776 /* Fail if an autoincrement side-effect has been duplicated. Be careful
2777 to count all the ways that I2SRC and I1SRC can be used. */
2778 if ((FIND_REG_INC_NOTE (i2, NULL_RTX) != 0
2779 && i2_is_used + added_sets_2 > 1)
2780 || (i1 != 0 && FIND_REG_INC_NOTE (i1, NULL_RTX) != 0
2781 && (n_occurrences + added_sets_1 + (added_sets_2 && ! i1_feeds_i3)
2782 > 1))
2783 /* Fail if we tried to make a new register. */
2784 || max_reg_num () != maxreg
2785 /* Fail if we couldn't do something and have a CLOBBER. */
2786 || GET_CODE (newpat) == CLOBBER
2787 /* Fail if this new pattern is a MULT and we didn't have one before
2788 at the outer level. */
2789 || (GET_CODE (newpat) == SET && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (newpat)) == MULT
2790 && ! have_mult))
2792 undo_all ();
2793 return 0;
2796 /* If the actions of the earlier insns must be kept
2797 in addition to substituting them into the latest one,
2798 we must make a new PARALLEL for the latest insn
2799 to hold additional the SETs. */
2801 if (added_sets_1 || added_sets_2)
2803 combine_extras++;
2805 if (GET_CODE (newpat) == PARALLEL)
2807 rtvec old = XVEC (newpat, 0);
2808 total_sets = XVECLEN (newpat, 0) + added_sets_1 + added_sets_2;
2809 newpat = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (total_sets));
2810 memcpy (XVEC (newpat, 0)->elem, &old->elem[0],
2811 sizeof (old->elem[0]) * old->num_elem);
2813 else
2815 rtx old = newpat;
2816 total_sets = 1 + added_sets_1 + added_sets_2;
2817 newpat = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, rtvec_alloc (total_sets));
2818 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0) = old;
2821 if (added_sets_1)
2822 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, --total_sets) = i1pat;
2824 if (added_sets_2)
2826 /* If there is no I1, use I2's body as is. We used to also not do
2827 the subst call below if I2 was substituted into I3,
2828 but that could lose a simplification. */
2829 if (i1 == 0)
2830 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, --total_sets) = i2pat;
2831 else
2832 /* See comment where i2pat is assigned. */
2833 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, --total_sets)
2834 = subst (i2pat, i1dest, i1src, 0, 0);
2838 /* We come here when we are replacing a destination in I2 with the
2839 destination of I3. */
2840 validate_replacement:
2842 /* Note which hard regs this insn has as inputs. */
2843 mark_used_regs_combine (newpat);
2845 /* If recog_for_combine fails, it strips existing clobbers. If we'll
2846 consider splitting this pattern, we might need these clobbers. */
2847 if (i1 && GET_CODE (newpat) == PARALLEL
2848 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, XVECLEN (newpat, 0) - 1)) == CLOBBER)
2850 int len = XVECLEN (newpat, 0);
2852 newpat_vec_with_clobbers = rtvec_alloc (len);
2853 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
2854 RTVEC_ELT (newpat_vec_with_clobbers, i) = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i);
2857 /* Is the result of combination a valid instruction? */
2858 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
2860 /* If the result isn't valid, see if it is a PARALLEL of two SETs where
2861 the second SET's destination is a register that is unused and isn't
2862 marked as an instruction that might trap in an EH region. In that case,
2863 we just need the first SET. This can occur when simplifying a divmod
2864 insn. We *must* test for this case here because the code below that
2865 splits two independent SETs doesn't handle this case correctly when it
2866 updates the register status.
2868 It's pointless doing this if we originally had two sets, one from
2869 i3, and one from i2. Combining then splitting the parallel results
2870 in the original i2 again plus an invalid insn (which we delete).
2871 The net effect is only to move instructions around, which makes
2872 debug info less accurate.
2874 Also check the case where the first SET's destination is unused.
2875 That would not cause incorrect code, but does cause an unneeded
2876 insn to remain. */
2878 if (insn_code_number < 0
2879 && !(added_sets_2 && i1 == 0)
2880 && GET_CODE (newpat) == PARALLEL
2881 && XVECLEN (newpat, 0) == 2
2882 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)) == SET
2883 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)) == SET
2884 && asm_noperands (newpat) < 0)
2886 rtx set0 = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0);
2887 rtx set1 = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1);
2888 rtx note;
2890 if (((REG_P (SET_DEST (set1))
2891 && find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED, SET_DEST (set1)))
2892 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set1)) == SUBREG
2893 && find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED, SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (set1)))))
2894 && (!(note = find_reg_note (i3, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX))
2895 || INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0)) <= 0)
2896 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (set1)))
2898 newpat = set0;
2899 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
2902 else if (((REG_P (SET_DEST (set0))
2903 && find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED, SET_DEST (set0)))
2904 || (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (set0)) == SUBREG
2905 && find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED,
2906 SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (set0)))))
2907 && (!(note = find_reg_note (i3, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX))
2908 || INTVAL (XEXP (note, 0)) <= 0)
2909 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (set0)))
2911 newpat = set1;
2912 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
2914 if (insn_code_number >= 0)
2916 /* If we will be able to accept this, we have made a
2917 change to the destination of I3. This requires us to
2918 do a few adjustments. */
2920 PATTERN (i3) = newpat;
2921 adjust_for_new_dest (i3);
2926 /* If we were combining three insns and the result is a simple SET
2927 with no ASM_OPERANDS that wasn't recognized, try to split it into two
2928 insns. There are two ways to do this. It can be split using a
2929 machine-specific method (like when you have an addition of a large
2930 constant) or by combine in the function find_split_point. */
2932 if (i1 && insn_code_number < 0 && GET_CODE (newpat) == SET
2933 && asm_noperands (newpat) < 0)
2935 rtx parallel, m_split, *split;
2937 /* See if the MD file can split NEWPAT. If it can't, see if letting it
2938 use I2DEST as a scratch register will help. In the latter case,
2939 convert I2DEST to the mode of the source of NEWPAT if we can. */
2941 m_split = combine_split_insns (newpat, i3);
2943 /* We can only use I2DEST as a scratch reg if it doesn't overlap any
2944 inputs of NEWPAT. */
2946 /* ??? If I2DEST is not safe, and I1DEST exists, then it would be
2947 possible to try that as a scratch reg. This would require adding
2948 more code to make it work though. */
2950 if (m_split == 0 && ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (i2dest, newpat))
2952 enum machine_mode new_mode = GET_MODE (SET_DEST (newpat));
2954 /* First try to split using the original register as a
2955 scratch register. */
2956 parallel = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
2957 gen_rtvec (2, newpat,
2958 gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode,
2959 i2dest)));
2960 m_split = combine_split_insns (parallel, i3);
2962 /* If that didn't work, try changing the mode of I2DEST if
2963 we can. */
2964 if (m_split == 0
2965 && new_mode != GET_MODE (i2dest)
2966 && new_mode != VOIDmode
2967 && can_change_dest_mode (i2dest, added_sets_2, new_mode))
2969 enum machine_mode old_mode = GET_MODE (i2dest);
2970 rtx ni2dest;
2972 if (REGNO (i2dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2973 ni2dest = gen_rtx_REG (new_mode, REGNO (i2dest));
2974 else
2976 SUBST_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (i2dest)], new_mode);
2977 ni2dest = regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (i2dest)];
2980 parallel = (gen_rtx_PARALLEL
2981 (VOIDmode,
2982 gen_rtvec (2, newpat,
2983 gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode,
2984 ni2dest))));
2985 m_split = combine_split_insns (parallel, i3);
2987 if (m_split == 0
2988 && REGNO (i2dest) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
2990 struct undo *buf;
2992 adjust_reg_mode (regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (i2dest)], old_mode);
2993 buf = undobuf.undos;
2994 undobuf.undos = buf->next;
2995 buf->next = undobuf.frees;
2996 undobuf.frees = buf;
3001 /* If recog_for_combine has discarded clobbers, try to use them
3002 again for the split. */
3003 if (m_split == 0 && newpat_vec_with_clobbers)
3005 parallel = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode, newpat_vec_with_clobbers);
3006 m_split = combine_split_insns (parallel, i3);
3009 if (m_split && NEXT_INSN (m_split) == NULL_RTX)
3011 m_split = PATTERN (m_split);
3012 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&m_split, i3, &new_i3_notes);
3013 if (insn_code_number >= 0)
3014 newpat = m_split;
3016 else if (m_split && NEXT_INSN (NEXT_INSN (m_split)) == NULL_RTX
3017 && (next_real_insn (i2) == i3
3018 || ! use_crosses_set_p (PATTERN (m_split), DF_INSN_LUID (i2))))
3020 rtx i2set, i3set;
3021 rtx newi3pat = PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (m_split));
3022 newi2pat = PATTERN (m_split);
3024 i3set = single_set (NEXT_INSN (m_split));
3025 i2set = single_set (m_split);
3027 i2_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newi2pat, i2, &new_i2_notes);
3029 /* If I2 or I3 has multiple SETs, we won't know how to track
3030 register status, so don't use these insns. If I2's destination
3031 is used between I2 and I3, we also can't use these insns. */
3033 if (i2_code_number >= 0 && i2set && i3set
3034 && (next_real_insn (i2) == i3
3035 || ! reg_used_between_p (SET_DEST (i2set), i2, i3)))
3036 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newi3pat, i3,
3037 &new_i3_notes);
3038 if (insn_code_number >= 0)
3039 newpat = newi3pat;
3041 /* It is possible that both insns now set the destination of I3.
3042 If so, we must show an extra use of it. */
3044 if (insn_code_number >= 0)
3046 rtx new_i3_dest = SET_DEST (i3set);
3047 rtx new_i2_dest = SET_DEST (i2set);
3049 while (GET_CODE (new_i3_dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
3050 || GET_CODE (new_i3_dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
3051 || GET_CODE (new_i3_dest) == SUBREG)
3052 new_i3_dest = XEXP (new_i3_dest, 0);
3054 while (GET_CODE (new_i2_dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
3055 || GET_CODE (new_i2_dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
3056 || GET_CODE (new_i2_dest) == SUBREG)
3057 new_i2_dest = XEXP (new_i2_dest, 0);
3059 if (REG_P (new_i3_dest)
3060 && REG_P (new_i2_dest)
3061 && REGNO (new_i3_dest) == REGNO (new_i2_dest))
3062 INC_REG_N_SETS (REGNO (new_i2_dest), 1);
3066 /* If we can split it and use I2DEST, go ahead and see if that
3067 helps things be recognized. Verify that none of the registers
3068 are set between I2 and I3. */
3069 if (insn_code_number < 0 && (split = find_split_point (&newpat, i3)) != 0
3070 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
3071 && REG_P (i2dest)
3072 #endif
3073 /* We need I2DEST in the proper mode. If it is a hard register
3074 or the only use of a pseudo, we can change its mode.
3075 Make sure we don't change a hard register to have a mode that
3076 isn't valid for it, or change the number of registers. */
3077 && (GET_MODE (*split) == GET_MODE (i2dest)
3078 || GET_MODE (*split) == VOIDmode
3079 || can_change_dest_mode (i2dest, added_sets_2,
3080 GET_MODE (*split)))
3081 && (next_real_insn (i2) == i3
3082 || ! use_crosses_set_p (*split, DF_INSN_LUID (i2)))
3083 /* We can't overwrite I2DEST if its value is still used by
3084 NEWPAT. */
3085 && ! reg_referenced_p (i2dest, newpat))
3087 rtx newdest = i2dest;
3088 enum rtx_code split_code = GET_CODE (*split);
3089 enum machine_mode split_mode = GET_MODE (*split);
3090 bool subst_done = false;
3091 newi2pat = NULL_RTX;
3093 /* Get NEWDEST as a register in the proper mode. We have already
3094 validated that we can do this. */
3095 if (GET_MODE (i2dest) != split_mode && split_mode != VOIDmode)
3097 if (REGNO (i2dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
3098 newdest = gen_rtx_REG (split_mode, REGNO (i2dest));
3099 else
3101 SUBST_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (i2dest)], split_mode);
3102 newdest = regno_reg_rtx[REGNO (i2dest)];
3106 /* If *SPLIT is a (mult FOO (const_int pow2)), convert it to
3107 an ASHIFT. This can occur if it was inside a PLUS and hence
3108 appeared to be a memory address. This is a kludge. */
3109 if (split_code == MULT
3110 && GET_CODE (XEXP (*split, 1)) == CONST_INT
3111 && INTVAL (XEXP (*split, 1)) > 0
3112 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (*split, 1)))) >= 0)
3114 SUBST (*split, gen_rtx_ASHIFT (split_mode,
3115 XEXP (*split, 0), GEN_INT (i)));
3116 /* Update split_code because we may not have a multiply
3117 anymore. */
3118 split_code = GET_CODE (*split);
3121 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
3122 /* If *SPLIT is a paradoxical SUBREG, when we split it, it should
3123 be written as a ZERO_EXTEND. */
3124 if (split_code == SUBREG && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (*split)))
3126 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
3127 /* Or as a SIGN_EXTEND if LOAD_EXTEND_OP says that that's
3128 what it really is. */
3129 if (LOAD_EXTEND_OP (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (*split)))
3130 == SIGN_EXTEND)
3131 SUBST (*split, gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (split_mode,
3132 SUBREG_REG (*split)));
3133 else
3134 #endif
3135 SUBST (*split, gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (split_mode,
3136 SUBREG_REG (*split)));
3138 #endif
3140 /* Attempt to split binary operators using arithmetic identities. */
3141 if (BINARY_P (SET_SRC (newpat))
3142 && split_mode == GET_MODE (SET_SRC (newpat))
3143 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (newpat)))
3145 rtx setsrc = SET_SRC (newpat);
3146 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (setsrc);
3147 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (setsrc);
3148 rtx src_op0 = XEXP (setsrc, 0);
3149 rtx src_op1 = XEXP (setsrc, 1);
3151 /* Split "X = Y op Y" as "Z = Y; X = Z op Z". */
3152 if (rtx_equal_p (src_op0, src_op1))
3154 newi2pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, newdest, src_op0);
3155 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 0), newdest);
3156 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 1), newdest);
3157 subst_done = true;
3159 /* Split "((P op Q) op R) op S" where op is PLUS or MULT. */
3160 else if ((code == PLUS || code == MULT)
3161 && GET_CODE (src_op0) == code
3162 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src_op0, 0)) == code
3163 && (INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode)
3164 || (FLOAT_MODE_P (mode)
3165 && flag_unsafe_math_optimizations)))
3167 rtx p = XEXP (XEXP (src_op0, 0), 0);
3168 rtx q = XEXP (XEXP (src_op0, 0), 1);
3169 rtx r = XEXP (src_op0, 1);
3170 rtx s = src_op1;
3172 /* Split both "((X op Y) op X) op Y" and
3173 "((X op Y) op Y) op X" as "T op T" where T is
3174 "X op Y". */
3175 if ((rtx_equal_p (p,r) && rtx_equal_p (q,s))
3176 || (rtx_equal_p (p,s) && rtx_equal_p (q,r)))
3178 newi2pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, newdest,
3179 XEXP (src_op0, 0));
3180 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 0), newdest);
3181 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 1), newdest);
3182 subst_done = true;
3184 /* Split "((X op X) op Y) op Y)" as "T op T" where
3185 T is "X op Y". */
3186 else if (rtx_equal_p (p,q) && rtx_equal_p (r,s))
3188 rtx tmp = simplify_gen_binary (code, mode, p, r);
3189 newi2pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, newdest, tmp);
3190 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 0), newdest);
3191 SUBST (XEXP (setsrc, 1), newdest);
3192 subst_done = true;
3197 if (!subst_done)
3199 newi2pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, newdest, *split);
3200 SUBST (*split, newdest);
3203 i2_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newi2pat, i2, &new_i2_notes);
3205 /* recog_for_combine might have added CLOBBERs to newi2pat.
3206 Make sure NEWPAT does not depend on the clobbered regs. */
3207 if (GET_CODE (newi2pat) == PARALLEL)
3208 for (i = XVECLEN (newi2pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
3209 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newi2pat, 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
3211 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (newi2pat, 0, i), 0);
3212 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, newpat))
3214 undo_all ();
3215 return 0;
3219 /* If the split point was a MULT and we didn't have one before,
3220 don't use one now. */
3221 if (i2_code_number >= 0 && ! (split_code == MULT && ! have_mult))
3222 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
3226 /* Check for a case where we loaded from memory in a narrow mode and
3227 then sign extended it, but we need both registers. In that case,
3228 we have a PARALLEL with both loads from the same memory location.
3229 We can split this into a load from memory followed by a register-register
3230 copy. This saves at least one insn, more if register allocation can
3231 eliminate the copy.
3233 We cannot do this if the destination of the first assignment is a
3234 condition code register or cc0. We eliminate this case by making sure
3235 the SET_DEST and SET_SRC have the same mode.
3237 We cannot do this if the destination of the second assignment is
3238 a register that we have already assumed is zero-extended. Similarly
3239 for a SUBREG of such a register. */
3241 else if (i1 && insn_code_number < 0 && asm_noperands (newpat) < 0
3242 && GET_CODE (newpat) == PARALLEL
3243 && XVECLEN (newpat, 0) == 2
3244 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)) == SET
3245 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))) == SIGN_EXTEND
3246 && (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)))
3247 == GET_MODE (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))))
3248 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)) == SET
3249 && rtx_equal_p (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3250 XEXP (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)), 0))
3251 && ! use_crosses_set_p (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3252 DF_INSN_LUID (i2))
3253 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))) != ZERO_EXTRACT
3254 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))) != STRICT_LOW_PART
3255 && ! (temp = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3256 (REG_P (temp)
3257 && VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat,
3258 REGNO (temp))->nonzero_bits != 0
3259 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) < BITS_PER_WORD
3260 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) < HOST_BITS_PER_INT
3261 && (VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat,
3262 REGNO (temp))->nonzero_bits
3263 != GET_MODE_MASK (word_mode))))
3264 && ! (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))) == SUBREG
3265 && (temp = SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))),
3266 (REG_P (temp)
3267 && VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat,
3268 REGNO (temp))->nonzero_bits != 0
3269 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) < BITS_PER_WORD
3270 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) < HOST_BITS_PER_INT
3271 && (VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat,
3272 REGNO (temp))->nonzero_bits
3273 != GET_MODE_MASK (word_mode)))))
3274 && ! reg_overlap_mentioned_p (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3275 SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)))
3276 && ! find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED,
3277 SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))))
3279 rtx ni2dest;
3281 newi2pat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0);
3282 ni2dest = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0));
3283 newpat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1);
3284 SUBST (SET_SRC (newpat),
3285 gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (SET_SRC (newpat)), ni2dest));
3286 i2_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newi2pat, i2, &new_i2_notes);
3288 if (i2_code_number >= 0)
3289 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
3291 if (insn_code_number >= 0)
3292 swap_i2i3 = 1;
3295 /* Similarly, check for a case where we have a PARALLEL of two independent
3296 SETs but we started with three insns. In this case, we can do the sets
3297 as two separate insns. This case occurs when some SET allows two
3298 other insns to combine, but the destination of that SET is still live. */
3300 else if (i1 && insn_code_number < 0 && asm_noperands (newpat) < 0
3301 && GET_CODE (newpat) == PARALLEL
3302 && XVECLEN (newpat, 0) == 2
3303 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)) == SET
3304 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))) != ZERO_EXTRACT
3305 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))) != STRICT_LOW_PART
3306 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)) == SET
3307 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))) != ZERO_EXTRACT
3308 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))) != STRICT_LOW_PART
3309 && ! use_crosses_set_p (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3310 DF_INSN_LUID (i2))
3311 && ! reg_referenced_p (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)),
3312 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))
3313 && ! reg_referenced_p (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)),
3314 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))
3315 && ! (contains_muldiv (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)))
3316 && contains_muldiv (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1))))
3317 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
3318 /* We cannot split the parallel into two sets if both sets
3319 reference cc0. */
3320 && ! (reg_referenced_p (cc0_rtx, XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0))
3321 && reg_referenced_p (cc0_rtx, XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1)))
3322 #endif
3325 /* Normally, it doesn't matter which of the two is done first,
3326 but it does if one references cc0. In that case, it has to
3327 be first. */
3328 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
3329 if (reg_referenced_p (cc0_rtx, XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0)))
3331 newi2pat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0);
3332 newpat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1);
3334 else
3335 #endif
3337 newi2pat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 1);
3338 newpat = XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0);
3341 i2_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newi2pat, i2, &new_i2_notes);
3343 if (i2_code_number >= 0)
3344 insn_code_number = recog_for_combine (&newpat, i3, &new_i3_notes);
3347 /* If it still isn't recognized, fail and change things back the way they
3348 were. */
3349 if ((insn_code_number < 0
3350 /* Is the result a reasonable ASM_OPERANDS? */
3351 && (! check_asm_operands (newpat) || added_sets_1 || added_sets_2)))
3353 undo_all ();
3354 return 0;
3357 /* If we had to change another insn, make sure it is valid also. */
3358 if (undobuf.other_insn)
3360 CLEAR_HARD_REG_SET (newpat_used_regs);
3362 other_pat = PATTERN (undobuf.other_insn);
3363 other_code_number = recog_for_combine (&other_pat, undobuf.other_insn,
3364 &new_other_notes);
3366 if (other_code_number < 0 && ! check_asm_operands (other_pat))
3368 undo_all ();
3369 return 0;
3373 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
3374 /* If I2 is the CC0 setter and I3 is the CC0 user then check whether
3375 they are adjacent to each other or not. */
3377 rtx p = prev_nonnote_insn (i3);
3378 if (p && p != i2 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (p) && newi2pat
3379 && sets_cc0_p (newi2pat))
3381 undo_all ();
3382 return 0;
3385 #endif
3387 /* Only allow this combination if insn_rtx_costs reports that the
3388 replacement instructions are cheaper than the originals. */
3389 if (!combine_validate_cost (i1, i2, i3, newpat, newi2pat, other_pat))
3391 undo_all ();
3392 return 0;
3395 /* We now know that we can do this combination. Merge the insns and
3396 update the status of registers and LOG_LINKS. */
3398 if (undobuf.other_insn)
3400 rtx note, next;
3402 PATTERN (undobuf.other_insn) = other_pat;
3404 /* If any of the notes in OTHER_INSN were REG_UNUSED, ensure that they
3405 are still valid. Then add any non-duplicate notes added by
3406 recog_for_combine. */
3407 for (note = REG_NOTES (undobuf.other_insn); note; note = next)
3409 next = XEXP (note, 1);
3411 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_UNUSED
3412 && ! reg_set_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (undobuf.other_insn)))
3413 remove_note (undobuf.other_insn, note);
3416 distribute_notes (new_other_notes, undobuf.other_insn,
3417 undobuf.other_insn, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3420 if (swap_i2i3)
3422 rtx insn;
3423 rtx link;
3424 rtx ni2dest;
3426 /* I3 now uses what used to be its destination and which is now
3427 I2's destination. This requires us to do a few adjustments. */
3428 PATTERN (i3) = newpat;
3429 adjust_for_new_dest (i3);
3431 /* We need a LOG_LINK from I3 to I2. But we used to have one,
3432 so we still will.
3434 However, some later insn might be using I2's dest and have
3435 a LOG_LINK pointing at I3. We must remove this link.
3436 The simplest way to remove the link is to point it at I1,
3437 which we know will be a NOTE. */
3439 /* newi2pat is usually a SET here; however, recog_for_combine might
3440 have added some clobbers. */
3441 if (GET_CODE (newi2pat) == PARALLEL)
3442 ni2dest = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (newi2pat, 0, 0));
3443 else
3444 ni2dest = SET_DEST (newi2pat);
3446 for (insn = NEXT_INSN (i3);
3447 insn && (this_basic_block->next_bb == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
3448 || insn != BB_HEAD (this_basic_block->next_bb));
3449 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
3451 if (INSN_P (insn) && reg_referenced_p (ni2dest, PATTERN (insn)))
3453 for (link = LOG_LINKS (insn); link;
3454 link = XEXP (link, 1))
3455 if (XEXP (link, 0) == i3)
3456 XEXP (link, 0) = i1;
3458 break;
3464 rtx i3notes, i2notes, i1notes = 0;
3465 rtx i3links, i2links, i1links = 0;
3466 rtx midnotes = 0;
3467 unsigned int regno;
3468 /* Compute which registers we expect to eliminate. newi2pat may be setting
3469 either i3dest or i2dest, so we must check it. Also, i1dest may be the
3470 same as i3dest, in which case newi2pat may be setting i1dest. */
3471 rtx elim_i2 = ((newi2pat && reg_set_p (i2dest, newi2pat))
3472 || i2dest_in_i2src || i2dest_in_i1src
3473 || !i2dest_killed
3474 ? 0 : i2dest);
3475 rtx elim_i1 = (i1 == 0 || i1dest_in_i1src
3476 || (newi2pat && reg_set_p (i1dest, newi2pat))
3477 || !i1dest_killed
3478 ? 0 : i1dest);
3480 /* Get the old REG_NOTES and LOG_LINKS from all our insns and
3481 clear them. */
3482 i3notes = REG_NOTES (i3), i3links = LOG_LINKS (i3);
3483 i2notes = REG_NOTES (i2), i2links = LOG_LINKS (i2);
3484 if (i1)
3485 i1notes = REG_NOTES (i1), i1links = LOG_LINKS (i1);
3487 /* Ensure that we do not have something that should not be shared but
3488 occurs multiple times in the new insns. Check this by first
3489 resetting all the `used' flags and then copying anything is shared. */
3491 reset_used_flags (i3notes);
3492 reset_used_flags (i2notes);
3493 reset_used_flags (i1notes);
3494 reset_used_flags (newpat);
3495 reset_used_flags (newi2pat);
3496 if (undobuf.other_insn)
3497 reset_used_flags (PATTERN (undobuf.other_insn));
3499 i3notes = copy_rtx_if_shared (i3notes);
3500 i2notes = copy_rtx_if_shared (i2notes);
3501 i1notes = copy_rtx_if_shared (i1notes);
3502 newpat = copy_rtx_if_shared (newpat);
3503 newi2pat = copy_rtx_if_shared (newi2pat);
3504 if (undobuf.other_insn)
3505 reset_used_flags (PATTERN (undobuf.other_insn));
3507 INSN_CODE (i3) = insn_code_number;
3508 PATTERN (i3) = newpat;
3510 if (CALL_P (i3) && CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (i3))
3512 rtx call_usage = CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (i3);
3514 reset_used_flags (call_usage);
3515 call_usage = copy_rtx (call_usage);
3517 if (substed_i2)
3518 replace_rtx (call_usage, i2dest, i2src);
3520 if (substed_i1)
3521 replace_rtx (call_usage, i1dest, i1src);
3523 CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE (i3) = call_usage;
3526 if (undobuf.other_insn)
3527 INSN_CODE (undobuf.other_insn) = other_code_number;
3529 /* We had one special case above where I2 had more than one set and
3530 we replaced a destination of one of those sets with the destination
3531 of I3. In that case, we have to update LOG_LINKS of insns later
3532 in this basic block. Note that this (expensive) case is rare.
3534 Also, in this case, we must pretend that all REG_NOTEs for I2
3535 actually came from I3, so that REG_UNUSED notes from I2 will be
3536 properly handled. */
3538 if (i3_subst_into_i2)
3540 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (PATTERN (i2), 0); i++)
3541 if ((GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i)) == SET
3542 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i)) == CLOBBER)
3543 && REG_P (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i)))
3544 && SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i)) != i2dest
3545 && ! find_reg_note (i2, REG_UNUSED,
3546 SET_DEST (XVECEXP (PATTERN (i2), 0, i))))
3547 for (temp = NEXT_INSN (i2);
3548 temp && (this_basic_block->next_bb == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
3549 || BB_HEAD (this_basic_block) != temp);
3550 temp = NEXT_INSN (temp))
3551 if (temp != i3 && INSN_P (temp))
3552 for (link = LOG_LINKS (temp); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
3553 if (XEXP (link, 0) == i2)
3554 XEXP (link, 0) = i3;
3556 if (i3notes)
3558 rtx link = i3notes;
3559 while (XEXP (link, 1))
3560 link = XEXP (link, 1);
3561 XEXP (link, 1) = i2notes;
3563 else
3564 i3notes = i2notes;
3565 i2notes = 0;
3568 LOG_LINKS (i3) = 0;
3569 REG_NOTES (i3) = 0;
3570 LOG_LINKS (i2) = 0;
3571 REG_NOTES (i2) = 0;
3573 if (newi2pat)
3575 INSN_CODE (i2) = i2_code_number;
3576 PATTERN (i2) = newi2pat;
3578 else
3579 SET_INSN_DELETED (i2);
3581 if (i1)
3583 LOG_LINKS (i1) = 0;
3584 REG_NOTES (i1) = 0;
3585 SET_INSN_DELETED (i1);
3588 /* Get death notes for everything that is now used in either I3 or
3589 I2 and used to die in a previous insn. If we built two new
3590 patterns, move from I1 to I2 then I2 to I3 so that we get the
3591 proper movement on registers that I2 modifies. */
3593 if (newi2pat)
3595 move_deaths (newi2pat, NULL_RTX, DF_INSN_LUID (i1), i2, &midnotes);
3596 move_deaths (newpat, newi2pat, DF_INSN_LUID (i1), i3, &midnotes);
3598 else
3599 move_deaths (newpat, NULL_RTX, i1 ? DF_INSN_LUID (i1) : DF_INSN_LUID (i2),
3600 i3, &midnotes);
3602 /* Distribute all the LOG_LINKS and REG_NOTES from I1, I2, and I3. */
3603 if (i3notes)
3604 distribute_notes (i3notes, i3, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3605 elim_i2, elim_i1);
3606 if (i2notes)
3607 distribute_notes (i2notes, i2, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3608 elim_i2, elim_i1);
3609 if (i1notes)
3610 distribute_notes (i1notes, i1, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3611 elim_i2, elim_i1);
3612 if (midnotes)
3613 distribute_notes (midnotes, NULL_RTX, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3614 elim_i2, elim_i1);
3616 /* Distribute any notes added to I2 or I3 by recog_for_combine. We
3617 know these are REG_UNUSED and want them to go to the desired insn,
3618 so we always pass it as i3. */
3620 if (newi2pat && new_i2_notes)
3621 distribute_notes (new_i2_notes, i2, i2, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3623 if (new_i3_notes)
3624 distribute_notes (new_i3_notes, i3, i3, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3626 /* If I3DEST was used in I3SRC, it really died in I3. We may need to
3627 put a REG_DEAD note for it somewhere. If NEWI2PAT exists and sets
3628 I3DEST, the death must be somewhere before I2, not I3. If we passed I3
3629 in that case, it might delete I2. Similarly for I2 and I1.
3630 Show an additional death due to the REG_DEAD note we make here. If
3631 we discard it in distribute_notes, we will decrement it again. */
3633 if (i3dest_killed)
3635 if (newi2pat && reg_set_p (i3dest_killed, newi2pat))
3636 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i3dest_killed,
3637 NULL_RTX),
3638 NULL_RTX, i2, NULL_RTX, elim_i2, elim_i1);
3639 else
3640 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i3dest_killed,
3641 NULL_RTX),
3642 NULL_RTX, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3643 elim_i2, elim_i1);
3646 if (i2dest_in_i2src)
3648 if (newi2pat && reg_set_p (i2dest, newi2pat))
3649 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i2dest, NULL_RTX),
3650 NULL_RTX, i2, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3651 else
3652 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i2dest, NULL_RTX),
3653 NULL_RTX, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3654 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3657 if (i1dest_in_i1src)
3659 if (newi2pat && reg_set_p (i1dest, newi2pat))
3660 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i1dest, NULL_RTX),
3661 NULL_RTX, i2, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3662 else
3663 distribute_notes (gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, i1dest, NULL_RTX),
3664 NULL_RTX, i3, newi2pat ? i2 : NULL_RTX,
3665 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
3668 distribute_links (i3links);
3669 distribute_links (i2links);
3670 distribute_links (i1links);
3672 if (REG_P (i2dest))
3674 rtx link;
3675 rtx i2_insn = 0, i2_val = 0, set;
3677 /* The insn that used to set this register doesn't exist, and
3678 this life of the register may not exist either. See if one of
3679 I3's links points to an insn that sets I2DEST. If it does,
3680 that is now the last known value for I2DEST. If we don't update
3681 this and I2 set the register to a value that depended on its old
3682 contents, we will get confused. If this insn is used, thing
3683 will be set correctly in combine_instructions. */
3685 for (link = LOG_LINKS (i3); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
3686 if ((set = single_set (XEXP (link, 0))) != 0
3687 && rtx_equal_p (i2dest, SET_DEST (set)))
3688 i2_insn = XEXP (link, 0), i2_val = SET_SRC (set);
3690 record_value_for_reg (i2dest, i2_insn, i2_val);
3692 /* If the reg formerly set in I2 died only once and that was in I3,
3693 zero its use count so it won't make `reload' do any work. */
3694 if (! added_sets_2
3695 && (newi2pat == 0 || ! reg_mentioned_p (i2dest, newi2pat))
3696 && ! i2dest_in_i2src)
3698 regno = REGNO (i2dest);
3699 INC_REG_N_SETS (regno, -1);
3703 if (i1 && REG_P (i1dest))
3705 rtx link;
3706 rtx i1_insn = 0, i1_val = 0, set;
3708 for (link = LOG_LINKS (i3); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
3709 if ((set = single_set (XEXP (link, 0))) != 0
3710 && rtx_equal_p (i1dest, SET_DEST (set)))
3711 i1_insn = XEXP (link, 0), i1_val = SET_SRC (set);
3713 record_value_for_reg (i1dest, i1_insn, i1_val);
3715 regno = REGNO (i1dest);
3716 if (! added_sets_1 && ! i1dest_in_i1src)
3717 INC_REG_N_SETS (regno, -1);
3720 /* Update reg_stat[].nonzero_bits et al for any changes that may have
3721 been made to this insn. The order of
3722 set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies() is important. Because newi2pat
3723 can affect nonzero_bits of newpat */
3724 if (newi2pat)
3725 note_stores (newi2pat, set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies, NULL);
3726 note_stores (newpat, set_nonzero_bits_and_sign_copies, NULL);
3728 /* Set new_direct_jump_p if a new return or simple jump instruction
3729 has been created.
3731 If I3 is now an unconditional jump, ensure that it has a
3732 BARRIER following it since it may have initially been a
3733 conditional jump. It may also be the last nonnote insn. */
3735 if (returnjump_p (i3) || any_uncondjump_p (i3))
3737 *new_direct_jump_p = 1;
3738 mark_jump_label (PATTERN (i3), i3, 0);
3740 if ((temp = next_nonnote_insn (i3)) == NULL_RTX
3741 || !BARRIER_P (temp))
3742 emit_barrier_after (i3);
3745 if (undobuf.other_insn != NULL_RTX
3746 && (returnjump_p (undobuf.other_insn)
3747 || any_uncondjump_p (undobuf.other_insn)))
3749 *new_direct_jump_p = 1;
3751 if ((temp = next_nonnote_insn (undobuf.other_insn)) == NULL_RTX
3752 || !BARRIER_P (temp))
3753 emit_barrier_after (undobuf.other_insn);
3756 /* An NOOP jump does not need barrier, but it does need cleaning up
3757 of CFG. */
3758 if (GET_CODE (newpat) == SET
3759 && SET_SRC (newpat) == pc_rtx
3760 && SET_DEST (newpat) == pc_rtx)
3761 *new_direct_jump_p = 1;
3764 if (undobuf.other_insn != NULL_RTX)
3766 if (dump_file)
3768 fprintf (dump_file, "modifying other_insn ");
3769 dump_insn_slim (dump_file, undobuf.other_insn);
3771 df_insn_rescan (undobuf.other_insn);
3774 if (i1 && !(NOTE_P(i1) && (NOTE_KIND (i1) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED)))
3776 if (dump_file)
3778 fprintf (dump_file, "modifying insn i1 ");
3779 dump_insn_slim (dump_file, i1);
3781 df_insn_rescan (i1);
3784 if (i2 && !(NOTE_P(i2) && (NOTE_KIND (i2) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED)))
3786 if (dump_file)
3788 fprintf (dump_file, "modifying insn i2 ");
3789 dump_insn_slim (dump_file, i2);
3791 df_insn_rescan (i2);
3794 if (i3 && !(NOTE_P(i3) && (NOTE_KIND (i3) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED)))
3796 if (dump_file)
3798 fprintf (dump_file, "modifying insn i3 ");
3799 dump_insn_slim (dump_file, i3);
3801 df_insn_rescan (i3);
3804 combine_successes++;
3805 undo_commit ();
3807 if (added_links_insn
3808 && (newi2pat == 0 || DF_INSN_LUID (added_links_insn) < DF_INSN_LUID (i2))
3809 && DF_INSN_LUID (added_links_insn) < DF_INSN_LUID (i3))
3810 return added_links_insn;
3811 else
3812 return newi2pat ? i2 : i3;
3815 /* Undo all the modifications recorded in undobuf. */
3817 static void
3818 undo_all (void)
3820 struct undo *undo, *next;
3822 for (undo = undobuf.undos; undo; undo = next)
3824 next = undo->next;
3825 switch (undo->kind)
3827 case UNDO_RTX:
3828 *undo->where.r = undo->old_contents.r;
3829 break;
3830 case UNDO_INT:
3831 *undo->where.i = undo->old_contents.i;
3832 break;
3833 case UNDO_MODE:
3834 adjust_reg_mode (*undo->where.r, undo->old_contents.m);
3835 break;
3836 default:
3837 gcc_unreachable ();
3840 undo->next = undobuf.frees;
3841 undobuf.frees = undo;
3844 undobuf.undos = 0;
3847 /* We've committed to accepting the changes we made. Move all
3848 of the undos to the free list. */
3850 static void
3851 undo_commit (void)
3853 struct undo *undo, *next;
3855 for (undo = undobuf.undos; undo; undo = next)
3857 next = undo->next;
3858 undo->next = undobuf.frees;
3859 undobuf.frees = undo;
3861 undobuf.undos = 0;
3864 /* Find the innermost point within the rtx at LOC, possibly LOC itself,
3865 where we have an arithmetic expression and return that point. LOC will
3866 be inside INSN.
3868 try_combine will call this function to see if an insn can be split into
3869 two insns. */
3871 static rtx *
3872 find_split_point (rtx *loc, rtx insn)
3874 rtx x = *loc;
3875 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
3876 rtx *split;
3877 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len = 0;
3878 HOST_WIDE_INT pos = 0;
3879 int unsignedp = 0;
3880 rtx inner = NULL_RTX;
3882 /* First special-case some codes. */
3883 switch (code)
3885 case SUBREG:
3886 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
3887 /* If we are making a paradoxical SUBREG invalid, it becomes a split
3888 point. */
3889 if (MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (x)))
3890 return loc;
3891 #endif
3892 return find_split_point (&SUBREG_REG (x), insn);
3894 case MEM:
3895 #ifdef HAVE_lo_sum
3896 /* If we have (mem (const ..)) or (mem (symbol_ref ...)), split it
3897 using LO_SUM and HIGH. */
3898 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST
3899 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
3901 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0),
3902 gen_rtx_LO_SUM (Pmode,
3903 gen_rtx_HIGH (Pmode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3904 XEXP (x, 0)));
3905 return &XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
3907 #endif
3909 /* If we have a PLUS whose second operand is a constant and the
3910 address is not valid, perhaps will can split it up using
3911 the machine-specific way to split large constants. We use
3912 the first pseudo-reg (one of the virtual regs) as a placeholder;
3913 it will not remain in the result. */
3914 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
3915 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
3916 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0)))
3918 rtx reg = regno_reg_rtx[FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER];
3919 rtx seq = combine_split_insns (gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, reg,
3920 XEXP (x, 0)),
3921 subst_insn);
3923 /* This should have produced two insns, each of which sets our
3924 placeholder. If the source of the second is a valid address,
3925 we can make put both sources together and make a split point
3926 in the middle. */
3928 if (seq
3929 && NEXT_INSN (seq) != NULL_RTX
3930 && NEXT_INSN (NEXT_INSN (seq)) == NULL_RTX
3931 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (seq)
3932 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (seq)) == SET
3933 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (seq)) == reg
3934 && ! reg_mentioned_p (reg,
3935 SET_SRC (PATTERN (seq)))
3936 && NONJUMP_INSN_P (NEXT_INSN (seq))
3937 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (seq))) == SET
3938 && SET_DEST (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (seq))) == reg
3939 && memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x),
3940 SET_SRC (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (seq)))))
3942 rtx src1 = SET_SRC (PATTERN (seq));
3943 rtx src2 = SET_SRC (PATTERN (NEXT_INSN (seq)));
3945 /* Replace the placeholder in SRC2 with SRC1. If we can
3946 find where in SRC2 it was placed, that can become our
3947 split point and we can replace this address with SRC2.
3948 Just try two obvious places. */
3950 src2 = replace_rtx (src2, reg, src1);
3951 split = 0;
3952 if (XEXP (src2, 0) == src1)
3953 split = &XEXP (src2, 0);
3954 else if (GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (XEXP (src2, 0)))[0] == 'e'
3955 && XEXP (XEXP (src2, 0), 0) == src1)
3956 split = &XEXP (XEXP (src2, 0), 0);
3958 if (split)
3960 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), src2);
3961 return split;
3965 /* If that didn't work, perhaps the first operand is complex and
3966 needs to be computed separately, so make a split point there.
3967 This will occur on machines that just support REG + CONST
3968 and have a constant moved through some previous computation. */
3970 else if (!OBJECT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
3971 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
3972 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))))
3973 return &XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
3976 /* If we have a PLUS whose first operand is complex, try computing it
3977 separately by making a split there. */
3978 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
3979 && ! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
3980 && ! OBJECT_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
3981 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
3982 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)))))
3983 return &XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
3984 break;
3986 case SET:
3987 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
3988 /* If SET_DEST is CC0 and SET_SRC is not an operand, a COMPARE, or a
3989 ZERO_EXTRACT, the most likely reason why this doesn't match is that
3990 we need to put the operand into a register. So split at that
3991 point. */
3993 if (SET_DEST (x) == cc0_rtx
3994 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != COMPARE
3995 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) != ZERO_EXTRACT
3996 && !OBJECT_P (SET_SRC (x))
3997 && ! (GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == SUBREG
3998 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (SET_SRC (x)))))
3999 return &SET_SRC (x);
4000 #endif
4002 /* See if we can split SET_SRC as it stands. */
4003 split = find_split_point (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
4004 if (split && split != &SET_SRC (x))
4005 return split;
4007 /* See if we can split SET_DEST as it stands. */
4008 split = find_split_point (&SET_DEST (x), insn);
4009 if (split && split != &SET_DEST (x))
4010 return split;
4012 /* See if this is a bitfield assignment with everything constant. If
4013 so, this is an IOR of an AND, so split it into that. */
4014 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
4015 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)))
4016 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
4017 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 1)) == CONST_INT
4018 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 2)) == CONST_INT
4019 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x)) == CONST_INT
4020 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 1))
4021 + INTVAL (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 2)))
4022 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0))))
4023 && ! side_effects_p (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)))
4025 HOST_WIDE_INT pos = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 2));
4026 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 1));
4027 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT src = INTVAL (SET_SRC (x));
4028 rtx dest = XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0);
4029 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (dest);
4030 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1;
4031 rtx or_mask;
4033 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4034 pos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - len - pos;
4036 or_mask = gen_int_mode (src << pos, mode);
4037 if (src == mask)
4038 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
4039 simplify_gen_binary (IOR, mode, dest, or_mask));
4040 else
4042 rtx negmask = gen_int_mode (~(mask << pos), mode);
4043 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
4044 simplify_gen_binary (IOR, mode,
4045 simplify_gen_binary (AND, mode,
4046 dest, negmask),
4047 or_mask));
4050 SUBST (SET_DEST (x), dest);
4052 split = find_split_point (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
4053 if (split && split != &SET_SRC (x))
4054 return split;
4057 /* Otherwise, see if this is an operation that we can split into two.
4058 If so, try to split that. */
4059 code = GET_CODE (SET_SRC (x));
4061 switch (code)
4063 case AND:
4064 /* If we are AND'ing with a large constant that is only a single
4065 bit and the result is only being used in a context where we
4066 need to know if it is zero or nonzero, replace it with a bit
4067 extraction. This will avoid the large constant, which might
4068 have taken more than one insn to make. If the constant were
4069 not a valid argument to the AND but took only one insn to make,
4070 this is no worse, but if it took more than one insn, it will
4071 be better. */
4073 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) == CONST_INT
4074 && REG_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))
4075 && (pos = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)))) >= 7
4076 && REG_P (SET_DEST (x))
4077 && (split = find_single_use (SET_DEST (x), insn, (rtx*) 0)) != 0
4078 && (GET_CODE (*split) == EQ || GET_CODE (*split) == NE)
4079 && XEXP (*split, 0) == SET_DEST (x)
4080 && XEXP (*split, 1) == const0_rtx)
4082 rtx extraction = make_extraction (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)),
4083 XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0),
4084 pos, NULL_RTX, 1, 1, 0, 0);
4085 if (extraction != 0)
4087 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), extraction);
4088 return find_split_point (loc, insn);
4091 break;
4093 case NE:
4094 /* If STORE_FLAG_VALUE is -1, this is (NE X 0) and only one bit of X
4095 is known to be on, this can be converted into a NEG of a shift. */
4096 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1 && XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1) == const0_rtx
4097 && GET_MODE (SET_SRC (x)) == GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))
4098 && 1 <= (pos = exact_log2
4099 (nonzero_bits (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0),
4100 GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))))))
4102 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0));
4104 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
4105 gen_rtx_NEG (mode,
4106 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode,
4107 XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0),
4108 GEN_INT (pos))));
4110 split = find_split_point (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
4111 if (split && split != &SET_SRC (x))
4112 return split;
4114 break;
4116 case SIGN_EXTEND:
4117 inner = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0);
4119 /* We can't optimize if either mode is a partial integer
4120 mode as we don't know how many bits are significant
4121 in those modes. */
4122 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (inner)) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT
4123 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SET_SRC (x))) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
4124 break;
4126 pos = 0;
4127 len = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner));
4128 unsignedp = 0;
4129 break;
4131 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
4132 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
4133 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1)) == CONST_INT
4134 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2)) == CONST_INT)
4136 inner = XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0);
4137 len = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1));
4138 pos = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 2));
4140 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4141 pos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) - len - pos;
4142 unsignedp = (code == ZERO_EXTRACT);
4144 break;
4146 default:
4147 break;
4150 if (len && pos >= 0 && pos + len <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
4152 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (SET_SRC (x));
4154 /* For unsigned, we have a choice of a shift followed by an
4155 AND or two shifts. Use two shifts for field sizes where the
4156 constant might be too large. We assume here that we can
4157 always at least get 8-bit constants in an AND insn, which is
4158 true for every current RISC. */
4160 if (unsignedp && len <= 8)
4162 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
4163 gen_rtx_AND (mode,
4164 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT
4165 (mode, gen_lowpart (mode, inner),
4166 GEN_INT (pos)),
4167 GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1)));
4169 split = find_split_point (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
4170 if (split && split != &SET_SRC (x))
4171 return split;
4173 else
4175 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
4176 gen_rtx_fmt_ee
4177 (unsignedp ? LSHIFTRT : ASHIFTRT, mode,
4178 gen_rtx_ASHIFT (mode,
4179 gen_lowpart (mode, inner),
4180 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
4181 - len - pos)),
4182 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - len)));
4184 split = find_split_point (&SET_SRC (x), insn);
4185 if (split && split != &SET_SRC (x))
4186 return split;
4190 /* See if this is a simple operation with a constant as the second
4191 operand. It might be that this constant is out of range and hence
4192 could be used as a split point. */
4193 if (BINARY_P (SET_SRC (x))
4194 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1))
4195 && (OBJECT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))
4196 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0)) == SUBREG
4197 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0))))))
4198 return &XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 1);
4200 /* Finally, see if this is a simple operation with its first operand
4201 not in a register. The operation might require this operand in a
4202 register, so return it as a split point. We can always do this
4203 because if the first operand were another operation, we would have
4204 already found it as a split point. */
4205 if ((BINARY_P (SET_SRC (x)) || UNARY_P (SET_SRC (x)))
4206 && ! register_operand (XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0), VOIDmode))
4207 return &XEXP (SET_SRC (x), 0);
4209 return 0;
4211 case AND:
4212 case IOR:
4213 /* We write NOR as (and (not A) (not B)), but if we don't have a NOR,
4214 it is better to write this as (not (ior A B)) so we can split it.
4215 Similarly for IOR. */
4216 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == NOT && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == NOT)
4218 SUBST (*loc,
4219 gen_rtx_NOT (GET_MODE (x),
4220 gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code == IOR ? AND : IOR,
4221 GET_MODE (x),
4222 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0),
4223 XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0))));
4224 return find_split_point (loc, insn);
4227 /* Many RISC machines have a large set of logical insns. If the
4228 second operand is a NOT, put it first so we will try to split the
4229 other operand first. */
4230 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == NOT)
4232 rtx tem = XEXP (x, 0);
4233 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
4234 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), tem);
4236 break;
4238 default:
4239 break;
4242 /* Otherwise, select our actions depending on our rtx class. */
4243 switch (GET_RTX_CLASS (code))
4245 case RTX_BITFIELD_OPS: /* This is ZERO_EXTRACT and SIGN_EXTRACT. */
4246 case RTX_TERNARY:
4247 split = find_split_point (&XEXP (x, 2), insn);
4248 if (split)
4249 return split;
4250 /* ... fall through ... */
4251 case RTX_BIN_ARITH:
4252 case RTX_COMM_ARITH:
4253 case RTX_COMPARE:
4254 case RTX_COMM_COMPARE:
4255 split = find_split_point (&XEXP (x, 1), insn);
4256 if (split)
4257 return split;
4258 /* ... fall through ... */
4259 case RTX_UNARY:
4260 /* Some machines have (and (shift ...) ...) insns. If X is not
4261 an AND, but XEXP (X, 0) is, use it as our split point. */
4262 if (GET_CODE (x) != AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == AND)
4263 return &XEXP (x, 0);
4265 split = find_split_point (&XEXP (x, 0), insn);
4266 if (split)
4267 return split;
4268 return loc;
4270 default:
4271 /* Otherwise, we don't have a split point. */
4272 return 0;
4276 /* Throughout X, replace FROM with TO, and return the result.
4277 The result is TO if X is FROM;
4278 otherwise the result is X, but its contents may have been modified.
4279 If they were modified, a record was made in undobuf so that
4280 undo_all will (among other things) return X to its original state.
4282 If the number of changes necessary is too much to record to undo,
4283 the excess changes are not made, so the result is invalid.
4284 The changes already made can still be undone.
4285 undobuf.num_undo is incremented for such changes, so by testing that
4286 the caller can tell whether the result is valid.
4288 `n_occurrences' is incremented each time FROM is replaced.
4290 IN_DEST is nonzero if we are processing the SET_DEST of a SET.
4292 UNIQUE_COPY is nonzero if each substitution must be unique. We do this
4293 by copying if `n_occurrences' is nonzero. */
4295 static rtx
4296 subst (rtx x, rtx from, rtx to, int in_dest, int unique_copy)
4298 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
4299 enum machine_mode op0_mode = VOIDmode;
4300 const char *fmt;
4301 int len, i;
4302 rtx new;
4304 /* Two expressions are equal if they are identical copies of a shared
4305 RTX or if they are both registers with the same register number
4306 and mode. */
4308 #define COMBINE_RTX_EQUAL_P(X,Y) \
4309 ((X) == (Y) \
4310 || (REG_P (X) && REG_P (Y) \
4311 && REGNO (X) == REGNO (Y) && GET_MODE (X) == GET_MODE (Y)))
4313 if (! in_dest && COMBINE_RTX_EQUAL_P (x, from))
4315 n_occurrences++;
4316 return (unique_copy && n_occurrences > 1 ? copy_rtx (to) : to);
4319 /* If X and FROM are the same register but different modes, they
4320 will not have been seen as equal above. However, the log links code
4321 will make a LOG_LINKS entry for that case. If we do nothing, we
4322 will try to rerecognize our original insn and, when it succeeds,
4323 we will delete the feeding insn, which is incorrect.
4325 So force this insn not to match in this (rare) case. */
4326 if (! in_dest && code == REG && REG_P (from)
4327 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, from))
4328 return gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (x), const0_rtx);
4330 /* If this is an object, we are done unless it is a MEM or LO_SUM, both
4331 of which may contain things that can be combined. */
4332 if (code != MEM && code != LO_SUM && OBJECT_P (x))
4333 return x;
4335 /* It is possible to have a subexpression appear twice in the insn.
4336 Suppose that FROM is a register that appears within TO.
4337 Then, after that subexpression has been scanned once by `subst',
4338 the second time it is scanned, TO may be found. If we were
4339 to scan TO here, we would find FROM within it and create a
4340 self-referent rtl structure which is completely wrong. */
4341 if (COMBINE_RTX_EQUAL_P (x, to))
4342 return to;
4344 /* Parallel asm_operands need special attention because all of the
4345 inputs are shared across the arms. Furthermore, unsharing the
4346 rtl results in recognition failures. Failure to handle this case
4347 specially can result in circular rtl.
4349 Solve this by doing a normal pass across the first entry of the
4350 parallel, and only processing the SET_DESTs of the subsequent
4351 entries. Ug. */
4353 if (code == PARALLEL
4354 && GET_CODE (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0)) == SET
4355 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0))) == ASM_OPERANDS)
4357 new = subst (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0), from, to, 0, unique_copy);
4359 /* If this substitution failed, this whole thing fails. */
4360 if (GET_CODE (new) == CLOBBER
4361 && XEXP (new, 0) == const0_rtx)
4362 return new;
4364 SUBST (XVECEXP (x, 0, 0), new);
4366 for (i = XVECLEN (x, 0) - 1; i >= 1; i--)
4368 rtx dest = SET_DEST (XVECEXP (x, 0, i));
4370 if (!REG_P (dest)
4371 && GET_CODE (dest) != CC0
4372 && GET_CODE (dest) != PC)
4374 new = subst (dest, from, to, 0, unique_copy);
4376 /* If this substitution failed, this whole thing fails. */
4377 if (GET_CODE (new) == CLOBBER
4378 && XEXP (new, 0) == const0_rtx)
4379 return new;
4381 SUBST (SET_DEST (XVECEXP (x, 0, i)), new);
4385 else
4387 len = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code);
4388 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
4390 /* We don't need to process a SET_DEST that is a register, CC0,
4391 or PC, so set up to skip this common case. All other cases
4392 where we want to suppress replacing something inside a
4393 SET_SRC are handled via the IN_DEST operand. */
4394 if (code == SET
4395 && (REG_P (SET_DEST (x))
4396 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == CC0
4397 || GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == PC))
4398 fmt = "ie";
4400 /* Get the mode of operand 0 in case X is now a SIGN_EXTEND of a
4401 constant. */
4402 if (fmt[0] == 'e')
4403 op0_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4405 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
4407 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
4409 int j;
4410 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
4412 if (COMBINE_RTX_EQUAL_P (XVECEXP (x, i, j), from))
4414 new = (unique_copy && n_occurrences
4415 ? copy_rtx (to) : to);
4416 n_occurrences++;
4418 else
4420 new = subst (XVECEXP (x, i, j), from, to, 0,
4421 unique_copy);
4423 /* If this substitution failed, this whole thing
4424 fails. */
4425 if (GET_CODE (new) == CLOBBER
4426 && XEXP (new, 0) == const0_rtx)
4427 return new;
4430 SUBST (XVECEXP (x, i, j), new);
4433 else if (fmt[i] == 'e')
4435 /* If this is a register being set, ignore it. */
4436 new = XEXP (x, i);
4437 if (in_dest
4438 && i == 0
4439 && (((code == SUBREG || code == ZERO_EXTRACT)
4440 && REG_P (new))
4441 || code == STRICT_LOW_PART))
4444 else if (COMBINE_RTX_EQUAL_P (XEXP (x, i), from))
4446 /* In general, don't install a subreg involving two
4447 modes not tieable. It can worsen register
4448 allocation, and can even make invalid reload
4449 insns, since the reg inside may need to be copied
4450 from in the outside mode, and that may be invalid
4451 if it is an fp reg copied in integer mode.
4453 We allow two exceptions to this: It is valid if
4454 it is inside another SUBREG and the mode of that
4455 SUBREG and the mode of the inside of TO is
4456 tieable and it is valid if X is a SET that copies
4457 FROM to CC0. */
4459 if (GET_CODE (to) == SUBREG
4460 && ! MODES_TIEABLE_P (GET_MODE (to),
4461 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (to)))
4462 && ! (code == SUBREG
4463 && MODES_TIEABLE_P (GET_MODE (x),
4464 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (to))))
4465 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
4466 && ! (code == SET && i == 1 && XEXP (x, 0) == cc0_rtx)
4467 #endif
4469 return gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, const0_rtx);
4471 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
4472 if (code == SUBREG
4473 && REG_P (to)
4474 && REGNO (to) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4475 && REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (to),
4476 GET_MODE (to),
4477 GET_MODE (x)))
4478 return gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, const0_rtx);
4479 #endif
4481 new = (unique_copy && n_occurrences ? copy_rtx (to) : to);
4482 n_occurrences++;
4484 else
4485 /* If we are in a SET_DEST, suppress most cases unless we
4486 have gone inside a MEM, in which case we want to
4487 simplify the address. We assume here that things that
4488 are actually part of the destination have their inner
4489 parts in the first expression. This is true for SUBREG,
4490 STRICT_LOW_PART, and ZERO_EXTRACT, which are the only
4491 things aside from REG and MEM that should appear in a
4492 SET_DEST. */
4493 new = subst (XEXP (x, i), from, to,
4494 (((in_dest
4495 && (code == SUBREG || code == STRICT_LOW_PART
4496 || code == ZERO_EXTRACT))
4497 || code == SET)
4498 && i == 0), unique_copy);
4500 /* If we found that we will have to reject this combination,
4501 indicate that by returning the CLOBBER ourselves, rather than
4502 an expression containing it. This will speed things up as
4503 well as prevent accidents where two CLOBBERs are considered
4504 to be equal, thus producing an incorrect simplification. */
4506 if (GET_CODE (new) == CLOBBER && XEXP (new, 0) == const0_rtx)
4507 return new;
4509 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
4510 && (GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT
4511 || GET_CODE (new) == CONST_DOUBLE))
4513 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4515 x = simplify_subreg (GET_MODE (x), new,
4516 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)),
4517 SUBREG_BYTE (x));
4518 if (! x)
4519 x = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (mode, const0_rtx);
4521 else if (GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT
4522 && GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTEND)
4524 x = simplify_unary_operation (ZERO_EXTEND, GET_MODE (x),
4525 new, GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)));
4526 gcc_assert (x);
4528 else
4529 SUBST (XEXP (x, i), new);
4534 /* Check if we are loading something from the constant pool via float
4535 extension; in this case we would undo compress_float_constant
4536 optimization and degenerate constant load to an immediate value. */
4537 if (GET_CODE (x) == FLOAT_EXTEND
4538 && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4539 && MEM_READONLY_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
4541 rtx tmp = avoid_constant_pool_reference (x);
4542 if (x != tmp)
4543 return x;
4546 /* Try to simplify X. If the simplification changed the code, it is likely
4547 that further simplification will help, so loop, but limit the number
4548 of repetitions that will be performed. */
4550 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
4552 /* If X is sufficiently simple, don't bother trying to do anything
4553 with it. */
4554 if (code != CONST_INT && code != REG && code != CLOBBER)
4555 x = combine_simplify_rtx (x, op0_mode, in_dest);
4557 if (GET_CODE (x) == code)
4558 break;
4560 code = GET_CODE (x);
4562 /* We no longer know the original mode of operand 0 since we
4563 have changed the form of X) */
4564 op0_mode = VOIDmode;
4567 return x;
4570 /* Simplify X, a piece of RTL. We just operate on the expression at the
4571 outer level; call `subst' to simplify recursively. Return the new
4572 expression.
4574 OP0_MODE is the original mode of XEXP (x, 0). IN_DEST is nonzero
4575 if we are inside a SET_DEST. */
4577 static rtx
4578 combine_simplify_rtx (rtx x, enum machine_mode op0_mode, int in_dest)
4580 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
4581 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
4582 rtx temp;
4583 int i;
4585 /* If this is a commutative operation, put a constant last and a complex
4586 expression first. We don't need to do this for comparisons here. */
4587 if (COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (x)
4588 && swap_commutative_operands_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1)))
4590 temp = XEXP (x, 0);
4591 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
4592 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), temp);
4595 /* If this is a simple operation applied to an IF_THEN_ELSE, try
4596 applying it to the arms of the IF_THEN_ELSE. This often simplifies
4597 things. Check for cases where both arms are testing the same
4598 condition.
4600 Don't do anything if all operands are very simple. */
4602 if ((BINARY_P (x)
4603 && ((!OBJECT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4604 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
4605 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)))))
4606 || (!OBJECT_P (XEXP (x, 1))
4607 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == SUBREG
4608 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 1)))))))
4609 || (UNARY_P (x)
4610 && (!OBJECT_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4611 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
4612 && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)))))))
4614 rtx cond, true_rtx, false_rtx;
4616 cond = if_then_else_cond (x, &true_rtx, &false_rtx);
4617 if (cond != 0
4618 /* If everything is a comparison, what we have is highly unlikely
4619 to be simpler, so don't use it. */
4620 && ! (COMPARISON_P (x)
4621 && (COMPARISON_P (true_rtx) || COMPARISON_P (false_rtx))))
4623 rtx cop1 = const0_rtx;
4624 enum rtx_code cond_code = simplify_comparison (NE, &cond, &cop1);
4626 if (cond_code == NE && COMPARISON_P (cond))
4627 return x;
4629 /* Simplify the alternative arms; this may collapse the true and
4630 false arms to store-flag values. Be careful to use copy_rtx
4631 here since true_rtx or false_rtx might share RTL with x as a
4632 result of the if_then_else_cond call above. */
4633 true_rtx = subst (copy_rtx (true_rtx), pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
4634 false_rtx = subst (copy_rtx (false_rtx), pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
4636 /* If true_rtx and false_rtx are not general_operands, an if_then_else
4637 is unlikely to be simpler. */
4638 if (general_operand (true_rtx, VOIDmode)
4639 && general_operand (false_rtx, VOIDmode))
4641 enum rtx_code reversed;
4643 /* Restarting if we generate a store-flag expression will cause
4644 us to loop. Just drop through in this case. */
4646 /* If the result values are STORE_FLAG_VALUE and zero, we can
4647 just make the comparison operation. */
4648 if (true_rtx == const_true_rtx && false_rtx == const0_rtx)
4649 x = simplify_gen_relational (cond_code, mode, VOIDmode,
4650 cond, cop1);
4651 else if (true_rtx == const0_rtx && false_rtx == const_true_rtx
4652 && ((reversed = reversed_comparison_code_parts
4653 (cond_code, cond, cop1, NULL))
4654 != UNKNOWN))
4655 x = simplify_gen_relational (reversed, mode, VOIDmode,
4656 cond, cop1);
4658 /* Likewise, we can make the negate of a comparison operation
4659 if the result values are - STORE_FLAG_VALUE and zero. */
4660 else if (GET_CODE (true_rtx) == CONST_INT
4661 && INTVAL (true_rtx) == - STORE_FLAG_VALUE
4662 && false_rtx == const0_rtx)
4663 x = simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
4664 simplify_gen_relational (cond_code,
4665 mode, VOIDmode,
4666 cond, cop1),
4667 mode);
4668 else if (GET_CODE (false_rtx) == CONST_INT
4669 && INTVAL (false_rtx) == - STORE_FLAG_VALUE
4670 && true_rtx == const0_rtx
4671 && ((reversed = reversed_comparison_code_parts
4672 (cond_code, cond, cop1, NULL))
4673 != UNKNOWN))
4674 x = simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
4675 simplify_gen_relational (reversed,
4676 mode, VOIDmode,
4677 cond, cop1),
4678 mode);
4679 else
4680 return gen_rtx_IF_THEN_ELSE (mode,
4681 simplify_gen_relational (cond_code,
4682 mode,
4683 VOIDmode,
4684 cond,
4685 cop1),
4686 true_rtx, false_rtx);
4688 code = GET_CODE (x);
4689 op0_mode = VOIDmode;
4694 /* Try to fold this expression in case we have constants that weren't
4695 present before. */
4696 temp = 0;
4697 switch (GET_RTX_CLASS (code))
4699 case RTX_UNARY:
4700 if (op0_mode == VOIDmode)
4701 op0_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4702 temp = simplify_unary_operation (code, mode, XEXP (x, 0), op0_mode);
4703 break;
4704 case RTX_COMPARE:
4705 case RTX_COMM_COMPARE:
4707 enum machine_mode cmp_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0));
4708 if (cmp_mode == VOIDmode)
4710 cmp_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 1));
4711 if (cmp_mode == VOIDmode)
4712 cmp_mode = op0_mode;
4714 temp = simplify_relational_operation (code, mode, cmp_mode,
4715 XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
4717 break;
4718 case RTX_COMM_ARITH:
4719 case RTX_BIN_ARITH:
4720 temp = simplify_binary_operation (code, mode, XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
4721 break;
4722 case RTX_BITFIELD_OPS:
4723 case RTX_TERNARY:
4724 temp = simplify_ternary_operation (code, mode, op0_mode, XEXP (x, 0),
4725 XEXP (x, 1), XEXP (x, 2));
4726 break;
4727 default:
4728 break;
4731 if (temp)
4733 x = temp;
4734 code = GET_CODE (temp);
4735 op0_mode = VOIDmode;
4736 mode = GET_MODE (temp);
4739 /* First see if we can apply the inverse distributive law. */
4740 if (code == PLUS || code == MINUS
4741 || code == AND || code == IOR || code == XOR)
4743 x = apply_distributive_law (x);
4744 code = GET_CODE (x);
4745 op0_mode = VOIDmode;
4748 /* If CODE is an associative operation not otherwise handled, see if we
4749 can associate some operands. This can win if they are constants or
4750 if they are logically related (i.e. (a & b) & a). */
4751 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS || code == MULT || code == DIV
4752 || code == AND || code == IOR || code == XOR
4753 || code == SMAX || code == SMIN || code == UMAX || code == UMIN)
4754 && ((INTEGRAL_MODE_P (mode) && code != DIV)
4755 || (flag_associative_math && FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))))
4757 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == code)
4759 rtx other = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
4760 rtx inner_op0 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
4761 rtx inner_op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
4762 rtx inner;
4764 /* Make sure we pass the constant operand if any as the second
4765 one if this is a commutative operation. */
4766 if (CONSTANT_P (inner_op0) && COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (x))
4768 rtx tem = inner_op0;
4769 inner_op0 = inner_op1;
4770 inner_op1 = tem;
4772 inner = simplify_binary_operation (code == MINUS ? PLUS
4773 : code == DIV ? MULT
4774 : code,
4775 mode, inner_op0, inner_op1);
4777 /* For commutative operations, try the other pair if that one
4778 didn't simplify. */
4779 if (inner == 0 && COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (x))
4781 other = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
4782 inner = simplify_binary_operation (code, mode,
4783 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0),
4784 XEXP (x, 1));
4787 if (inner)
4788 return simplify_gen_binary (code, mode, other, inner);
4792 /* A little bit of algebraic simplification here. */
4793 switch (code)
4795 case MEM:
4796 /* Ensure that our address has any ASHIFTs converted to MULT in case
4797 address-recognizing predicates are called later. */
4798 temp = make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0), MEM);
4799 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), temp);
4800 break;
4802 case SUBREG:
4803 if (op0_mode == VOIDmode)
4804 op0_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x));
4806 /* See if this can be moved to simplify_subreg. */
4807 if (CONSTANT_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4808 && subreg_lowpart_offset (mode, op0_mode) == SUBREG_BYTE (x)
4809 /* Don't call gen_lowpart if the inner mode
4810 is VOIDmode and we cannot simplify it, as SUBREG without
4811 inner mode is invalid. */
4812 && (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)) != VOIDmode
4813 || gen_lowpart_common (mode, SUBREG_REG (x))))
4814 return gen_lowpart (mode, SUBREG_REG (x));
4816 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) == MODE_CC)
4817 break;
4819 rtx temp;
4820 temp = simplify_subreg (mode, SUBREG_REG (x), op0_mode,
4821 SUBREG_BYTE (x));
4822 if (temp)
4823 return temp;
4826 /* Don't change the mode of the MEM if that would change the meaning
4827 of the address. */
4828 if (MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4829 && (MEM_VOLATILE_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
4830 || mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (x), 0))))
4831 return gen_rtx_CLOBBER (mode, const0_rtx);
4833 /* Note that we cannot do any narrowing for non-constants since
4834 we might have been counting on using the fact that some bits were
4835 zero. We now do this in the SET. */
4837 break;
4839 case NEG:
4840 temp = expand_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0));
4842 /* For C equal to the width of MODE minus 1, (neg (ashiftrt X C)) can be
4843 replaced by (lshiftrt X C). This will convert
4844 (neg (sign_extract X 1 Y)) to (zero_extract X 1 Y). */
4846 if (GET_CODE (temp) == ASHIFTRT
4847 && GET_CODE (XEXP (temp, 1)) == CONST_INT
4848 && INTVAL (XEXP (temp, 1)) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1)
4849 return simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT, mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
4850 INTVAL (XEXP (temp, 1)));
4852 /* If X has only a single bit that might be nonzero, say, bit I, convert
4853 (neg X) to (ashiftrt (ashift X C-I) C-I) where C is the bitsize of
4854 MODE minus 1. This will convert (neg (zero_extract X 1 Y)) to
4855 (sign_extract X 1 Y). But only do this if TEMP isn't a register
4856 or a SUBREG of one since we'd be making the expression more
4857 complex if it was just a register. */
4859 if (!REG_P (temp)
4860 && ! (GET_CODE (temp) == SUBREG
4861 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (temp)))
4862 && (i = exact_log2 (nonzero_bits (temp, mode))) >= 0)
4864 rtx temp1 = simplify_shift_const
4865 (NULL_RTX, ASHIFTRT, mode,
4866 simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode, temp,
4867 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1 - i),
4868 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1 - i);
4870 /* If all we did was surround TEMP with the two shifts, we
4871 haven't improved anything, so don't use it. Otherwise,
4872 we are better off with TEMP1. */
4873 if (GET_CODE (temp1) != ASHIFTRT
4874 || GET_CODE (XEXP (temp1, 0)) != ASHIFT
4875 || XEXP (XEXP (temp1, 0), 0) != temp)
4876 return temp1;
4878 break;
4880 case TRUNCATE:
4881 /* We can't handle truncation to a partial integer mode here
4882 because we don't know the real bitsize of the partial
4883 integer mode. */
4884 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
4885 break;
4887 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
4888 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
4889 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))))
4890 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0),
4891 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)),
4892 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0));
4894 /* Similarly to what we do in simplify-rtx.c, a truncate of a register
4895 whose value is a comparison can be replaced with a subreg if
4896 STORE_FLAG_VALUE permits. */
4897 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
4898 && ((HOST_WIDE_INT) STORE_FLAG_VALUE & ~GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == 0
4899 && (temp = get_last_value (XEXP (x, 0)))
4900 && COMPARISON_P (temp))
4901 return gen_lowpart (mode, XEXP (x, 0));
4902 break;
4904 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
4905 case COMPARE:
4906 /* Convert (compare FOO (const_int 0)) to FOO unless we aren't
4907 using cc0, in which case we want to leave it as a COMPARE
4908 so we can distinguish it from a register-register-copy. */
4909 if (XEXP (x, 1) == const0_rtx)
4910 return XEXP (x, 0);
4912 /* x - 0 is the same as x unless x's mode has signed zeros and
4913 allows rounding towards -infinity. Under those conditions,
4914 0 - 0 is -0. */
4915 if (!(HONOR_SIGNED_ZEROS (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
4916 && HONOR_SIGN_DEPENDENT_ROUNDING (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
4917 && XEXP (x, 1) == CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
4918 return XEXP (x, 0);
4919 break;
4920 #endif
4922 case CONST:
4923 /* (const (const X)) can become (const X). Do it this way rather than
4924 returning the inner CONST since CONST can be shared with a
4925 REG_EQUAL note. */
4926 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST)
4927 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
4928 break;
4930 #ifdef HAVE_lo_sum
4931 case LO_SUM:
4932 /* Convert (lo_sum (high FOO) FOO) to FOO. This is necessary so we
4933 can add in an offset. find_split_point will split this address up
4934 again if it doesn't match. */
4935 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == HIGH
4936 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), XEXP (x, 1)))
4937 return XEXP (x, 1);
4938 break;
4939 #endif
4941 case PLUS:
4942 /* (plus (xor (and <foo> (const_int pow2 - 1)) <c>) <-c>)
4943 when c is (const_int (pow2 + 1) / 2) is a sign extension of a
4944 bit-field and can be replaced by either a sign_extend or a
4945 sign_extract. The `and' may be a zero_extend and the two
4946 <c>, -<c> constants may be reversed. */
4947 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == XOR
4948 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
4949 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
4950 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) == -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))
4951 && ((i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))) >= 0
4952 || (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)))) >= 0)
4953 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
4954 && ((GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == AND
4955 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
4956 && (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 1))
4957 == ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (i + 1)) - 1))
4958 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == ZERO_EXTEND
4959 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0)))
4960 == (unsigned int) i + 1))))
4961 return simplify_shift_const
4962 (NULL_RTX, ASHIFTRT, mode,
4963 simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode,
4964 XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), 0),
4965 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - (i + 1)),
4966 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - (i + 1));
4968 /* If only the low-order bit of X is possibly nonzero, (plus x -1)
4969 can become (ashiftrt (ashift (xor x 1) C) C) where C is
4970 the bitsize of the mode - 1. This allows simplification of
4971 "a = (b & 8) == 0;" */
4972 if (XEXP (x, 1) == constm1_rtx
4973 && !REG_P (XEXP (x, 0))
4974 && ! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
4975 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))))
4976 && nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode) == 1)
4977 return simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFTRT, mode,
4978 simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode,
4979 gen_rtx_XOR (mode, XEXP (x, 0), const1_rtx),
4980 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1),
4981 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1);
4983 /* If we are adding two things that have no bits in common, convert
4984 the addition into an IOR. This will often be further simplified,
4985 for example in cases like ((a & 1) + (a & 2)), which can
4986 become a & 3. */
4988 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
4989 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode)
4990 & nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 1), mode)) == 0)
4992 /* Try to simplify the expression further. */
4993 rtx tor = simplify_gen_binary (IOR, mode, XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
4994 temp = combine_simplify_rtx (tor, mode, in_dest);
4996 /* If we could, great. If not, do not go ahead with the IOR
4997 replacement, since PLUS appears in many special purpose
4998 address arithmetic instructions. */
4999 if (GET_CODE (temp) != CLOBBER && temp != tor)
5000 return temp;
5002 break;
5004 case MINUS:
5005 /* (minus <foo> (and <foo> (const_int -pow2))) becomes
5006 (and <foo> (const_int pow2-1)) */
5007 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == AND
5008 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) == CONST_INT
5009 && exact_log2 (-INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1))) >= 0
5010 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0), XEXP (x, 0)))
5011 return simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (x, 0),
5012 -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1)) - 1);
5013 break;
5015 case MULT:
5016 /* If we have (mult (plus A B) C), apply the distributive law and then
5017 the inverse distributive law to see if things simplify. This
5018 occurs mostly in addresses, often when unrolling loops. */
5020 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS)
5022 rtx result = distribute_and_simplify_rtx (x, 0);
5023 if (result)
5024 return result;
5027 /* Try simplify a*(b/c) as (a*b)/c. */
5028 if (FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) && flag_associative_math
5029 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == DIV)
5031 rtx tem = simplify_binary_operation (MULT, mode,
5032 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0),
5033 XEXP (x, 1));
5034 if (tem)
5035 return simplify_gen_binary (DIV, mode, tem, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
5037 break;
5039 case UDIV:
5040 /* If this is a divide by a power of two, treat it as a shift if
5041 its first operand is a shift. */
5042 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
5043 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)))) >= 0
5044 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ASHIFT
5045 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
5046 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ASHIFTRT
5047 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ROTATE
5048 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ROTATERT))
5049 return simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT, mode, XEXP (x, 0), i);
5050 break;
5052 case EQ: case NE:
5053 case GT: case GTU: case GE: case GEU:
5054 case LT: case LTU: case LE: case LEU:
5055 case UNEQ: case LTGT:
5056 case UNGT: case UNGE:
5057 case UNLT: case UNLE:
5058 case UNORDERED: case ORDERED:
5059 /* If the first operand is a condition code, we can't do anything
5060 with it. */
5061 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == COMPARE
5062 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))) != MODE_CC
5063 && ! CC0_P (XEXP (x, 0))))
5065 rtx op0 = XEXP (x, 0);
5066 rtx op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
5067 enum rtx_code new_code;
5069 if (GET_CODE (op0) == COMPARE)
5070 op1 = XEXP (op0, 1), op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
5072 /* Simplify our comparison, if possible. */
5073 new_code = simplify_comparison (code, &op0, &op1);
5075 /* If STORE_FLAG_VALUE is 1, we can convert (ne x 0) to simply X
5076 if only the low-order bit is possibly nonzero in X (such as when
5077 X is a ZERO_EXTRACT of one bit). Similarly, we can convert EQ to
5078 (xor X 1) or (minus 1 X); we use the former. Finally, if X is
5079 known to be either 0 or -1, NE becomes a NEG and EQ becomes
5080 (plus X 1).
5082 Remove any ZERO_EXTRACT we made when thinking this was a
5083 comparison. It may now be simpler to use, e.g., an AND. If a
5084 ZERO_EXTRACT is indeed appropriate, it will be placed back by
5085 the call to make_compound_operation in the SET case. */
5087 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1
5088 && new_code == NE && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5089 && op1 == const0_rtx
5090 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5091 && nonzero_bits (op0, mode) == 1)
5092 return gen_lowpart (mode,
5093 expand_compound_operation (op0));
5095 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1
5096 && new_code == NE && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5097 && op1 == const0_rtx
5098 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5099 && (num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode)
5100 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
5102 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5103 return simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
5104 gen_lowpart (mode, op0),
5105 mode);
5108 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1
5109 && new_code == EQ && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5110 && op1 == const0_rtx
5111 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5112 && nonzero_bits (op0, mode) == 1)
5114 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5115 return simplify_gen_binary (XOR, mode,
5116 gen_lowpart (mode, op0),
5117 const1_rtx);
5120 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1
5121 && new_code == EQ && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5122 && op1 == const0_rtx
5123 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5124 && (num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode)
5125 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
5127 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5128 return plus_constant (gen_lowpart (mode, op0), 1);
5131 /* If STORE_FLAG_VALUE is -1, we have cases similar to
5132 those above. */
5133 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1
5134 && new_code == NE && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5135 && op1 == const0_rtx
5136 && (num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode)
5137 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
5138 return gen_lowpart (mode,
5139 expand_compound_operation (op0));
5141 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1
5142 && new_code == NE && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5143 && op1 == const0_rtx
5144 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5145 && nonzero_bits (op0, mode) == 1)
5147 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5148 return simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
5149 gen_lowpart (mode, op0),
5150 mode);
5153 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1
5154 && new_code == EQ && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5155 && op1 == const0_rtx
5156 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5157 && (num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode)
5158 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
5160 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5161 return simplify_gen_unary (NOT, mode,
5162 gen_lowpart (mode, op0),
5163 mode);
5166 /* If X is 0/1, (eq X 0) is X-1. */
5167 else if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1
5168 && new_code == EQ && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5169 && op1 == const0_rtx
5170 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5171 && nonzero_bits (op0, mode) == 1)
5173 op0 = expand_compound_operation (op0);
5174 return plus_constant (gen_lowpart (mode, op0), -1);
5177 /* If STORE_FLAG_VALUE says to just test the sign bit and X has just
5178 one bit that might be nonzero, we can convert (ne x 0) to
5179 (ashift x c) where C puts the bit in the sign bit. Remove any
5180 AND with STORE_FLAG_VALUE when we are done, since we are only
5181 going to test the sign bit. */
5182 if (new_code == NE && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5183 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5184 && ((STORE_FLAG_VALUE & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
5185 == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1))
5186 && op1 == const0_rtx
5187 && mode == GET_MODE (op0)
5188 && (i = exact_log2 (nonzero_bits (op0, mode))) >= 0)
5190 x = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode,
5191 expand_compound_operation (op0),
5192 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1 - i);
5193 if (GET_CODE (x) == AND && XEXP (x, 1) == const_true_rtx)
5194 return XEXP (x, 0);
5195 else
5196 return x;
5199 /* If the code changed, return a whole new comparison. */
5200 if (new_code != code)
5201 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (new_code, mode, op0, op1);
5203 /* Otherwise, keep this operation, but maybe change its operands.
5204 This also converts (ne (compare FOO BAR) 0) to (ne FOO BAR). */
5205 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), op0);
5206 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), op1);
5208 break;
5210 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
5211 return simplify_if_then_else (x);
5213 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
5214 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
5215 case ZERO_EXTEND:
5216 case SIGN_EXTEND:
5217 /* If we are processing SET_DEST, we are done. */
5218 if (in_dest)
5219 return x;
5221 return expand_compound_operation (x);
5223 case SET:
5224 return simplify_set (x);
5226 case AND:
5227 case IOR:
5228 return simplify_logical (x);
5230 case ASHIFT:
5231 case LSHIFTRT:
5232 case ASHIFTRT:
5233 case ROTATE:
5234 case ROTATERT:
5235 /* If this is a shift by a constant amount, simplify it. */
5236 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
5237 return simplify_shift_const (x, code, mode, XEXP (x, 0),
5238 INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
5240 else if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED && !REG_P (XEXP (x, 1)))
5241 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1),
5242 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 1), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 1)),
5243 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
5244 << exact_log2 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x))))
5245 - 1,
5246 0));
5247 break;
5249 default:
5250 break;
5253 return x;
5256 /* Simplify X, an IF_THEN_ELSE expression. Return the new expression. */
5258 static rtx
5259 simplify_if_then_else (rtx x)
5261 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
5262 rtx cond = XEXP (x, 0);
5263 rtx true_rtx = XEXP (x, 1);
5264 rtx false_rtx = XEXP (x, 2);
5265 enum rtx_code true_code = GET_CODE (cond);
5266 int comparison_p = COMPARISON_P (cond);
5267 rtx temp;
5268 int i;
5269 enum rtx_code false_code;
5270 rtx reversed;
5272 /* Simplify storing of the truth value. */
5273 if (comparison_p && true_rtx == const_true_rtx && false_rtx == const0_rtx)
5274 return simplify_gen_relational (true_code, mode, VOIDmode,
5275 XEXP (cond, 0), XEXP (cond, 1));
5277 /* Also when the truth value has to be reversed. */
5278 if (comparison_p
5279 && true_rtx == const0_rtx && false_rtx == const_true_rtx
5280 && (reversed = reversed_comparison (cond, mode)))
5281 return reversed;
5283 /* Sometimes we can simplify the arm of an IF_THEN_ELSE if a register used
5284 in it is being compared against certain values. Get the true and false
5285 comparisons and see if that says anything about the value of each arm. */
5287 if (comparison_p
5288 && ((false_code = reversed_comparison_code (cond, NULL))
5289 != UNKNOWN)
5290 && REG_P (XEXP (cond, 0)))
5292 HOST_WIDE_INT nzb;
5293 rtx from = XEXP (cond, 0);
5294 rtx true_val = XEXP (cond, 1);
5295 rtx false_val = true_val;
5296 int swapped = 0;
5298 /* If FALSE_CODE is EQ, swap the codes and arms. */
5300 if (false_code == EQ)
5302 swapped = 1, true_code = EQ, false_code = NE;
5303 temp = true_rtx, true_rtx = false_rtx, false_rtx = temp;
5306 /* If we are comparing against zero and the expression being tested has
5307 only a single bit that might be nonzero, that is its value when it is
5308 not equal to zero. Similarly if it is known to be -1 or 0. */
5310 if (true_code == EQ && true_val == const0_rtx
5311 && exact_log2 (nzb = nonzero_bits (from, GET_MODE (from))) >= 0)
5313 false_code = EQ;
5314 false_val = GEN_INT (trunc_int_for_mode (nzb, GET_MODE (from)));
5316 else if (true_code == EQ && true_val == const0_rtx
5317 && (num_sign_bit_copies (from, GET_MODE (from))
5318 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (from))))
5320 false_code = EQ;
5321 false_val = constm1_rtx;
5324 /* Now simplify an arm if we know the value of the register in the
5325 branch and it is used in the arm. Be careful due to the potential
5326 of locally-shared RTL. */
5328 if (reg_mentioned_p (from, true_rtx))
5329 true_rtx = subst (known_cond (copy_rtx (true_rtx), true_code,
5330 from, true_val),
5331 pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
5332 if (reg_mentioned_p (from, false_rtx))
5333 false_rtx = subst (known_cond (copy_rtx (false_rtx), false_code,
5334 from, false_val),
5335 pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
5337 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), swapped ? false_rtx : true_rtx);
5338 SUBST (XEXP (x, 2), swapped ? true_rtx : false_rtx);
5340 true_rtx = XEXP (x, 1);
5341 false_rtx = XEXP (x, 2);
5342 true_code = GET_CODE (cond);
5345 /* If we have (if_then_else FOO (pc) (label_ref BAR)) and FOO can be
5346 reversed, do so to avoid needing two sets of patterns for
5347 subtract-and-branch insns. Similarly if we have a constant in the true
5348 arm, the false arm is the same as the first operand of the comparison, or
5349 the false arm is more complicated than the true arm. */
5351 if (comparison_p
5352 && reversed_comparison_code (cond, NULL) != UNKNOWN
5353 && (true_rtx == pc_rtx
5354 || (CONSTANT_P (true_rtx)
5355 && GET_CODE (false_rtx) != CONST_INT && false_rtx != pc_rtx)
5356 || true_rtx == const0_rtx
5357 || (OBJECT_P (true_rtx) && !OBJECT_P (false_rtx))
5358 || (GET_CODE (true_rtx) == SUBREG && OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (true_rtx))
5359 && !OBJECT_P (false_rtx))
5360 || reg_mentioned_p (true_rtx, false_rtx)
5361 || rtx_equal_p (false_rtx, XEXP (cond, 0))))
5363 true_code = reversed_comparison_code (cond, NULL);
5364 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), reversed_comparison (cond, GET_MODE (cond)));
5365 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), false_rtx);
5366 SUBST (XEXP (x, 2), true_rtx);
5368 temp = true_rtx, true_rtx = false_rtx, false_rtx = temp;
5369 cond = XEXP (x, 0);
5371 /* It is possible that the conditional has been simplified out. */
5372 true_code = GET_CODE (cond);
5373 comparison_p = COMPARISON_P (cond);
5376 /* If the two arms are identical, we don't need the comparison. */
5378 if (rtx_equal_p (true_rtx, false_rtx) && ! side_effects_p (cond))
5379 return true_rtx;
5381 /* Convert a == b ? b : a to "a". */
5382 if (true_code == EQ && ! side_effects_p (cond)
5383 && !HONOR_NANS (mode)
5384 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 0), false_rtx)
5385 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 1), true_rtx))
5386 return false_rtx;
5387 else if (true_code == NE && ! side_effects_p (cond)
5388 && !HONOR_NANS (mode)
5389 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 0), true_rtx)
5390 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 1), false_rtx))
5391 return true_rtx;
5393 /* Look for cases where we have (abs x) or (neg (abs X)). */
5395 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5396 && comparison_p
5397 && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx
5398 && GET_CODE (false_rtx) == NEG
5399 && rtx_equal_p (true_rtx, XEXP (false_rtx, 0))
5400 && rtx_equal_p (true_rtx, XEXP (cond, 0))
5401 && ! side_effects_p (true_rtx))
5402 switch (true_code)
5404 case GT:
5405 case GE:
5406 return simplify_gen_unary (ABS, mode, true_rtx, mode);
5407 case LT:
5408 case LE:
5409 return
5410 simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
5411 simplify_gen_unary (ABS, mode, true_rtx, mode),
5412 mode);
5413 default:
5414 break;
5417 /* Look for MIN or MAX. */
5419 if ((! FLOAT_MODE_P (mode) || flag_unsafe_math_optimizations)
5420 && comparison_p
5421 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 0), true_rtx)
5422 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond, 1), false_rtx)
5423 && ! side_effects_p (cond))
5424 switch (true_code)
5426 case GE:
5427 case GT:
5428 return simplify_gen_binary (SMAX, mode, true_rtx, false_rtx);
5429 case LE:
5430 case LT:
5431 return simplify_gen_binary (SMIN, mode, true_rtx, false_rtx);
5432 case GEU:
5433 case GTU:
5434 return simplify_gen_binary (UMAX, mode, true_rtx, false_rtx);
5435 case LEU:
5436 case LTU:
5437 return simplify_gen_binary (UMIN, mode, true_rtx, false_rtx);
5438 default:
5439 break;
5442 /* If we have (if_then_else COND (OP Z C1) Z) and OP is an identity when its
5443 second operand is zero, this can be done as (OP Z (mult COND C2)) where
5444 C2 = C1 * STORE_FLAG_VALUE. Similarly if OP has an outer ZERO_EXTEND or
5445 SIGN_EXTEND as long as Z is already extended (so we don't destroy it).
5446 We can do this kind of thing in some cases when STORE_FLAG_VALUE is
5447 neither 1 or -1, but it isn't worth checking for. */
5449 if ((STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 || STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
5450 && comparison_p
5451 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5452 && ! side_effects_p (x))
5454 rtx t = make_compound_operation (true_rtx, SET);
5455 rtx f = make_compound_operation (false_rtx, SET);
5456 rtx cond_op0 = XEXP (cond, 0);
5457 rtx cond_op1 = XEXP (cond, 1);
5458 enum rtx_code op = UNKNOWN, extend_op = UNKNOWN;
5459 enum machine_mode m = mode;
5460 rtx z = 0, c1 = NULL_RTX;
5462 if ((GET_CODE (t) == PLUS || GET_CODE (t) == MINUS
5463 || GET_CODE (t) == IOR || GET_CODE (t) == XOR
5464 || GET_CODE (t) == ASHIFT
5465 || GET_CODE (t) == LSHIFTRT || GET_CODE (t) == ASHIFTRT)
5466 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (t, 0), f))
5467 c1 = XEXP (t, 1), op = GET_CODE (t), z = f;
5469 /* If an identity-zero op is commutative, check whether there
5470 would be a match if we swapped the operands. */
5471 else if ((GET_CODE (t) == PLUS || GET_CODE (t) == IOR
5472 || GET_CODE (t) == XOR)
5473 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (t, 1), f))
5474 c1 = XEXP (t, 0), op = GET_CODE (t), z = f;
5475 else if (GET_CODE (t) == SIGN_EXTEND
5476 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == PLUS
5477 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == MINUS
5478 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == IOR
5479 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == XOR
5480 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == ASHIFT
5481 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
5482 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == ASHIFTRT)
5483 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
5484 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0))
5485 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0)), f)
5486 && (num_sign_bit_copies (f, GET_MODE (f))
5487 > (unsigned int)
5488 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
5489 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0))))))
5491 c1 = XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1); z = f; op = GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5492 extend_op = SIGN_EXTEND;
5493 m = GET_MODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5495 else if (GET_CODE (t) == SIGN_EXTEND
5496 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == PLUS
5497 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == IOR
5498 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == XOR)
5499 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1)) == SUBREG
5500 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1))
5501 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1)), f)
5502 && (num_sign_bit_copies (f, GET_MODE (f))
5503 > (unsigned int)
5504 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
5505 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1))))))
5507 c1 = XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0); z = f; op = GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5508 extend_op = SIGN_EXTEND;
5509 m = GET_MODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5511 else if (GET_CODE (t) == ZERO_EXTEND
5512 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == PLUS
5513 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == MINUS
5514 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == IOR
5515 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == XOR
5516 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == ASHIFT
5517 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
5518 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == ASHIFTRT)
5519 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
5520 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5521 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0))
5522 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0)), f)
5523 && ((nonzero_bits (f, GET_MODE (f))
5524 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0))))
5525 == 0))
5527 c1 = XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1); z = f; op = GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5528 extend_op = ZERO_EXTEND;
5529 m = GET_MODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5531 else if (GET_CODE (t) == ZERO_EXTEND
5532 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == PLUS
5533 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == IOR
5534 || GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0)) == XOR)
5535 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1)) == SUBREG
5536 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5537 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1))
5538 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1)), f)
5539 && ((nonzero_bits (f, GET_MODE (f))
5540 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 1))))
5541 == 0))
5543 c1 = XEXP (XEXP (t, 0), 0); z = f; op = GET_CODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5544 extend_op = ZERO_EXTEND;
5545 m = GET_MODE (XEXP (t, 0));
5548 if (z)
5550 temp = subst (simplify_gen_relational (true_code, m, VOIDmode,
5551 cond_op0, cond_op1),
5552 pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
5553 temp = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, m, temp,
5554 simplify_gen_binary (MULT, m, c1,
5555 const_true_rtx));
5556 temp = subst (temp, pc_rtx, pc_rtx, 0, 0);
5557 temp = simplify_gen_binary (op, m, gen_lowpart (m, z), temp);
5559 if (extend_op != UNKNOWN)
5560 temp = simplify_gen_unary (extend_op, mode, temp, m);
5562 return temp;
5566 /* If we have (if_then_else (ne A 0) C1 0) and either A is known to be 0 or
5567 1 and C1 is a single bit or A is known to be 0 or -1 and C1 is the
5568 negation of a single bit, we can convert this operation to a shift. We
5569 can actually do this more generally, but it doesn't seem worth it. */
5571 if (true_code == NE && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx
5572 && false_rtx == const0_rtx && GET_CODE (true_rtx) == CONST_INT
5573 && ((1 == nonzero_bits (XEXP (cond, 0), mode)
5574 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (true_rtx))) >= 0)
5575 || ((num_sign_bit_copies (XEXP (cond, 0), mode)
5576 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
5577 && (i = exact_log2 (-INTVAL (true_rtx))) >= 0)))
5578 return
5579 simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode,
5580 gen_lowpart (mode, XEXP (cond, 0)), i);
5582 /* (IF_THEN_ELSE (NE REG 0) (0) (8)) is REG for nonzero_bits (REG) == 8. */
5583 if (true_code == NE && XEXP (cond, 1) == const0_rtx
5584 && false_rtx == const0_rtx && GET_CODE (true_rtx) == CONST_INT
5585 && GET_MODE (XEXP (cond, 0)) == mode
5586 && (INTVAL (true_rtx) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
5587 == nonzero_bits (XEXP (cond, 0), mode)
5588 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (true_rtx) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))) >= 0)
5589 return XEXP (cond, 0);
5591 return x;
5594 /* Simplify X, a SET expression. Return the new expression. */
5596 static rtx
5597 simplify_set (rtx x)
5599 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
5600 rtx dest = SET_DEST (x);
5601 enum machine_mode mode
5602 = GET_MODE (src) != VOIDmode ? GET_MODE (src) : GET_MODE (dest);
5603 rtx other_insn;
5604 rtx *cc_use;
5606 /* (set (pc) (return)) gets written as (return). */
5607 if (GET_CODE (dest) == PC && GET_CODE (src) == RETURN)
5608 return src;
5610 /* Now that we know for sure which bits of SRC we are using, see if we can
5611 simplify the expression for the object knowing that we only need the
5612 low-order bits. */
5614 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5615 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
5617 src = force_to_mode (src, mode, ~(HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, 0);
5618 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), src);
5621 /* If we are setting CC0 or if the source is a COMPARE, look for the use of
5622 the comparison result and try to simplify it unless we already have used
5623 undobuf.other_insn. */
5624 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC
5625 || GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE
5626 || CC0_P (dest))
5627 && (cc_use = find_single_use (dest, subst_insn, &other_insn)) != 0
5628 && (undobuf.other_insn == 0 || other_insn == undobuf.other_insn)
5629 && COMPARISON_P (*cc_use)
5630 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (*cc_use, 0), dest))
5632 enum rtx_code old_code = GET_CODE (*cc_use);
5633 enum rtx_code new_code;
5634 rtx op0, op1, tmp;
5635 int other_changed = 0;
5636 enum machine_mode compare_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
5638 if (GET_CODE (src) == COMPARE)
5639 op0 = XEXP (src, 0), op1 = XEXP (src, 1);
5640 else
5641 op0 = src, op1 = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (src));
5643 tmp = simplify_relational_operation (old_code, compare_mode, VOIDmode,
5644 op0, op1);
5645 if (!tmp)
5646 new_code = old_code;
5647 else if (!CONSTANT_P (tmp))
5649 new_code = GET_CODE (tmp);
5650 op0 = XEXP (tmp, 0);
5651 op1 = XEXP (tmp, 1);
5653 else
5655 rtx pat = PATTERN (other_insn);
5656 undobuf.other_insn = other_insn;
5657 SUBST (*cc_use, tmp);
5659 /* Attempt to simplify CC user. */
5660 if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
5662 rtx new = simplify_rtx (SET_SRC (pat));
5663 if (new != NULL_RTX)
5664 SUBST (SET_SRC (pat), new);
5667 /* Convert X into a no-op move. */
5668 SUBST (SET_DEST (x), pc_rtx);
5669 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), pc_rtx);
5670 return x;
5673 /* Simplify our comparison, if possible. */
5674 new_code = simplify_comparison (new_code, &op0, &op1);
5676 #ifdef SELECT_CC_MODE
5677 /* If this machine has CC modes other than CCmode, check to see if we
5678 need to use a different CC mode here. */
5679 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_CC)
5680 compare_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
5681 else
5682 compare_mode = SELECT_CC_MODE (new_code, op0, op1);
5684 #ifndef HAVE_cc0
5685 /* If the mode changed, we have to change SET_DEST, the mode in the
5686 compare, and the mode in the place SET_DEST is used. If SET_DEST is
5687 a hard register, just build new versions with the proper mode. If it
5688 is a pseudo, we lose unless it is only time we set the pseudo, in
5689 which case we can safely change its mode. */
5690 if (compare_mode != GET_MODE (dest))
5692 if (can_change_dest_mode (dest, 0, compare_mode))
5694 unsigned int regno = REGNO (dest);
5695 rtx new_dest;
5697 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
5698 new_dest = gen_rtx_REG (compare_mode, regno);
5699 else
5701 SUBST_MODE (regno_reg_rtx[regno], compare_mode);
5702 new_dest = regno_reg_rtx[regno];
5705 SUBST (SET_DEST (x), new_dest);
5706 SUBST (XEXP (*cc_use, 0), new_dest);
5707 other_changed = 1;
5709 dest = new_dest;
5712 #endif /* cc0 */
5713 #endif /* SELECT_CC_MODE */
5715 /* If the code changed, we have to build a new comparison in
5716 undobuf.other_insn. */
5717 if (new_code != old_code)
5719 int other_changed_previously = other_changed;
5720 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
5722 SUBST (*cc_use, gen_rtx_fmt_ee (new_code, GET_MODE (*cc_use),
5723 dest, const0_rtx));
5724 other_changed = 1;
5726 /* If the only change we made was to change an EQ into an NE or
5727 vice versa, OP0 has only one bit that might be nonzero, and OP1
5728 is zero, check if changing the user of the condition code will
5729 produce a valid insn. If it won't, we can keep the original code
5730 in that insn by surrounding our operation with an XOR. */
5732 if (((old_code == NE && new_code == EQ)
5733 || (old_code == EQ && new_code == NE))
5734 && ! other_changed_previously && op1 == const0_rtx
5735 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5736 && exact_log2 (mask = nonzero_bits (op0, GET_MODE (op0))) >= 0)
5738 rtx pat = PATTERN (other_insn), note = 0;
5740 if ((recog_for_combine (&pat, other_insn, &note) < 0
5741 && ! check_asm_operands (pat)))
5743 PUT_CODE (*cc_use, old_code);
5744 other_changed = 0;
5746 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (XOR, GET_MODE (op0),
5747 op0, GEN_INT (mask));
5752 if (other_changed)
5753 undobuf.other_insn = other_insn;
5755 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
5756 /* If we are now comparing against zero, change our source if
5757 needed. If we do not use cc0, we always have a COMPARE. */
5758 if (op1 == const0_rtx && dest == cc0_rtx)
5760 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), op0);
5761 src = op0;
5763 else
5764 #endif
5766 /* Otherwise, if we didn't previously have a COMPARE in the
5767 correct mode, we need one. */
5768 if (GET_CODE (src) != COMPARE || GET_MODE (src) != compare_mode)
5770 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), gen_rtx_COMPARE (compare_mode, op0, op1));
5771 src = SET_SRC (x);
5773 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == compare_mode && op1 == const0_rtx)
5775 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), op0);
5776 src = SET_SRC (x);
5778 /* Otherwise, update the COMPARE if needed. */
5779 else if (XEXP (src, 0) != op0 || XEXP (src, 1) != op1)
5781 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), gen_rtx_COMPARE (compare_mode, op0, op1));
5782 src = SET_SRC (x);
5785 else
5787 /* Get SET_SRC in a form where we have placed back any
5788 compound expressions. Then do the checks below. */
5789 src = make_compound_operation (src, SET);
5790 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), src);
5793 /* If we have (set x (subreg:m1 (op:m2 ...) 0)) with OP being some operation,
5794 and X being a REG or (subreg (reg)), we may be able to convert this to
5795 (set (subreg:m2 x) (op)).
5797 We can always do this if M1 is narrower than M2 because that means that
5798 we only care about the low bits of the result.
5800 However, on machines without WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS defined, we cannot
5801 perform a narrower operation than requested since the high-order bits will
5802 be undefined. On machine where it is defined, this transformation is safe
5803 as long as M1 and M2 have the same number of words. */
5805 if (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (src)
5806 && !OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (src))
5807 && (((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src)) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1))
5808 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
5809 == ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src)))
5810 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD))
5811 #ifndef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5812 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src))
5813 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src))))
5814 #endif
5815 #ifdef CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS
5816 && ! (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
5817 && REG_CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_P (REGNO (dest),
5818 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src)),
5819 GET_MODE (src)))
5820 #endif
5821 && (REG_P (dest)
5822 || (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
5823 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (dest)))))
5825 SUBST (SET_DEST (x),
5826 gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src)),
5827 dest));
5828 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), SUBREG_REG (src));
5830 src = SET_SRC (x), dest = SET_DEST (x);
5833 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
5834 /* If we have (set (cc0) (subreg ...)), we try to remove the subreg
5835 in SRC. */
5836 if (dest == cc0_rtx
5837 && GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG
5838 && subreg_lowpart_p (src)
5839 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (src))
5840 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src)))))
5842 rtx inner = SUBREG_REG (src);
5843 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (inner);
5845 /* Here we make sure that we don't have a sign bit on. */
5846 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5847 && (nonzero_bits (inner, inner_mode)
5848 < ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
5849 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (src)) - 1))))
5851 SUBST (SET_SRC (x), inner);
5852 src = SET_SRC (x);
5855 #endif
5857 #ifdef LOAD_EXTEND_OP
5858 /* If we have (set FOO (subreg:M (mem:N BAR) 0)) with M wider than N, this
5859 would require a paradoxical subreg. Replace the subreg with a
5860 zero_extend to avoid the reload that would otherwise be required. */
5862 if (GET_CODE (src) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (src)
5863 && LOAD_EXTEND_OP (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src))) != UNKNOWN
5864 && SUBREG_BYTE (src) == 0
5865 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src))
5866 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src))))
5867 && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (src)))
5869 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
5870 gen_rtx_fmt_e (LOAD_EXTEND_OP (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (src))),
5871 GET_MODE (src), SUBREG_REG (src)));
5873 src = SET_SRC (x);
5875 #endif
5877 /* If we don't have a conditional move, SET_SRC is an IF_THEN_ELSE, and we
5878 are comparing an item known to be 0 or -1 against 0, use a logical
5879 operation instead. Check for one of the arms being an IOR of the other
5880 arm with some value. We compute three terms to be IOR'ed together. In
5881 practice, at most two will be nonzero. Then we do the IOR's. */
5883 if (GET_CODE (dest) != PC
5884 && GET_CODE (src) == IF_THEN_ELSE
5885 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (src)) == MODE_INT
5886 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == EQ || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == NE)
5887 && XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 1) == const0_rtx
5888 && GET_MODE (src) == GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0))
5889 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
5890 && ! can_conditionally_move_p (GET_MODE (src))
5891 #endif
5892 && (num_sign_bit_copies (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0),
5893 GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0)))
5894 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0))))
5895 && ! side_effects_p (src))
5897 rtx true_rtx = (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == NE
5898 ? XEXP (src, 1) : XEXP (src, 2));
5899 rtx false_rtx = (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == NE
5900 ? XEXP (src, 2) : XEXP (src, 1));
5901 rtx term1 = const0_rtx, term2, term3;
5903 if (GET_CODE (true_rtx) == IOR
5904 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (true_rtx, 0), false_rtx))
5905 term1 = false_rtx, true_rtx = XEXP (true_rtx, 1), false_rtx = const0_rtx;
5906 else if (GET_CODE (true_rtx) == IOR
5907 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (true_rtx, 1), false_rtx))
5908 term1 = false_rtx, true_rtx = XEXP (true_rtx, 0), false_rtx = const0_rtx;
5909 else if (GET_CODE (false_rtx) == IOR
5910 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (false_rtx, 0), true_rtx))
5911 term1 = true_rtx, false_rtx = XEXP (false_rtx, 1), true_rtx = const0_rtx;
5912 else if (GET_CODE (false_rtx) == IOR
5913 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (false_rtx, 1), true_rtx))
5914 term1 = true_rtx, false_rtx = XEXP (false_rtx, 0), true_rtx = const0_rtx;
5916 term2 = simplify_gen_binary (AND, GET_MODE (src),
5917 XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0), true_rtx);
5918 term3 = simplify_gen_binary (AND, GET_MODE (src),
5919 simplify_gen_unary (NOT, GET_MODE (src),
5920 XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0),
5921 GET_MODE (src)),
5922 false_rtx);
5924 SUBST (SET_SRC (x),
5925 simplify_gen_binary (IOR, GET_MODE (src),
5926 simplify_gen_binary (IOR, GET_MODE (src),
5927 term1, term2),
5928 term3));
5930 src = SET_SRC (x);
5933 /* If either SRC or DEST is a CLOBBER of (const_int 0), make this
5934 whole thing fail. */
5935 if (GET_CODE (src) == CLOBBER && XEXP (src, 0) == const0_rtx)
5936 return src;
5937 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == CLOBBER && XEXP (dest, 0) == const0_rtx)
5938 return dest;
5939 else
5940 /* Convert this into a field assignment operation, if possible. */
5941 return make_field_assignment (x);
5944 /* Simplify, X, and AND, IOR, or XOR operation, and return the simplified
5945 result. */
5947 static rtx
5948 simplify_logical (rtx x)
5950 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
5951 rtx op0 = XEXP (x, 0);
5952 rtx op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
5954 switch (GET_CODE (x))
5956 case AND:
5957 /* We can call simplify_and_const_int only if we don't lose
5958 any (sign) bits when converting INTVAL (op1) to
5959 "unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT". */
5960 if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
5961 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
5962 || INTVAL (op1) > 0))
5964 x = simplify_and_const_int (x, mode, op0, INTVAL (op1));
5965 if (GET_CODE (x) != AND)
5966 return x;
5968 op0 = XEXP (x, 0);
5969 op1 = XEXP (x, 1);
5972 /* If we have any of (and (ior A B) C) or (and (xor A B) C),
5973 apply the distributive law and then the inverse distributive
5974 law to see if things simplify. */
5975 if (GET_CODE (op0) == IOR || GET_CODE (op0) == XOR)
5977 rtx result = distribute_and_simplify_rtx (x, 0);
5978 if (result)
5979 return result;
5981 if (GET_CODE (op1) == IOR || GET_CODE (op1) == XOR)
5983 rtx result = distribute_and_simplify_rtx (x, 1);
5984 if (result)
5985 return result;
5987 break;
5989 case IOR:
5990 /* If we have (ior (and A B) C), apply the distributive law and then
5991 the inverse distributive law to see if things simplify. */
5993 if (GET_CODE (op0) == AND)
5995 rtx result = distribute_and_simplify_rtx (x, 0);
5996 if (result)
5997 return result;
6000 if (GET_CODE (op1) == AND)
6002 rtx result = distribute_and_simplify_rtx (x, 1);
6003 if (result)
6004 return result;
6006 break;
6008 default:
6009 gcc_unreachable ();
6012 return x;
6015 /* We consider ZERO_EXTRACT, SIGN_EXTRACT, and SIGN_EXTEND as "compound
6016 operations" because they can be replaced with two more basic operations.
6017 ZERO_EXTEND is also considered "compound" because it can be replaced with
6018 an AND operation, which is simpler, though only one operation.
6020 The function expand_compound_operation is called with an rtx expression
6021 and will convert it to the appropriate shifts and AND operations,
6022 simplifying at each stage.
6024 The function make_compound_operation is called to convert an expression
6025 consisting of shifts and ANDs into the equivalent compound expression.
6026 It is the inverse of this function, loosely speaking. */
6028 static rtx
6029 expand_compound_operation (rtx x)
6031 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT pos = 0, len;
6032 int unsignedp = 0;
6033 unsigned int modewidth;
6034 rtx tem;
6036 switch (GET_CODE (x))
6038 case ZERO_EXTEND:
6039 unsignedp = 1;
6040 case SIGN_EXTEND:
6041 /* We can't necessarily use a const_int for a multiword mode;
6042 it depends on implicitly extending the value.
6043 Since we don't know the right way to extend it,
6044 we can't tell whether the implicit way is right.
6046 Even for a mode that is no wider than a const_int,
6047 we can't win, because we need to sign extend one of its bits through
6048 the rest of it, and we don't know which bit. */
6049 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT)
6050 return x;
6052 /* Return if (subreg:MODE FROM 0) is not a safe replacement for
6053 (zero_extend:MODE FROM) or (sign_extend:MODE FROM). It is for any MEM
6054 because (SUBREG (MEM...)) is guaranteed to cause the MEM to be
6055 reloaded. If not for that, MEM's would very rarely be safe.
6057 Reject MODEs bigger than a word, because we might not be able
6058 to reference a two-register group starting with an arbitrary register
6059 (and currently gen_lowpart might crash for a SUBREG). */
6061 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
6062 return x;
6064 /* Reject MODEs that aren't scalar integers because turning vector
6065 or complex modes into shifts causes problems. */
6067 if (! SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
6068 return x;
6070 len = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)));
6071 /* If the inner object has VOIDmode (the only way this can happen
6072 is if it is an ASM_OPERANDS), we can't do anything since we don't
6073 know how much masking to do. */
6074 if (len == 0)
6075 return x;
6077 break;
6079 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
6080 unsignedp = 1;
6082 /* ... fall through ... */
6084 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
6085 /* If the operand is a CLOBBER, just return it. */
6086 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CLOBBER)
6087 return XEXP (x, 0);
6089 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT
6090 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 2)) != CONST_INT
6091 || GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == VOIDmode)
6092 return x;
6094 /* Reject MODEs that aren't scalar integers because turning vector
6095 or complex modes into shifts causes problems. */
6097 if (! SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
6098 return x;
6100 len = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
6101 pos = INTVAL (XEXP (x, 2));
6103 /* This should stay within the object being extracted, fail otherwise. */
6104 if (len + pos > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
6105 return x;
6107 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6108 pos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))) - len - pos;
6110 break;
6112 default:
6113 return x;
6115 /* Convert sign extension to zero extension, if we know that the high
6116 bit is not set, as this is easier to optimize. It will be converted
6117 back to cheaper alternative in make_extraction. */
6118 if (GET_CODE (x) == SIGN_EXTEND
6119 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6120 && ((nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
6121 & ~(((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
6122 GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
6123 >> 1))
6124 == 0)))
6126 rtx temp = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0));
6127 rtx temp2 = expand_compound_operation (temp);
6129 /* Make sure this is a profitable operation. */
6130 if (rtx_cost (x, SET) > rtx_cost (temp2, SET))
6131 return temp2;
6132 else if (rtx_cost (x, SET) > rtx_cost (temp, SET))
6133 return temp;
6134 else
6135 return x;
6138 /* We can optimize some special cases of ZERO_EXTEND. */
6139 if (GET_CODE (x) == ZERO_EXTEND)
6141 /* (zero_extend:DI (truncate:SI foo:DI)) is just foo:DI if we
6142 know that the last value didn't have any inappropriate bits
6143 set. */
6144 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == TRUNCATE
6145 && GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == GET_MODE (x)
6146 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6147 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), GET_MODE (x))
6148 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))) == 0)
6149 return XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
6151 /* Likewise for (zero_extend:DI (subreg:SI foo:DI 0)). */
6152 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
6153 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == GET_MODE (x)
6154 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (x, 0))
6155 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6156 && (nonzero_bits (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)), GET_MODE (x))
6157 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))) == 0)
6158 return SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0));
6160 /* (zero_extend:DI (truncate:SI foo:DI)) is just foo:DI when foo
6161 is a comparison and STORE_FLAG_VALUE permits. This is like
6162 the first case, but it works even when GET_MODE (x) is larger
6163 than HOST_WIDE_INT. */
6164 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == TRUNCATE
6165 && GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == GET_MODE (x)
6166 && COMPARISON_P (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0))
6167 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
6168 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
6169 && ((HOST_WIDE_INT) STORE_FLAG_VALUE
6170 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))) == 0)
6171 return XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
6173 /* Likewise for (zero_extend:DI (subreg:SI foo:DI 0)). */
6174 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
6175 && GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == GET_MODE (x)
6176 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (x, 0))
6177 && COMPARISON_P (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)))
6178 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
6179 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
6180 && ((HOST_WIDE_INT) STORE_FLAG_VALUE
6181 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))) == 0)
6182 return SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0));
6186 /* If we reach here, we want to return a pair of shifts. The inner
6187 shift is a left shift of BITSIZE - POS - LEN bits. The outer
6188 shift is a right shift of BITSIZE - LEN bits. It is arithmetic or
6189 logical depending on the value of UNSIGNEDP.
6191 If this was a ZERO_EXTEND or ZERO_EXTRACT, this pair of shifts will be
6192 converted into an AND of a shift.
6194 We must check for the case where the left shift would have a negative
6195 count. This can happen in a case like (x >> 31) & 255 on machines
6196 that can't shift by a constant. On those machines, we would first
6197 combine the shift with the AND to produce a variable-position
6198 extraction. Then the constant of 31 would be substituted in to produce
6199 a such a position. */
6201 modewidth = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x));
6202 if (modewidth + len >= pos)
6204 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
6205 tem = gen_lowpart (mode, XEXP (x, 0));
6206 if (!tem || GET_CODE (tem) == CLOBBER)
6207 return x;
6208 tem = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode,
6209 tem, modewidth - pos - len);
6210 tem = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, unsignedp ? LSHIFTRT : ASHIFTRT,
6211 mode, tem, modewidth - len);
6213 else if (unsignedp && len < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
6214 tem = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (x),
6215 simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT,
6216 GET_MODE (x),
6217 XEXP (x, 0), pos),
6218 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1);
6219 else
6220 /* Any other cases we can't handle. */
6221 return x;
6223 /* If we couldn't do this for some reason, return the original
6224 expression. */
6225 if (GET_CODE (tem) == CLOBBER)
6226 return x;
6228 return tem;
6231 /* X is a SET which contains an assignment of one object into
6232 a part of another (such as a bit-field assignment, STRICT_LOW_PART,
6233 or certain SUBREGS). If possible, convert it into a series of
6234 logical operations.
6236 We half-heartedly support variable positions, but do not at all
6237 support variable lengths. */
6239 static const_rtx
6240 expand_field_assignment (const_rtx x)
6242 rtx inner;
6243 rtx pos; /* Always counts from low bit. */
6244 int len;
6245 rtx mask, cleared, masked;
6246 enum machine_mode compute_mode;
6248 /* Loop until we find something we can't simplify. */
6249 while (1)
6251 if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == STRICT_LOW_PART
6252 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)) == SUBREG)
6254 inner = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0));
6255 len = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)));
6256 pos = GEN_INT (subreg_lsb (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0)));
6258 else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == ZERO_EXTRACT
6259 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 1)) == CONST_INT)
6261 inner = XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 0);
6262 len = INTVAL (XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 1));
6263 pos = XEXP (SET_DEST (x), 2);
6265 /* A constant position should stay within the width of INNER. */
6266 if (GET_CODE (pos) == CONST_INT
6267 && INTVAL (pos) + len > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner)))
6268 break;
6270 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6272 if (GET_CODE (pos) == CONST_INT)
6273 pos = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) - len
6274 - INTVAL (pos));
6275 else if (GET_CODE (pos) == MINUS
6276 && GET_CODE (XEXP (pos, 1)) == CONST_INT
6277 && (INTVAL (XEXP (pos, 1))
6278 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (inner)) - len))
6279 /* If position is ADJUST - X, new position is X. */
6280 pos = XEXP (pos, 0);
6281 else
6282 pos = simplify_gen_binary (MINUS, GET_MODE (pos),
6283 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (
6284 GET_MODE (inner))
6285 - len),
6286 pos);
6290 /* A SUBREG between two modes that occupy the same numbers of words
6291 can be done by moving the SUBREG to the source. */
6292 else if (GET_CODE (SET_DEST (x)) == SUBREG
6293 /* We need SUBREGs to compute nonzero_bits properly. */
6294 && nonzero_sign_valid
6295 && (((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SET_DEST (x)))
6296 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
6297 == ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x))))
6298 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD)))
6300 x = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x)),
6301 gen_lowpart
6302 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (x))),
6303 SET_SRC (x)));
6304 continue;
6306 else
6307 break;
6309 while (GET_CODE (inner) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (inner))
6310 inner = SUBREG_REG (inner);
6312 compute_mode = GET_MODE (inner);
6314 /* Don't attempt bitwise arithmetic on non scalar integer modes. */
6315 if (! SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (compute_mode))
6317 enum machine_mode imode;
6319 /* Don't do anything for vector or complex integral types. */
6320 if (! FLOAT_MODE_P (compute_mode))
6321 break;
6323 /* Try to find an integral mode to pun with. */
6324 imode = mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (compute_mode), MODE_INT, 0);
6325 if (imode == BLKmode)
6326 break;
6328 compute_mode = imode;
6329 inner = gen_lowpart (imode, inner);
6332 /* Compute a mask of LEN bits, if we can do this on the host machine. */
6333 if (len >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
6334 break;
6336 /* Now compute the equivalent expression. Make a copy of INNER
6337 for the SET_DEST in case it is a MEM into which we will substitute;
6338 we don't want shared RTL in that case. */
6339 mask = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1);
6340 cleared = simplify_gen_binary (AND, compute_mode,
6341 simplify_gen_unary (NOT, compute_mode,
6342 simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT,
6343 compute_mode,
6344 mask, pos),
6345 compute_mode),
6346 inner);
6347 masked = simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT, compute_mode,
6348 simplify_gen_binary (
6349 AND, compute_mode,
6350 gen_lowpart (compute_mode, SET_SRC (x)),
6351 mask),
6352 pos);
6354 x = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, copy_rtx (inner),
6355 simplify_gen_binary (IOR, compute_mode,
6356 cleared, masked));
6359 return x;
6362 /* Return an RTX for a reference to LEN bits of INNER. If POS_RTX is nonzero,
6363 it is an RTX that represents a variable starting position; otherwise,
6364 POS is the (constant) starting bit position (counted from the LSB).
6366 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero for an unsigned reference and zero for a
6367 signed reference.
6369 IN_DEST is nonzero if this is a reference in the destination of a
6370 SET. This is used when a ZERO_ or SIGN_EXTRACT isn't needed. If nonzero,
6371 a STRICT_LOW_PART will be used, if zero, ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND will
6372 be used.
6374 IN_COMPARE is nonzero if we are in a COMPARE. This means that a
6375 ZERO_EXTRACT should be built even for bits starting at bit 0.
6377 MODE is the desired mode of the result (if IN_DEST == 0).
6379 The result is an RTX for the extraction or NULL_RTX if the target
6380 can't handle it. */
6382 static rtx
6383 make_extraction (enum machine_mode mode, rtx inner, HOST_WIDE_INT pos,
6384 rtx pos_rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, int unsignedp,
6385 int in_dest, int in_compare)
6387 /* This mode describes the size of the storage area
6388 to fetch the overall value from. Within that, we
6389 ignore the POS lowest bits, etc. */
6390 enum machine_mode is_mode = GET_MODE (inner);
6391 enum machine_mode inner_mode;
6392 enum machine_mode wanted_inner_mode;
6393 enum machine_mode wanted_inner_reg_mode = word_mode;
6394 enum machine_mode pos_mode = word_mode;
6395 enum machine_mode extraction_mode = word_mode;
6396 enum machine_mode tmode = mode_for_size (len, MODE_INT, 1);
6397 rtx new = 0;
6398 rtx orig_pos_rtx = pos_rtx;
6399 HOST_WIDE_INT orig_pos;
6401 if (GET_CODE (inner) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (inner))
6403 /* If going from (subreg:SI (mem:QI ...)) to (mem:QI ...),
6404 consider just the QI as the memory to extract from.
6405 The subreg adds or removes high bits; its mode is
6406 irrelevant to the meaning of this extraction,
6407 since POS and LEN count from the lsb. */
6408 if (MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (inner)))
6409 is_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner));
6410 inner = SUBREG_REG (inner);
6412 else if (GET_CODE (inner) == ASHIFT
6413 && GET_CODE (XEXP (inner, 1)) == CONST_INT
6414 && pos_rtx == 0 && pos == 0
6415 && len > (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (inner, 1)))
6417 /* We're extracting the least significant bits of an rtx
6418 (ashift X (const_int C)), where LEN > C. Extract the
6419 least significant (LEN - C) bits of X, giving an rtx
6420 whose mode is MODE, then shift it left C times. */
6421 new = make_extraction (mode, XEXP (inner, 0),
6422 0, 0, len - INTVAL (XEXP (inner, 1)),
6423 unsignedp, in_dest, in_compare);
6424 if (new != 0)
6425 return gen_rtx_ASHIFT (mode, new, XEXP (inner, 1));
6428 inner_mode = GET_MODE (inner);
6430 if (pos_rtx && GET_CODE (pos_rtx) == CONST_INT)
6431 pos = INTVAL (pos_rtx), pos_rtx = 0;
6433 /* See if this can be done without an extraction. We never can if the
6434 width of the field is not the same as that of some integer mode. For
6435 registers, we can only avoid the extraction if the position is at the
6436 low-order bit and this is either not in the destination or we have the
6437 appropriate STRICT_LOW_PART operation available.
6439 For MEM, we can avoid an extract if the field starts on an appropriate
6440 boundary and we can change the mode of the memory reference. */
6442 if (tmode != BLKmode
6443 && ((pos_rtx == 0 && (pos % BITS_PER_WORD) == 0
6444 && !MEM_P (inner)
6445 && (inner_mode == tmode
6446 || !REG_P (inner)
6447 || TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode),
6448 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode))
6449 || reg_truncated_to_mode (tmode, inner))
6450 && (! in_dest
6451 || (REG_P (inner)
6452 && have_insn_for (STRICT_LOW_PART, tmode))))
6453 || (MEM_P (inner) && pos_rtx == 0
6454 && (pos
6455 % (STRICT_ALIGNMENT ? GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode)
6456 : BITS_PER_UNIT)) == 0
6457 /* We can't do this if we are widening INNER_MODE (it
6458 may not be aligned, for one thing). */
6459 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode) >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode)
6460 && (inner_mode == tmode
6461 || (! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (inner, 0))
6462 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (inner))))))
6464 /* If INNER is a MEM, make a new MEM that encompasses just the desired
6465 field. If the original and current mode are the same, we need not
6466 adjust the offset. Otherwise, we do if bytes big endian.
6468 If INNER is not a MEM, get a piece consisting of just the field
6469 of interest (in this case POS % BITS_PER_WORD must be 0). */
6471 if (MEM_P (inner))
6473 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
6475 /* POS counts from lsb, but make OFFSET count in memory order. */
6476 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
6477 offset = (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (is_mode) - len - pos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
6478 else
6479 offset = pos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
6481 new = adjust_address_nv (inner, tmode, offset);
6483 else if (REG_P (inner))
6485 if (tmode != inner_mode)
6487 /* We can't call gen_lowpart in a DEST since we
6488 always want a SUBREG (see below) and it would sometimes
6489 return a new hard register. */
6490 if (pos || in_dest)
6492 HOST_WIDE_INT final_word = pos / BITS_PER_WORD;
6494 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
6495 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) > UNITS_PER_WORD)
6496 final_word = ((GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
6497 - GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode))
6498 / UNITS_PER_WORD) - final_word;
6500 final_word *= UNITS_PER_WORD;
6501 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN &&
6502 GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode))
6503 final_word += (GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode)
6504 - GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode)) % UNITS_PER_WORD;
6506 /* Avoid creating invalid subregs, for example when
6507 simplifying (x>>32)&255. */
6508 if (!validate_subreg (tmode, inner_mode, inner, final_word))
6509 return NULL_RTX;
6511 new = gen_rtx_SUBREG (tmode, inner, final_word);
6513 else
6514 new = gen_lowpart (tmode, inner);
6516 else
6517 new = inner;
6519 else
6520 new = force_to_mode (inner, tmode,
6521 len >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6522 ? ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0
6523 : ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1,
6526 /* If this extraction is going into the destination of a SET,
6527 make a STRICT_LOW_PART unless we made a MEM. */
6529 if (in_dest)
6530 return (MEM_P (new) ? new
6531 : (GET_CODE (new) != SUBREG
6532 ? gen_rtx_CLOBBER (tmode, const0_rtx)
6533 : gen_rtx_STRICT_LOW_PART (VOIDmode, new)));
6535 if (mode == tmode)
6536 return new;
6538 if (GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT)
6539 return gen_int_mode (INTVAL (new), mode);
6541 /* If we know that no extraneous bits are set, and that the high
6542 bit is not set, convert the extraction to the cheaper of
6543 sign and zero extension, that are equivalent in these cases. */
6544 if (flag_expensive_optimizations
6545 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6546 && ((nonzero_bits (new, tmode)
6547 & ~(((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
6548 GET_MODE_MASK (tmode))
6549 >> 1))
6550 == 0)))
6552 rtx temp = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, new);
6553 rtx temp1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (mode, new);
6555 /* Prefer ZERO_EXTENSION, since it gives more information to
6556 backends. */
6557 if (rtx_cost (temp, SET) <= rtx_cost (temp1, SET))
6558 return temp;
6559 return temp1;
6562 /* Otherwise, sign- or zero-extend unless we already are in the
6563 proper mode. */
6565 return (gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND,
6566 mode, new));
6569 /* Unless this is a COMPARE or we have a funny memory reference,
6570 don't do anything with zero-extending field extracts starting at
6571 the low-order bit since they are simple AND operations. */
6572 if (pos_rtx == 0 && pos == 0 && ! in_dest
6573 && ! in_compare && unsignedp)
6574 return 0;
6576 /* Unless INNER is not MEM, reject this if we would be spanning bytes or
6577 if the position is not a constant and the length is not 1. In all
6578 other cases, we would only be going outside our object in cases when
6579 an original shift would have been undefined. */
6580 if (MEM_P (inner)
6581 && ((pos_rtx == 0 && pos + len > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (is_mode))
6582 || (pos_rtx != 0 && len != 1)))
6583 return 0;
6585 /* Get the mode to use should INNER not be a MEM, the mode for the position,
6586 and the mode for the result. */
6587 if (in_dest && mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, -1) != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
6589 wanted_inner_reg_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, 0);
6590 pos_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, 2);
6591 extraction_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_insv, 3);
6594 if (! in_dest && unsignedp
6595 && mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, -1) != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
6597 wanted_inner_reg_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, 1);
6598 pos_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, 3);
6599 extraction_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, 0);
6602 if (! in_dest && ! unsignedp
6603 && mode_for_extraction (EP_extv, -1) != MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
6605 wanted_inner_reg_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extv, 1);
6606 pos_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extv, 3);
6607 extraction_mode = mode_for_extraction (EP_extv, 0);
6610 /* Never narrow an object, since that might not be safe. */
6612 if (mode != VOIDmode
6613 && GET_MODE_SIZE (extraction_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
6614 extraction_mode = mode;
6616 if (pos_rtx && GET_MODE (pos_rtx) != VOIDmode
6617 && GET_MODE_SIZE (pos_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (pos_rtx)))
6618 pos_mode = GET_MODE (pos_rtx);
6620 /* If this is not from memory, the desired mode is the preferred mode
6621 for an extraction pattern's first input operand, or word_mode if there
6622 is none. */
6623 if (!MEM_P (inner))
6624 wanted_inner_mode = wanted_inner_reg_mode;
6625 else
6627 /* Be careful not to go beyond the extracted object and maintain the
6628 natural alignment of the memory. */
6629 wanted_inner_mode = smallest_mode_for_size (len, MODE_INT);
6630 while (pos % GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode) + len
6631 > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode))
6633 wanted_inner_mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (wanted_inner_mode);
6634 gcc_assert (wanted_inner_mode != VOIDmode);
6637 /* If we have to change the mode of memory and cannot, the desired mode
6638 is EXTRACTION_MODE. */
6639 if (inner_mode != wanted_inner_mode
6640 && (mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (inner, 0))
6641 || MEM_VOLATILE_P (inner)
6642 || pos_rtx))
6643 wanted_inner_mode = extraction_mode;
6646 orig_pos = pos;
6648 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
6650 /* POS is passed as if BITS_BIG_ENDIAN == 0, so we need to convert it to
6651 BITS_BIG_ENDIAN style. If position is constant, compute new
6652 position. Otherwise, build subtraction.
6653 Note that POS is relative to the mode of the original argument.
6654 If it's a MEM we need to recompute POS relative to that.
6655 However, if we're extracting from (or inserting into) a register,
6656 we want to recompute POS relative to wanted_inner_mode. */
6657 int width = (MEM_P (inner)
6658 ? GET_MODE_BITSIZE (is_mode)
6659 : GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode));
6661 if (pos_rtx == 0)
6662 pos = width - len - pos;
6663 else
6664 pos_rtx
6665 = gen_rtx_MINUS (GET_MODE (pos_rtx), GEN_INT (width - len), pos_rtx);
6666 /* POS may be less than 0 now, but we check for that below.
6667 Note that it can only be less than 0 if !MEM_P (inner). */
6670 /* If INNER has a wider mode, and this is a constant extraction, try to
6671 make it smaller and adjust the byte to point to the byte containing
6672 the value. */
6673 if (wanted_inner_mode != VOIDmode
6674 && inner_mode != wanted_inner_mode
6675 && ! pos_rtx
6676 && GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_inner_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode)
6677 && MEM_P (inner)
6678 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (inner, 0))
6679 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (inner))
6681 int offset = 0;
6683 /* The computations below will be correct if the machine is big
6684 endian in both bits and bytes or little endian in bits and bytes.
6685 If it is mixed, we must adjust. */
6687 /* If bytes are big endian and we had a paradoxical SUBREG, we must
6688 adjust OFFSET to compensate. */
6689 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
6690 && GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode))
6691 offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (inner_mode);
6693 /* We can now move to the desired byte. */
6694 offset += (pos / GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode))
6695 * GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_inner_mode);
6696 pos %= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode);
6698 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
6699 && is_mode != wanted_inner_mode)
6700 offset = (GET_MODE_SIZE (is_mode)
6701 - GET_MODE_SIZE (wanted_inner_mode) - offset);
6703 inner = adjust_address_nv (inner, wanted_inner_mode, offset);
6706 /* If INNER is not memory, we can always get it into the proper mode. If we
6707 are changing its mode, POS must be a constant and smaller than the size
6708 of the new mode. */
6709 else if (!MEM_P (inner))
6711 if (GET_MODE (inner) != wanted_inner_mode
6712 && (pos_rtx != 0
6713 || orig_pos + len > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (wanted_inner_mode)))
6714 return 0;
6716 if (orig_pos < 0)
6717 return 0;
6719 inner = force_to_mode (inner, wanted_inner_mode,
6720 pos_rtx
6721 || len + orig_pos >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6722 ? ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0
6723 : ((((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1)
6724 << orig_pos),
6728 /* Adjust mode of POS_RTX, if needed. If we want a wider mode, we
6729 have to zero extend. Otherwise, we can just use a SUBREG. */
6730 if (pos_rtx != 0
6731 && GET_MODE_SIZE (pos_mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (pos_rtx)))
6733 rtx temp = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (pos_mode, pos_rtx);
6735 /* If we know that no extraneous bits are set, and that the high
6736 bit is not set, convert extraction to cheaper one - either
6737 SIGN_EXTENSION or ZERO_EXTENSION, that are equivalent in these
6738 cases. */
6739 if (flag_expensive_optimizations
6740 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (pos_rtx)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6741 && ((nonzero_bits (pos_rtx, GET_MODE (pos_rtx))
6742 & ~(((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
6743 GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (pos_rtx)))
6744 >> 1))
6745 == 0)))
6747 rtx temp1 = gen_rtx_SIGN_EXTEND (pos_mode, pos_rtx);
6749 /* Prefer ZERO_EXTENSION, since it gives more information to
6750 backends. */
6751 if (rtx_cost (temp1, SET) < rtx_cost (temp, SET))
6752 temp = temp1;
6754 pos_rtx = temp;
6756 else if (pos_rtx != 0
6757 && GET_MODE_SIZE (pos_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (pos_rtx)))
6758 pos_rtx = gen_lowpart (pos_mode, pos_rtx);
6760 /* Make POS_RTX unless we already have it and it is correct. If we don't
6761 have a POS_RTX but we do have an ORIG_POS_RTX, the latter must
6762 be a CONST_INT. */
6763 if (pos_rtx == 0 && orig_pos_rtx != 0 && INTVAL (orig_pos_rtx) == pos)
6764 pos_rtx = orig_pos_rtx;
6766 else if (pos_rtx == 0)
6767 pos_rtx = GEN_INT (pos);
6769 /* Make the required operation. See if we can use existing rtx. */
6770 new = gen_rtx_fmt_eee (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTRACT : SIGN_EXTRACT,
6771 extraction_mode, inner, GEN_INT (len), pos_rtx);
6772 if (! in_dest)
6773 new = gen_lowpart (mode, new);
6775 return new;
6778 /* See if X contains an ASHIFT of COUNT or more bits that can be commuted
6779 with any other operations in X. Return X without that shift if so. */
6781 static rtx
6782 extract_left_shift (rtx x, int count)
6784 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
6785 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
6786 rtx tem;
6788 switch (code)
6790 case ASHIFT:
6791 /* This is the shift itself. If it is wide enough, we will return
6792 either the value being shifted if the shift count is equal to
6793 COUNT or a shift for the difference. */
6794 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
6795 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= count)
6796 return simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode, XEXP (x, 0),
6797 INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) - count);
6798 break;
6800 case NEG: case NOT:
6801 if ((tem = extract_left_shift (XEXP (x, 0), count)) != 0)
6802 return simplify_gen_unary (code, mode, tem, mode);
6804 break;
6806 case PLUS: case IOR: case XOR: case AND:
6807 /* If we can safely shift this constant and we find the inner shift,
6808 make a new operation. */
6809 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
6810 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & ((((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << count)) - 1)) == 0
6811 && (tem = extract_left_shift (XEXP (x, 0), count)) != 0)
6812 return simplify_gen_binary (code, mode, tem,
6813 GEN_INT (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >> count));
6815 break;
6817 default:
6818 break;
6821 return 0;
6824 /* Look at the expression rooted at X. Look for expressions
6825 equivalent to ZERO_EXTRACT, SIGN_EXTRACT, ZERO_EXTEND, SIGN_EXTEND.
6826 Form these expressions.
6828 Return the new rtx, usually just X.
6830 Also, for machines like the VAX that don't have logical shift insns,
6831 try to convert logical to arithmetic shift operations in cases where
6832 they are equivalent. This undoes the canonicalizations to logical
6833 shifts done elsewhere.
6835 We try, as much as possible, to re-use rtl expressions to save memory.
6837 IN_CODE says what kind of expression we are processing. Normally, it is
6838 SET. In a memory address (inside a MEM, PLUS or minus, the latter two
6839 being kludges), it is MEM. When processing the arguments of a comparison
6840 or a COMPARE against zero, it is COMPARE. */
6842 static rtx
6843 make_compound_operation (rtx x, enum rtx_code in_code)
6845 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
6846 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
6847 int mode_width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6848 rtx rhs, lhs;
6849 enum rtx_code next_code;
6850 int i;
6851 rtx new = 0;
6852 rtx tem;
6853 const char *fmt;
6855 /* Select the code to be used in recursive calls. Once we are inside an
6856 address, we stay there. If we have a comparison, set to COMPARE,
6857 but once inside, go back to our default of SET. */
6859 next_code = (code == MEM || code == PLUS || code == MINUS ? MEM
6860 : ((code == COMPARE || COMPARISON_P (x))
6861 && XEXP (x, 1) == const0_rtx) ? COMPARE
6862 : in_code == COMPARE ? SET : in_code);
6864 /* Process depending on the code of this operation. If NEW is set
6865 nonzero, it will be returned. */
6867 switch (code)
6869 case ASHIFT:
6870 /* Convert shifts by constants into multiplications if inside
6871 an address. */
6872 if (in_code == MEM && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
6873 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6874 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0)
6876 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0), next_code);
6877 new = gen_rtx_MULT (mode, new,
6878 GEN_INT ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
6879 << INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))));
6881 break;
6883 case AND:
6884 /* If the second operand is not a constant, we can't do anything
6885 with it. */
6886 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != CONST_INT)
6887 break;
6889 /* If the constant is a power of two minus one and the first operand
6890 is a logical right shift, make an extraction. */
6891 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
6892 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + 1)) >= 0)
6894 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), next_code);
6895 new = make_extraction (mode, new, 0, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1), i, 1,
6896 0, in_code == COMPARE);
6899 /* Same as previous, but for (subreg (lshiftrt ...)) in first op. */
6900 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == SUBREG
6901 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (x, 0))
6902 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))) == LSHIFTRT
6903 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + 1)) >= 0)
6905 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)), 0),
6906 next_code);
6907 new = make_extraction (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0))), new, 0,
6908 XEXP (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (x, 0)), 1), i, 1,
6909 0, in_code == COMPARE);
6911 /* Same as previous, but for (xor/ior (lshiftrt...) (lshiftrt...)). */
6912 else if ((GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == XOR
6913 || GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == IOR)
6914 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0)) == LSHIFTRT
6915 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == LSHIFTRT
6916 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + 1)) >= 0)
6918 /* Apply the distributive law, and then try to make extractions. */
6919 new = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)), mode,
6920 gen_rtx_AND (mode, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0),
6921 XEXP (x, 1)),
6922 gen_rtx_AND (mode, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1),
6923 XEXP (x, 1)));
6924 new = make_compound_operation (new, in_code);
6927 /* If we are have (and (rotate X C) M) and C is larger than the number
6928 of bits in M, this is an extraction. */
6930 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ROTATE
6931 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
6932 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + 1)) >= 0
6933 && i <= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)))
6935 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), next_code);
6936 new = make_extraction (mode, new,
6937 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
6938 - INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))),
6939 NULL_RTX, i, 1, 0, in_code == COMPARE);
6942 /* On machines without logical shifts, if the operand of the AND is
6943 a logical shift and our mask turns off all the propagated sign
6944 bits, we can replace the logical shift with an arithmetic shift. */
6945 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
6946 && !have_insn_for (LSHIFTRT, mode)
6947 && have_insn_for (ASHIFTRT, mode)
6948 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
6949 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) >= 0
6950 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6951 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
6953 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
6955 mask >>= INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
6956 if ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & ~mask) == 0)
6957 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0),
6958 gen_rtx_ASHIFTRT (mode,
6959 make_compound_operation
6960 (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), next_code),
6961 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)));
6964 /* If the constant is one less than a power of two, this might be
6965 representable by an extraction even if no shift is present.
6966 If it doesn't end up being a ZERO_EXTEND, we will ignore it unless
6967 we are in a COMPARE. */
6968 else if ((i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + 1)) >= 0)
6969 new = make_extraction (mode,
6970 make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0),
6971 next_code),
6972 0, NULL_RTX, i, 1, 0, in_code == COMPARE);
6974 /* If we are in a comparison and this is an AND with a power of two,
6975 convert this into the appropriate bit extract. */
6976 else if (in_code == COMPARE
6977 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)))) >= 0)
6978 new = make_extraction (mode,
6979 make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0),
6980 next_code),
6981 i, NULL_RTX, 1, 1, 0, 1);
6983 break;
6985 case LSHIFTRT:
6986 /* If the sign bit is known to be zero, replace this with an
6987 arithmetic shift. */
6988 if (have_insn_for (ASHIFTRT, mode)
6989 && ! have_insn_for (LSHIFTRT, mode)
6990 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
6991 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode) & (1 << (mode_width - 1))) == 0)
6993 new = gen_rtx_ASHIFTRT (mode,
6994 make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, 0),
6995 next_code),
6996 XEXP (x, 1));
6997 break;
7000 /* ... fall through ... */
7002 case ASHIFTRT:
7003 lhs = XEXP (x, 0);
7004 rhs = XEXP (x, 1);
7006 /* If we have (ashiftrt (ashift foo C1) C2) with C2 >= C1,
7007 this is a SIGN_EXTRACT. */
7008 if (GET_CODE (rhs) == CONST_INT
7009 && GET_CODE (lhs) == ASHIFT
7010 && GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
7011 && INTVAL (rhs) >= INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)))
7013 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (lhs, 0), next_code);
7014 new = make_extraction (mode, new,
7015 INTVAL (rhs) - INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)),
7016 NULL_RTX, mode_width - INTVAL (rhs),
7017 code == LSHIFTRT, 0, in_code == COMPARE);
7018 break;
7021 /* See if we have operations between an ASHIFTRT and an ASHIFT.
7022 If so, try to merge the shifts into a SIGN_EXTEND. We could
7023 also do this for some cases of SIGN_EXTRACT, but it doesn't
7024 seem worth the effort; the case checked for occurs on Alpha. */
7026 if (!OBJECT_P (lhs)
7027 && ! (GET_CODE (lhs) == SUBREG
7028 && (OBJECT_P (SUBREG_REG (lhs))))
7029 && GET_CODE (rhs) == CONST_INT
7030 && INTVAL (rhs) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7031 && (new = extract_left_shift (lhs, INTVAL (rhs))) != 0)
7032 new = make_extraction (mode, make_compound_operation (new, next_code),
7033 0, NULL_RTX, mode_width - INTVAL (rhs),
7034 code == LSHIFTRT, 0, in_code == COMPARE);
7036 break;
7038 case SUBREG:
7039 /* Call ourselves recursively on the inner expression. If we are
7040 narrowing the object and it has a different RTL code from
7041 what it originally did, do this SUBREG as a force_to_mode. */
7043 tem = make_compound_operation (SUBREG_REG (x), in_code);
7046 rtx simplified;
7047 simplified = simplify_subreg (GET_MODE (x), tem, GET_MODE (tem),
7048 SUBREG_BYTE (x));
7050 if (simplified)
7051 tem = simplified;
7053 if (GET_CODE (tem) != GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (x))
7054 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (tem))
7055 && subreg_lowpart_p (x))
7057 rtx newer = force_to_mode (tem, mode, ~(HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
7060 /* If we have something other than a SUBREG, we might have
7061 done an expansion, so rerun ourselves. */
7062 if (GET_CODE (newer) != SUBREG)
7063 newer = make_compound_operation (newer, in_code);
7065 return newer;
7068 if (simplified)
7069 return tem;
7071 break;
7073 default:
7074 break;
7077 if (new)
7079 x = gen_lowpart (mode, new);
7080 code = GET_CODE (x);
7083 /* Now recursively process each operand of this operation. */
7084 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
7085 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (code); i++)
7086 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
7088 new = make_compound_operation (XEXP (x, i), next_code);
7089 SUBST (XEXP (x, i), new);
7092 /* If this is a commutative operation, the changes to the operands
7093 may have made it noncanonical. */
7094 if (COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (x)
7095 && swap_commutative_operands_p (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1)))
7097 tem = XEXP (x, 0);
7098 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
7099 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1), tem);
7102 return x;
7105 /* Given M see if it is a value that would select a field of bits
7106 within an item, but not the entire word. Return -1 if not.
7107 Otherwise, return the starting position of the field, where 0 is the
7108 low-order bit.
7110 *PLEN is set to the length of the field. */
7112 static int
7113 get_pos_from_mask (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT m, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *plen)
7115 /* Get the bit number of the first 1 bit from the right, -1 if none. */
7116 int pos = exact_log2 (m & -m);
7117 int len = 0;
7119 if (pos >= 0)
7120 /* Now shift off the low-order zero bits and see if we have a
7121 power of two minus 1. */
7122 len = exact_log2 ((m >> pos) + 1);
7124 if (len <= 0)
7125 pos = -1;
7127 *plen = len;
7128 return pos;
7131 /* If X refers to a register that equals REG in value, replace these
7132 references with REG. */
7133 static rtx
7134 canon_reg_for_combine (rtx x, rtx reg)
7136 rtx op0, op1, op2;
7137 const char *fmt;
7138 int i;
7139 bool copied;
7141 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
7142 switch (GET_RTX_CLASS (code))
7144 case RTX_UNARY:
7145 op0 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 0), reg);
7146 if (op0 != XEXP (x, 0))
7147 return simplify_gen_unary (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), op0,
7148 GET_MODE (reg));
7149 break;
7151 case RTX_BIN_ARITH:
7152 case RTX_COMM_ARITH:
7153 op0 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 0), reg);
7154 op1 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 1), reg);
7155 if (op0 != XEXP (x, 0) || op1 != XEXP (x, 1))
7156 return simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x), op0, op1);
7157 break;
7159 case RTX_COMPARE:
7160 case RTX_COMM_COMPARE:
7161 op0 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 0), reg);
7162 op1 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 1), reg);
7163 if (op0 != XEXP (x, 0) || op1 != XEXP (x, 1))
7164 return simplify_gen_relational (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x),
7165 GET_MODE (op0), op0, op1);
7166 break;
7168 case RTX_TERNARY:
7169 case RTX_BITFIELD_OPS:
7170 op0 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 0), reg);
7171 op1 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 1), reg);
7172 op2 = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, 2), reg);
7173 if (op0 != XEXP (x, 0) || op1 != XEXP (x, 1) || op2 != XEXP (x, 2))
7174 return simplify_gen_ternary (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x),
7175 GET_MODE (op0), op0, op1, op2);
7177 case RTX_OBJ:
7178 if (REG_P (x))
7180 if (rtx_equal_p (get_last_value (reg), x)
7181 || rtx_equal_p (reg, get_last_value (x)))
7182 return reg;
7183 else
7184 break;
7187 /* fall through */
7189 default:
7190 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
7191 copied = false;
7192 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
7193 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
7195 rtx op = canon_reg_for_combine (XEXP (x, i), reg);
7196 if (op != XEXP (x, i))
7198 if (!copied)
7200 copied = true;
7201 x = copy_rtx (x);
7203 XEXP (x, i) = op;
7206 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
7208 int j;
7209 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
7211 rtx op = canon_reg_for_combine (XVECEXP (x, i, j), reg);
7212 if (op != XVECEXP (x, i, j))
7214 if (!copied)
7216 copied = true;
7217 x = copy_rtx (x);
7219 XVECEXP (x, i, j) = op;
7224 break;
7227 return x;
7230 /* Return X converted to MODE. If the value is already truncated to
7231 MODE we can just return a subreg even though in the general case we
7232 would need an explicit truncation. */
7234 static rtx
7235 gen_lowpart_or_truncate (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
7237 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
7238 || TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
7239 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7240 || (REG_P (x) && reg_truncated_to_mode (mode, x)))
7241 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
7242 else
7243 return simplify_gen_unary (TRUNCATE, mode, x, GET_MODE (x));
7246 /* See if X can be simplified knowing that we will only refer to it in
7247 MODE and will only refer to those bits that are nonzero in MASK.
7248 If other bits are being computed or if masking operations are done
7249 that select a superset of the bits in MASK, they can sometimes be
7250 ignored.
7252 Return a possibly simplified expression, but always convert X to
7253 MODE. If X is a CONST_INT, AND the CONST_INT with MASK.
7255 If JUST_SELECT is nonzero, don't optimize by noticing that bits in MASK
7256 are all off in X. This is used when X will be complemented, by either
7257 NOT, NEG, or XOR. */
7259 static rtx
7260 force_to_mode (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask,
7261 int just_select)
7263 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
7264 int next_select = just_select || code == XOR || code == NOT || code == NEG;
7265 enum machine_mode op_mode;
7266 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT fuller_mask, nonzero;
7267 rtx op0, op1, temp;
7269 /* If this is a CALL or ASM_OPERANDS, don't do anything. Some of the
7270 code below will do the wrong thing since the mode of such an
7271 expression is VOIDmode.
7273 Also do nothing if X is a CLOBBER; this can happen if X was
7274 the return value from a call to gen_lowpart. */
7275 if (code == CALL || code == ASM_OPERANDS || code == CLOBBER)
7276 return x;
7278 /* We want to perform the operation is its present mode unless we know
7279 that the operation is valid in MODE, in which case we do the operation
7280 in MODE. */
7281 op_mode = ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x))
7282 && have_insn_for (code, mode))
7283 ? mode : GET_MODE (x));
7285 /* It is not valid to do a right-shift in a narrower mode
7286 than the one it came in with. */
7287 if ((code == LSHIFTRT || code == ASHIFTRT)
7288 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7289 op_mode = GET_MODE (x);
7291 /* Truncate MASK to fit OP_MODE. */
7292 if (op_mode)
7293 mask &= GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
7295 /* When we have an arithmetic operation, or a shift whose count we
7296 do not know, we need to assume that all bits up to the highest-order
7297 bit in MASK will be needed. This is how we form such a mask. */
7298 if (mask & ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1)))
7299 fuller_mask = ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0;
7300 else
7301 fuller_mask = (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (floor_log2 (mask) + 1))
7302 - 1);
7304 /* Determine what bits of X are guaranteed to be (non)zero. */
7305 nonzero = nonzero_bits (x, mode);
7307 /* If none of the bits in X are needed, return a zero. */
7308 if (!just_select && (nonzero & mask) == 0 && !side_effects_p (x))
7309 x = const0_rtx;
7311 /* If X is a CONST_INT, return a new one. Do this here since the
7312 test below will fail. */
7313 if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT)
7315 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode))
7316 return gen_int_mode (INTVAL (x) & mask, mode);
7317 else
7319 x = GEN_INT (INTVAL (x) & mask);
7320 return gen_lowpart_common (mode, x);
7324 /* If X is narrower than MODE and we want all the bits in X's mode, just
7325 get X in the proper mode. */
7326 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)) < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
7327 && (GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x)) & ~mask) == 0)
7328 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
7330 switch (code)
7332 case CLOBBER:
7333 /* If X is a (clobber (const_int)), return it since we know we are
7334 generating something that won't match. */
7335 return x;
7337 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7338 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7339 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
7340 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
7341 x = expand_compound_operation (x);
7342 if (GET_CODE (x) != code)
7343 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7344 break;
7346 case SUBREG:
7347 if (subreg_lowpart_p (x)
7348 /* We can ignore the effect of this SUBREG if it narrows the mode or
7349 if the constant masks to zero all the bits the mode doesn't
7350 have. */
7351 && ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
7352 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
7353 || (0 == (mask
7354 & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x))
7355 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)))))))
7356 return force_to_mode (SUBREG_REG (x), mode, mask, next_select);
7357 break;
7359 case AND:
7360 /* If this is an AND with a constant, convert it into an AND
7361 whose constant is the AND of that constant with MASK. If it
7362 remains an AND of MASK, delete it since it is redundant. */
7364 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT)
7366 x = simplify_and_const_int (x, op_mode, XEXP (x, 0),
7367 mask & INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
7369 /* If X is still an AND, see if it is an AND with a mask that
7370 is just some low-order bits. If so, and it is MASK, we don't
7371 need it. */
7373 if (GET_CODE (x) == AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7374 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x)))
7375 == mask))
7376 x = XEXP (x, 0);
7378 /* If it remains an AND, try making another AND with the bits
7379 in the mode mask that aren't in MASK turned on. If the
7380 constant in the AND is wide enough, this might make a
7381 cheaper constant. */
7383 if (GET_CODE (x) == AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7384 && GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x)) != mask
7385 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7387 HOST_WIDE_INT cval = (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7388 | (GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x)) & ~mask));
7389 int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x));
7390 rtx y;
7392 /* If MODE is narrower than HOST_WIDE_INT and CVAL is a negative
7393 number, sign extend it. */
7394 if (width > 0 && width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7395 && (cval & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))) != 0)
7396 cval |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << width;
7398 y = simplify_gen_binary (AND, GET_MODE (x),
7399 XEXP (x, 0), GEN_INT (cval));
7400 if (rtx_cost (y, SET) < rtx_cost (x, SET))
7401 x = y;
7404 break;
7407 goto binop;
7409 case PLUS:
7410 /* In (and (plus FOO C1) M), if M is a mask that just turns off
7411 low-order bits (as in an alignment operation) and FOO is already
7412 aligned to that boundary, mask C1 to that boundary as well.
7413 This may eliminate that PLUS and, later, the AND. */
7416 unsigned int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
7417 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT smask = mask;
7419 /* If MODE is narrower than HOST_WIDE_INT and mask is a negative
7420 number, sign extend it. */
7422 if (width < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7423 && (smask & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))) != 0)
7424 smask |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) -1 << width;
7426 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7427 && exact_log2 (- smask) >= 0
7428 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode) & ~smask) == 0
7429 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & ~smask) != 0)
7430 return force_to_mode (plus_constant (XEXP (x, 0),
7431 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & smask)),
7432 mode, smask, next_select);
7435 /* ... fall through ... */
7437 case MULT:
7438 /* For PLUS, MINUS and MULT, we need any bits less significant than the
7439 most significant bit in MASK since carries from those bits will
7440 affect the bits we are interested in. */
7441 mask = fuller_mask;
7442 goto binop;
7444 case MINUS:
7445 /* If X is (minus C Y) where C's least set bit is larger than any bit
7446 in the mask, then we may replace with (neg Y). */
7447 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT
7448 && (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0))
7449 & -INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0))))
7450 > mask))
7452 x = simplify_gen_unary (NEG, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 1),
7453 GET_MODE (x));
7454 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7457 /* Similarly, if C contains every bit in the fuller_mask, then we may
7458 replace with (not Y). */
7459 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == CONST_INT
7460 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0)) | (HOST_WIDE_INT) fuller_mask)
7461 == INTVAL (XEXP (x, 0))))
7463 x = simplify_gen_unary (NOT, GET_MODE (x),
7464 XEXP (x, 1), GET_MODE (x));
7465 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7468 mask = fuller_mask;
7469 goto binop;
7471 case IOR:
7472 case XOR:
7473 /* If X is (ior (lshiftrt FOO C1) C2), try to commute the IOR and
7474 LSHIFTRT so we end up with an (and (lshiftrt (ior ...) ...) ...)
7475 operation which may be a bitfield extraction. Ensure that the
7476 constant we form is not wider than the mode of X. */
7478 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
7479 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
7480 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) >= 0
7481 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7482 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7483 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1))
7484 + floor_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))))
7485 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7486 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7487 & ~nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x))) == 0)
7489 temp = GEN_INT ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) & mask)
7490 << INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)));
7491 temp = simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (x), GET_MODE (x),
7492 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), temp);
7493 x = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x), temp,
7494 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
7495 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7498 binop:
7499 /* For most binary operations, just propagate into the operation and
7500 change the mode if we have an operation of that mode. */
7502 op0 = gen_lowpart_or_truncate (op_mode,
7503 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, mask,
7504 next_select));
7505 op1 = gen_lowpart_or_truncate (op_mode,
7506 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 1), mode, mask,
7507 next_select));
7509 if (op_mode != GET_MODE (x) || op0 != XEXP (x, 0) || op1 != XEXP (x, 1))
7510 x = simplify_gen_binary (code, op_mode, op0, op1);
7511 break;
7513 case ASHIFT:
7514 /* For left shifts, do the same, but just for the first operand.
7515 However, we cannot do anything with shifts where we cannot
7516 guarantee that the counts are smaller than the size of the mode
7517 because such a count will have a different meaning in a
7518 wider mode. */
7520 if (! (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7521 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0
7522 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
7523 && ! (GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 1)) != VOIDmode
7524 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 1), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 1)))
7525 < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))))
7526 break;
7528 /* If the shift count is a constant and we can do arithmetic in
7529 the mode of the shift, refine which bits we need. Otherwise, use the
7530 conservative form of the mask. */
7531 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7532 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0
7533 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode)
7534 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7535 mask >>= INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
7536 else
7537 mask = fuller_mask;
7539 op0 = gen_lowpart_or_truncate (op_mode,
7540 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), op_mode,
7541 mask, next_select));
7543 if (op_mode != GET_MODE (x) || op0 != XEXP (x, 0))
7544 x = simplify_gen_binary (code, op_mode, op0, XEXP (x, 1));
7545 break;
7547 case LSHIFTRT:
7548 /* Here we can only do something if the shift count is a constant,
7549 this shift constant is valid for the host, and we can do arithmetic
7550 in OP_MODE. */
7552 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7553 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7554 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (op_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7556 rtx inner = XEXP (x, 0);
7557 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT inner_mask;
7559 /* Select the mask of the bits we need for the shift operand. */
7560 inner_mask = mask << INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
7562 /* We can only change the mode of the shift if we can do arithmetic
7563 in the mode of the shift and INNER_MASK is no wider than the
7564 width of X's mode. */
7565 if ((inner_mask & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x))) != 0)
7566 op_mode = GET_MODE (x);
7568 inner = force_to_mode (inner, op_mode, inner_mask, next_select);
7570 if (GET_MODE (x) != op_mode || inner != XEXP (x, 0))
7571 x = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, op_mode, inner, XEXP (x, 1));
7574 /* If we have (and (lshiftrt FOO C1) C2) where the combination of the
7575 shift and AND produces only copies of the sign bit (C2 is one less
7576 than a power of two), we can do this with just a shift. */
7578 if (GET_CODE (x) == LSHIFTRT
7579 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7580 /* The shift puts one of the sign bit copies in the least significant
7581 bit. */
7582 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7583 + num_sign_bit_copies (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0))))
7584 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7585 && exact_log2 (mask + 1) >= 0
7586 /* Number of bits left after the shift must be more than the mask
7587 needs. */
7588 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) + exact_log2 (mask + 1))
7589 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7590 /* Must be more sign bit copies than the mask needs. */
7591 && ((int) num_sign_bit_copies (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
7592 >= exact_log2 (mask + 1)))
7593 x = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
7594 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x))
7595 - exact_log2 (mask + 1)));
7597 goto shiftrt;
7599 case ASHIFTRT:
7600 /* If we are just looking for the sign bit, we don't need this shift at
7601 all, even if it has a variable count. */
7602 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7603 && (mask == ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
7604 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - 1))))
7605 return force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, mask, next_select);
7607 /* If this is a shift by a constant, get a mask that contains those bits
7608 that are not copies of the sign bit. We then have two cases: If
7609 MASK only includes those bits, this can be a logical shift, which may
7610 allow simplifications. If MASK is a single-bit field not within
7611 those bits, we are requesting a copy of the sign bit and hence can
7612 shift the sign bit to the appropriate location. */
7614 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0
7615 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7617 int i;
7619 /* If the considered data is wider than HOST_WIDE_INT, we can't
7620 represent a mask for all its bits in a single scalar.
7621 But we only care about the lower bits, so calculate these. */
7623 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7625 nonzero = ~(HOST_WIDE_INT) 0;
7627 /* GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7628 is the number of bits a full-width mask would have set.
7629 We need only shift if these are fewer than nonzero can
7630 hold. If not, we must keep all bits set in nonzero. */
7632 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7633 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7634 nonzero >>= INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7635 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7636 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) ;
7638 else
7640 nonzero = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x));
7641 nonzero >>= INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1));
7644 if ((mask & ~nonzero) == 0)
7646 x = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x),
7647 XEXP (x, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)));
7648 if (GET_CODE (x) != ASHIFTRT)
7649 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7652 else if ((i = exact_log2 (mask)) >= 0)
7654 x = simplify_shift_const
7655 (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
7656 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - 1 - i);
7658 if (GET_CODE (x) != ASHIFTRT)
7659 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7663 /* If MASK is 1, convert this to an LSHIFTRT. This can be done
7664 even if the shift count isn't a constant. */
7665 if (mask == 1)
7666 x = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x),
7667 XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
7669 shiftrt:
7671 /* If this is a zero- or sign-extension operation that just affects bits
7672 we don't care about, remove it. Be sure the call above returned
7673 something that is still a shift. */
7675 if ((GET_CODE (x) == LSHIFTRT || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFTRT)
7676 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7677 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0
7678 && (INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1))
7679 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - (floor_log2 (mask) + 1))
7680 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == ASHIFT
7681 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1) == XEXP (x, 1))
7682 return force_to_mode (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), mode, mask,
7683 next_select);
7685 break;
7687 case ROTATE:
7688 case ROTATERT:
7689 /* If the shift count is constant and we can do computations
7690 in the mode of X, compute where the bits we care about are.
7691 Otherwise, we can't do anything. Don't change the mode of
7692 the shift or propagate MODE into the shift, though. */
7693 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == CONST_INT
7694 && INTVAL (XEXP (x, 1)) >= 0)
7696 temp = simplify_binary_operation (code == ROTATE ? ROTATERT : ROTATE,
7697 GET_MODE (x), GEN_INT (mask),
7698 XEXP (x, 1));
7699 if (temp && GET_CODE (temp) == CONST_INT)
7700 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0),
7701 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), GET_MODE (x),
7702 INTVAL (temp), next_select));
7704 break;
7706 case NEG:
7707 /* If we just want the low-order bit, the NEG isn't needed since it
7708 won't change the low-order bit. */
7709 if (mask == 1)
7710 return force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, mask, just_select);
7712 /* We need any bits less significant than the most significant bit in
7713 MASK since carries from those bits will affect the bits we are
7714 interested in. */
7715 mask = fuller_mask;
7716 goto unop;
7718 case NOT:
7719 /* (not FOO) is (xor FOO CONST), so if FOO is an LSHIFTRT, we can do the
7720 same as the XOR case above. Ensure that the constant we form is not
7721 wider than the mode of X. */
7723 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
7724 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
7725 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) >= 0
7726 && (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) + floor_log2 (mask)
7727 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))
7728 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
7730 temp = gen_int_mode (mask << INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1)),
7731 GET_MODE (x));
7732 temp = simplify_gen_binary (XOR, GET_MODE (x),
7733 XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0), temp);
7734 x = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (x),
7735 temp, XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1));
7737 return force_to_mode (x, mode, mask, next_select);
7740 /* (and (not FOO) CONST) is (not (or FOO (not CONST))), so we must
7741 use the full mask inside the NOT. */
7742 mask = fuller_mask;
7744 unop:
7745 op0 = gen_lowpart_or_truncate (op_mode,
7746 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, mask,
7747 next_select));
7748 if (op_mode != GET_MODE (x) || op0 != XEXP (x, 0))
7749 x = simplify_gen_unary (code, op_mode, op0, op_mode);
7750 break;
7752 case NE:
7753 /* (and (ne FOO 0) CONST) can be (and FOO CONST) if CONST is included
7754 in STORE_FLAG_VALUE and FOO has a single bit that might be nonzero,
7755 which is equal to STORE_FLAG_VALUE. */
7756 if ((mask & ~STORE_FLAG_VALUE) == 0 && XEXP (x, 1) == const0_rtx
7757 && GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == mode
7758 && exact_log2 (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode)) >= 0
7759 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (x, 0), mode)
7760 == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) STORE_FLAG_VALUE))
7761 return force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 0), mode, mask, next_select);
7763 break;
7765 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
7766 /* We have no way of knowing if the IF_THEN_ELSE can itself be
7767 written in a narrower mode. We play it safe and do not do so. */
7769 SUBST (XEXP (x, 1),
7770 gen_lowpart_or_truncate (GET_MODE (x),
7771 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 1), mode,
7772 mask, next_select)));
7773 SUBST (XEXP (x, 2),
7774 gen_lowpart_or_truncate (GET_MODE (x),
7775 force_to_mode (XEXP (x, 2), mode,
7776 mask, next_select)));
7777 break;
7779 default:
7780 break;
7783 /* Ensure we return a value of the proper mode. */
7784 return gen_lowpart_or_truncate (mode, x);
7787 /* Return nonzero if X is an expression that has one of two values depending on
7788 whether some other value is zero or nonzero. In that case, we return the
7789 value that is being tested, *PTRUE is set to the value if the rtx being
7790 returned has a nonzero value, and *PFALSE is set to the other alternative.
7792 If we return zero, we set *PTRUE and *PFALSE to X. */
7794 static rtx
7795 if_then_else_cond (rtx x, rtx *ptrue, rtx *pfalse)
7797 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
7798 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
7799 rtx cond0, cond1, true0, true1, false0, false1;
7800 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nz;
7802 /* If we are comparing a value against zero, we are done. */
7803 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
7804 && XEXP (x, 1) == const0_rtx)
7806 *ptrue = (code == NE) ? const_true_rtx : const0_rtx;
7807 *pfalse = (code == NE) ? const0_rtx : const_true_rtx;
7808 return XEXP (x, 0);
7811 /* If this is a unary operation whose operand has one of two values, apply
7812 our opcode to compute those values. */
7813 else if (UNARY_P (x)
7814 && (cond0 = if_then_else_cond (XEXP (x, 0), &true0, &false0)) != 0)
7816 *ptrue = simplify_gen_unary (code, mode, true0, GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)));
7817 *pfalse = simplify_gen_unary (code, mode, false0,
7818 GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)));
7819 return cond0;
7822 /* If this is a COMPARE, do nothing, since the IF_THEN_ELSE we would
7823 make can't possibly match and would suppress other optimizations. */
7824 else if (code == COMPARE)
7827 /* If this is a binary operation, see if either side has only one of two
7828 values. If either one does or if both do and they are conditional on
7829 the same value, compute the new true and false values. */
7830 else if (BINARY_P (x))
7832 cond0 = if_then_else_cond (XEXP (x, 0), &true0, &false0);
7833 cond1 = if_then_else_cond (XEXP (x, 1), &true1, &false1);
7835 if ((cond0 != 0 || cond1 != 0)
7836 && ! (cond0 != 0 && cond1 != 0 && ! rtx_equal_p (cond0, cond1)))
7838 /* If if_then_else_cond returned zero, then true/false are the
7839 same rtl. We must copy one of them to prevent invalid rtl
7840 sharing. */
7841 if (cond0 == 0)
7842 true0 = copy_rtx (true0);
7843 else if (cond1 == 0)
7844 true1 = copy_rtx (true1);
7846 if (COMPARISON_P (x))
7848 *ptrue = simplify_gen_relational (code, mode, VOIDmode,
7849 true0, true1);
7850 *pfalse = simplify_gen_relational (code, mode, VOIDmode,
7851 false0, false1);
7853 else
7855 *ptrue = simplify_gen_binary (code, mode, true0, true1);
7856 *pfalse = simplify_gen_binary (code, mode, false0, false1);
7859 return cond0 ? cond0 : cond1;
7862 /* See if we have PLUS, IOR, XOR, MINUS or UMAX, where one of the
7863 operands is zero when the other is nonzero, and vice-versa,
7864 and STORE_FLAG_VALUE is 1 or -1. */
7866 if ((STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 || STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
7867 && (code == PLUS || code == IOR || code == XOR || code == MINUS
7868 || code == UMAX)
7869 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == MULT)
7871 rtx op0 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
7872 rtx op1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 1);
7874 cond0 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
7875 cond1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0);
7877 if (COMPARISON_P (cond0)
7878 && COMPARISON_P (cond1)
7879 && ((GET_CODE (cond0) == reversed_comparison_code (cond1, NULL)
7880 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 0), XEXP (cond1, 0))
7881 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 1), XEXP (cond1, 1)))
7882 || ((swap_condition (GET_CODE (cond0))
7883 == reversed_comparison_code (cond1, NULL))
7884 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 0), XEXP (cond1, 1))
7885 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 1), XEXP (cond1, 0))))
7886 && ! side_effects_p (x))
7888 *ptrue = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, mode, op0, const_true_rtx);
7889 *pfalse = simplify_gen_binary (MULT, mode,
7890 (code == MINUS
7891 ? simplify_gen_unary (NEG, mode,
7892 op1, mode)
7893 : op1),
7894 const_true_rtx);
7895 return cond0;
7899 /* Similarly for MULT, AND and UMIN, except that for these the result
7900 is always zero. */
7901 if ((STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 || STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
7902 && (code == MULT || code == AND || code == UMIN)
7903 && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == MULT && GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 1)) == MULT)
7905 cond0 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
7906 cond1 = XEXP (XEXP (x, 1), 0);
7908 if (COMPARISON_P (cond0)
7909 && COMPARISON_P (cond1)
7910 && ((GET_CODE (cond0) == reversed_comparison_code (cond1, NULL)
7911 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 0), XEXP (cond1, 0))
7912 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 1), XEXP (cond1, 1)))
7913 || ((swap_condition (GET_CODE (cond0))
7914 == reversed_comparison_code (cond1, NULL))
7915 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 0), XEXP (cond1, 1))
7916 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (cond0, 1), XEXP (cond1, 0))))
7917 && ! side_effects_p (x))
7919 *ptrue = *pfalse = const0_rtx;
7920 return cond0;
7925 else if (code == IF_THEN_ELSE)
7927 /* If we have IF_THEN_ELSE already, extract the condition and
7928 canonicalize it if it is NE or EQ. */
7929 cond0 = XEXP (x, 0);
7930 *ptrue = XEXP (x, 1), *pfalse = XEXP (x, 2);
7931 if (GET_CODE (cond0) == NE && XEXP (cond0, 1) == const0_rtx)
7932 return XEXP (cond0, 0);
7933 else if (GET_CODE (cond0) == EQ && XEXP (cond0, 1) == const0_rtx)
7935 *ptrue = XEXP (x, 2), *pfalse = XEXP (x, 1);
7936 return XEXP (cond0, 0);
7938 else
7939 return cond0;
7942 /* If X is a SUBREG, we can narrow both the true and false values
7943 if the inner expression, if there is a condition. */
7944 else if (code == SUBREG
7945 && 0 != (cond0 = if_then_else_cond (SUBREG_REG (x),
7946 &true0, &false0)))
7948 true0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, true0,
7949 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
7950 false0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, false0,
7951 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)), SUBREG_BYTE (x));
7952 if (true0 && false0)
7954 *ptrue = true0;
7955 *pfalse = false0;
7956 return cond0;
7960 /* If X is a constant, this isn't special and will cause confusions
7961 if we treat it as such. Likewise if it is equivalent to a constant. */
7962 else if (CONSTANT_P (x)
7963 || ((cond0 = get_last_value (x)) != 0 && CONSTANT_P (cond0)))
7966 /* If we're in BImode, canonicalize on 0 and STORE_FLAG_VALUE, as that
7967 will be least confusing to the rest of the compiler. */
7968 else if (mode == BImode)
7970 *ptrue = GEN_INT (STORE_FLAG_VALUE), *pfalse = const0_rtx;
7971 return x;
7974 /* If X is known to be either 0 or -1, those are the true and
7975 false values when testing X. */
7976 else if (x == constm1_rtx || x == const0_rtx
7977 || (mode != VOIDmode
7978 && num_sign_bit_copies (x, mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
7980 *ptrue = constm1_rtx, *pfalse = const0_rtx;
7981 return x;
7984 /* Likewise for 0 or a single bit. */
7985 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (mode)
7986 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
7987 && exact_log2 (nz = nonzero_bits (x, mode)) >= 0)
7989 *ptrue = gen_int_mode (nz, mode), *pfalse = const0_rtx;
7990 return x;
7993 /* Otherwise fail; show no condition with true and false values the same. */
7994 *ptrue = *pfalse = x;
7995 return 0;
7998 /* Return the value of expression X given the fact that condition COND
7999 is known to be true when applied to REG as its first operand and VAL
8000 as its second. X is known to not be shared and so can be modified in
8001 place.
8003 We only handle the simplest cases, and specifically those cases that
8004 arise with IF_THEN_ELSE expressions. */
8006 static rtx
8007 known_cond (rtx x, enum rtx_code cond, rtx reg, rtx val)
8009 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8010 rtx temp;
8011 const char *fmt;
8012 int i, j;
8014 if (side_effects_p (x))
8015 return x;
8017 /* If either operand of the condition is a floating point value,
8018 then we have to avoid collapsing an EQ comparison. */
8019 if (cond == EQ
8020 && rtx_equal_p (x, reg)
8021 && ! FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
8022 && ! FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (val)))
8023 return val;
8025 if (cond == UNEQ && rtx_equal_p (x, reg))
8026 return val;
8028 /* If X is (abs REG) and we know something about REG's relationship
8029 with zero, we may be able to simplify this. */
8031 if (code == ABS && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), reg) && val == const0_rtx)
8032 switch (cond)
8034 case GE: case GT: case EQ:
8035 return XEXP (x, 0);
8036 case LT: case LE:
8037 return simplify_gen_unary (NEG, GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)),
8038 XEXP (x, 0),
8039 GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0)));
8040 default:
8041 break;
8044 /* The only other cases we handle are MIN, MAX, and comparisons if the
8045 operands are the same as REG and VAL. */
8047 else if (COMPARISON_P (x) || COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (x))
8049 if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), val))
8050 cond = swap_condition (cond), temp = val, val = reg, reg = temp;
8052 if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 0), reg) && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (x, 1), val))
8054 if (COMPARISON_P (x))
8056 if (comparison_dominates_p (cond, code))
8057 return const_true_rtx;
8059 code = reversed_comparison_code (x, NULL);
8060 if (code != UNKNOWN
8061 && comparison_dominates_p (cond, code))
8062 return const0_rtx;
8063 else
8064 return x;
8066 else if (code == SMAX || code == SMIN
8067 || code == UMIN || code == UMAX)
8069 int unsignedp = (code == UMIN || code == UMAX);
8071 /* Do not reverse the condition when it is NE or EQ.
8072 This is because we cannot conclude anything about
8073 the value of 'SMAX (x, y)' when x is not equal to y,
8074 but we can when x equals y. */
8075 if ((code == SMAX || code == UMAX)
8076 && ! (cond == EQ || cond == NE))
8077 cond = reverse_condition (cond);
8079 switch (cond)
8081 case GE: case GT:
8082 return unsignedp ? x : XEXP (x, 1);
8083 case LE: case LT:
8084 return unsignedp ? x : XEXP (x, 0);
8085 case GEU: case GTU:
8086 return unsignedp ? XEXP (x, 1) : x;
8087 case LEU: case LTU:
8088 return unsignedp ? XEXP (x, 0) : x;
8089 default:
8090 break;
8095 else if (code == SUBREG)
8097 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x));
8098 rtx new, r = known_cond (SUBREG_REG (x), cond, reg, val);
8100 if (SUBREG_REG (x) != r)
8102 /* We must simplify subreg here, before we lose track of the
8103 original inner_mode. */
8104 new = simplify_subreg (GET_MODE (x), r,
8105 inner_mode, SUBREG_BYTE (x));
8106 if (new)
8107 return new;
8108 else
8109 SUBST (SUBREG_REG (x), r);
8112 return x;
8114 /* We don't have to handle SIGN_EXTEND here, because even in the
8115 case of replacing something with a modeless CONST_INT, a
8116 CONST_INT is already (supposed to be) a valid sign extension for
8117 its narrower mode, which implies it's already properly
8118 sign-extended for the wider mode. Now, for ZERO_EXTEND, the
8119 story is different. */
8120 else if (code == ZERO_EXTEND)
8122 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (x, 0));
8123 rtx new, r = known_cond (XEXP (x, 0), cond, reg, val);
8125 if (XEXP (x, 0) != r)
8127 /* We must simplify the zero_extend here, before we lose
8128 track of the original inner_mode. */
8129 new = simplify_unary_operation (ZERO_EXTEND, GET_MODE (x),
8130 r, inner_mode);
8131 if (new)
8132 return new;
8133 else
8134 SUBST (XEXP (x, 0), r);
8137 return x;
8140 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
8141 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
8143 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
8144 SUBST (XEXP (x, i), known_cond (XEXP (x, i), cond, reg, val));
8145 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
8146 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
8147 SUBST (XVECEXP (x, i, j), known_cond (XVECEXP (x, i, j),
8148 cond, reg, val));
8151 return x;
8154 /* See if X and Y are equal for the purposes of seeing if we can rewrite an
8155 assignment as a field assignment. */
8157 static int
8158 rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (rtx x, rtx y)
8160 if (x == y || rtx_equal_p (x, y))
8161 return 1;
8163 if (x == 0 || y == 0 || GET_MODE (x) != GET_MODE (y))
8164 return 0;
8166 /* Check for a paradoxical SUBREG of a MEM compared with the MEM.
8167 Note that all SUBREGs of MEM are paradoxical; otherwise they
8168 would have been rewritten. */
8169 if (MEM_P (x) && GET_CODE (y) == SUBREG
8170 && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (y))
8171 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (y),
8172 gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (y)), x)))
8173 return 1;
8175 if (MEM_P (y) && GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
8176 && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (x))
8177 && rtx_equal_p (SUBREG_REG (x),
8178 gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x)), y)))
8179 return 1;
8181 /* We used to see if get_last_value of X and Y were the same but that's
8182 not correct. In one direction, we'll cause the assignment to have
8183 the wrong destination and in the case, we'll import a register into this
8184 insn that might have already have been dead. So fail if none of the
8185 above cases are true. */
8186 return 0;
8189 /* See if X, a SET operation, can be rewritten as a bit-field assignment.
8190 Return that assignment if so.
8192 We only handle the most common cases. */
8194 static rtx
8195 make_field_assignment (rtx x)
8197 rtx dest = SET_DEST (x);
8198 rtx src = SET_SRC (x);
8199 rtx assign;
8200 rtx rhs, lhs;
8201 HOST_WIDE_INT c1;
8202 HOST_WIDE_INT pos;
8203 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
8204 rtx other;
8205 enum machine_mode mode;
8207 /* If SRC was (and (not (ashift (const_int 1) POS)) DEST), this is
8208 a clear of a one-bit field. We will have changed it to
8209 (and (rotate (const_int -2) POS) DEST), so check for that. Also check
8210 for a SUBREG. */
8212 if (GET_CODE (src) == AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == ROTATE
8213 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0)) == CONST_INT
8214 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0)) == -2
8215 && rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (dest, XEXP (src, 1)))
8217 assign = make_extraction (VOIDmode, dest, 0, XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 1),
8218 1, 1, 1, 0);
8219 if (assign != 0)
8220 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, assign, const0_rtx);
8221 return x;
8224 if (GET_CODE (src) == AND && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == SUBREG
8225 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (src, 0))
8226 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)))
8227 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (src, 0)))))
8228 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (src, 0))) == ROTATE
8229 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (src, 0)), 0)) == CONST_INT
8230 && INTVAL (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (src, 0)), 0)) == -2
8231 && rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (dest, XEXP (src, 1)))
8233 assign = make_extraction (VOIDmode, dest, 0,
8234 XEXP (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (src, 0)), 1),
8235 1, 1, 1, 0);
8236 if (assign != 0)
8237 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, assign, const0_rtx);
8238 return x;
8241 /* If SRC is (ior (ashift (const_int 1) POS) DEST), this is a set of a
8242 one-bit field. */
8243 if (GET_CODE (src) == IOR && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 0)) == ASHIFT
8244 && XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 0) == const1_rtx
8245 && rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (dest, XEXP (src, 1)))
8247 assign = make_extraction (VOIDmode, dest, 0, XEXP (XEXP (src, 0), 1),
8248 1, 1, 1, 0);
8249 if (assign != 0)
8250 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, assign, const1_rtx);
8251 return x;
8254 /* If DEST is already a field assignment, i.e. ZERO_EXTRACT, and the
8255 SRC is an AND with all bits of that field set, then we can discard
8256 the AND. */
8257 if (GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
8258 && GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 1)) == CONST_INT
8259 && GET_CODE (src) == AND
8260 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
8262 HOST_WIDE_INT width = INTVAL (XEXP (dest, 1));
8263 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT and_mask = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
8264 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ze_mask;
8266 if (width >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
8267 ze_mask = -1;
8268 else
8269 ze_mask = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)1 << width) - 1;
8271 /* Complete overlap. We can remove the source AND. */
8272 if ((and_mask & ze_mask) == ze_mask)
8273 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, XEXP (src, 0));
8275 /* Partial overlap. We can reduce the source AND. */
8276 if ((and_mask & ze_mask) != and_mask)
8278 mode = GET_MODE (src);
8279 src = gen_rtx_AND (mode, XEXP (src, 0),
8280 gen_int_mode (and_mask & ze_mask, mode));
8281 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, dest, src);
8285 /* The other case we handle is assignments into a constant-position
8286 field. They look like (ior/xor (and DEST C1) OTHER). If C1 represents
8287 a mask that has all one bits except for a group of zero bits and
8288 OTHER is known to have zeros where C1 has ones, this is such an
8289 assignment. Compute the position and length from C1. Shift OTHER
8290 to the appropriate position, force it to the required mode, and
8291 make the extraction. Check for the AND in both operands. */
8293 if (GET_CODE (src) != IOR && GET_CODE (src) != XOR)
8294 return x;
8296 rhs = expand_compound_operation (XEXP (src, 0));
8297 lhs = expand_compound_operation (XEXP (src, 1));
8299 if (GET_CODE (rhs) == AND
8300 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
8301 && rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (XEXP (rhs, 0), dest))
8302 c1 = INTVAL (XEXP (rhs, 1)), other = lhs;
8303 else if (GET_CODE (lhs) == AND
8304 && GET_CODE (XEXP (lhs, 1)) == CONST_INT
8305 && rtx_equal_for_field_assignment_p (XEXP (lhs, 0), dest))
8306 c1 = INTVAL (XEXP (lhs, 1)), other = rhs;
8307 else
8308 return x;
8310 pos = get_pos_from_mask ((~c1) & GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (dest)), &len);
8311 if (pos < 0 || pos + len > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest))
8312 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8313 || (c1 & nonzero_bits (other, GET_MODE (dest))) != 0)
8314 return x;
8316 assign = make_extraction (VOIDmode, dest, pos, NULL_RTX, len, 1, 1, 0);
8317 if (assign == 0)
8318 return x;
8320 /* The mode to use for the source is the mode of the assignment, or of
8321 what is inside a possible STRICT_LOW_PART. */
8322 mode = (GET_CODE (assign) == STRICT_LOW_PART
8323 ? GET_MODE (XEXP (assign, 0)) : GET_MODE (assign));
8325 /* Shift OTHER right POS places and make it the source, restricting it
8326 to the proper length and mode. */
8328 src = canon_reg_for_combine (simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT,
8329 GET_MODE (src),
8330 other, pos),
8331 dest);
8332 src = force_to_mode (src, mode,
8333 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8334 ? ~(unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 0
8335 : ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << len) - 1,
8338 /* If SRC is masked by an AND that does not make a difference in
8339 the value being stored, strip it. */
8340 if (GET_CODE (assign) == ZERO_EXTRACT
8341 && GET_CODE (XEXP (assign, 1)) == CONST_INT
8342 && INTVAL (XEXP (assign, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8343 && GET_CODE (src) == AND
8344 && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT
8345 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1))
8346 == ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (XEXP (assign, 1))) - 1))
8347 src = XEXP (src, 0);
8349 return gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, assign, src);
8352 /* See if X is of the form (+ (* a c) (* b c)) and convert to (* (+ a b) c)
8353 if so. */
8355 static rtx
8356 apply_distributive_law (rtx x)
8358 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
8359 enum rtx_code inner_code;
8360 rtx lhs, rhs, other;
8361 rtx tem;
8363 /* Distributivity is not true for floating point as it can change the
8364 value. So we don't do it unless -funsafe-math-optimizations. */
8365 if (FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
8366 && ! flag_unsafe_math_optimizations)
8367 return x;
8369 /* The outer operation can only be one of the following: */
8370 if (code != IOR && code != AND && code != XOR
8371 && code != PLUS && code != MINUS)
8372 return x;
8374 lhs = XEXP (x, 0);
8375 rhs = XEXP (x, 1);
8377 /* If either operand is a primitive we can't do anything, so get out
8378 fast. */
8379 if (OBJECT_P (lhs) || OBJECT_P (rhs))
8380 return x;
8382 lhs = expand_compound_operation (lhs);
8383 rhs = expand_compound_operation (rhs);
8384 inner_code = GET_CODE (lhs);
8385 if (inner_code != GET_CODE (rhs))
8386 return x;
8388 /* See if the inner and outer operations distribute. */
8389 switch (inner_code)
8391 case LSHIFTRT:
8392 case ASHIFTRT:
8393 case AND:
8394 case IOR:
8395 /* These all distribute except over PLUS. */
8396 if (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
8397 return x;
8398 break;
8400 case MULT:
8401 if (code != PLUS && code != MINUS)
8402 return x;
8403 break;
8405 case ASHIFT:
8406 /* This is also a multiply, so it distributes over everything. */
8407 break;
8409 case SUBREG:
8410 /* Non-paradoxical SUBREGs distributes over all operations,
8411 provided the inner modes and byte offsets are the same, this
8412 is an extraction of a low-order part, we don't convert an fp
8413 operation to int or vice versa, this is not a vector mode,
8414 and we would not be converting a single-word operation into a
8415 multi-word operation. The latter test is not required, but
8416 it prevents generating unneeded multi-word operations. Some
8417 of the previous tests are redundant given the latter test,
8418 but are retained because they are required for correctness.
8420 We produce the result slightly differently in this case. */
8422 if (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs)) != GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rhs))
8423 || SUBREG_BYTE (lhs) != SUBREG_BYTE (rhs)
8424 || ! subreg_lowpart_p (lhs)
8425 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (lhs))
8426 != GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs))))
8427 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (lhs))
8428 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs))))
8429 || VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (lhs))
8430 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs))) > UNITS_PER_WORD
8431 /* Result might need to be truncated. Don't change mode if
8432 explicit truncation is needed. */
8433 || !TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION
8434 (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)),
8435 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs)))))
8436 return x;
8438 tem = simplify_gen_binary (code, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (lhs)),
8439 SUBREG_REG (lhs), SUBREG_REG (rhs));
8440 return gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (x), tem);
8442 default:
8443 return x;
8446 /* Set LHS and RHS to the inner operands (A and B in the example
8447 above) and set OTHER to the common operand (C in the example).
8448 There is only one way to do this unless the inner operation is
8449 commutative. */
8450 if (COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (lhs)
8451 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (lhs, 0), XEXP (rhs, 0)))
8452 other = XEXP (lhs, 0), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 1), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 1);
8453 else if (COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (lhs)
8454 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (lhs, 0), XEXP (rhs, 1)))
8455 other = XEXP (lhs, 0), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 1), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
8456 else if (COMMUTATIVE_ARITH_P (lhs)
8457 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (lhs, 1), XEXP (rhs, 0)))
8458 other = XEXP (lhs, 1), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 1);
8459 else if (rtx_equal_p (XEXP (lhs, 1), XEXP (rhs, 1)))
8460 other = XEXP (lhs, 1), lhs = XEXP (lhs, 0), rhs = XEXP (rhs, 0);
8461 else
8462 return x;
8464 /* Form the new inner operation, seeing if it simplifies first. */
8465 tem = simplify_gen_binary (code, GET_MODE (x), lhs, rhs);
8467 /* There is one exception to the general way of distributing:
8468 (a | c) ^ (b | c) -> (a ^ b) & ~c */
8469 if (code == XOR && inner_code == IOR)
8471 inner_code = AND;
8472 other = simplify_gen_unary (NOT, GET_MODE (x), other, GET_MODE (x));
8475 /* We may be able to continuing distributing the result, so call
8476 ourselves recursively on the inner operation before forming the
8477 outer operation, which we return. */
8478 return simplify_gen_binary (inner_code, GET_MODE (x),
8479 apply_distributive_law (tem), other);
8482 /* See if X is of the form (* (+ A B) C), and if so convert to
8483 (+ (* A C) (* B C)) and try to simplify.
8485 Most of the time, this results in no change. However, if some of
8486 the operands are the same or inverses of each other, simplifications
8487 will result.
8489 For example, (and (ior A B) (not B)) can occur as the result of
8490 expanding a bit field assignment. When we apply the distributive
8491 law to this, we get (ior (and (A (not B))) (and (B (not B)))),
8492 which then simplifies to (and (A (not B))).
8494 Note that no checks happen on the validity of applying the inverse
8495 distributive law. This is pointless since we can do it in the
8496 few places where this routine is called.
8498 N is the index of the term that is decomposed (the arithmetic operation,
8499 i.e. (+ A B) in the first example above). !N is the index of the term that
8500 is distributed, i.e. of C in the first example above. */
8501 static rtx
8502 distribute_and_simplify_rtx (rtx x, int n)
8504 enum machine_mode mode;
8505 enum rtx_code outer_code, inner_code;
8506 rtx decomposed, distributed, inner_op0, inner_op1, new_op0, new_op1, tmp;
8508 decomposed = XEXP (x, n);
8509 if (!ARITHMETIC_P (decomposed))
8510 return NULL_RTX;
8512 mode = GET_MODE (x);
8513 outer_code = GET_CODE (x);
8514 distributed = XEXP (x, !n);
8516 inner_code = GET_CODE (decomposed);
8517 inner_op0 = XEXP (decomposed, 0);
8518 inner_op1 = XEXP (decomposed, 1);
8520 /* Special case (and (xor B C) (not A)), which is equivalent to
8521 (xor (ior A B) (ior A C)) */
8522 if (outer_code == AND && inner_code == XOR && GET_CODE (distributed) == NOT)
8524 distributed = XEXP (distributed, 0);
8525 outer_code = IOR;
8528 if (n == 0)
8530 /* Distribute the second term. */
8531 new_op0 = simplify_gen_binary (outer_code, mode, inner_op0, distributed);
8532 new_op1 = simplify_gen_binary (outer_code, mode, inner_op1, distributed);
8534 else
8536 /* Distribute the first term. */
8537 new_op0 = simplify_gen_binary (outer_code, mode, distributed, inner_op0);
8538 new_op1 = simplify_gen_binary (outer_code, mode, distributed, inner_op1);
8541 tmp = apply_distributive_law (simplify_gen_binary (inner_code, mode,
8542 new_op0, new_op1));
8543 if (GET_CODE (tmp) != outer_code
8544 && rtx_cost (tmp, SET) < rtx_cost (x, SET))
8545 return tmp;
8547 return NULL_RTX;
8550 /* Simplify a logical `and' of VAROP with the constant CONSTOP, to be done
8551 in MODE. Return an equivalent form, if different from (and VAROP
8552 (const_int CONSTOP)). Otherwise, return NULL_RTX. */
8554 static rtx
8555 simplify_and_const_int_1 (enum machine_mode mode, rtx varop,
8556 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT constop)
8558 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT nonzero;
8559 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT orig_constop;
8560 rtx orig_varop;
8561 int i;
8563 orig_varop = varop;
8564 orig_constop = constop;
8565 if (GET_CODE (varop) == CLOBBER)
8566 return NULL_RTX;
8568 /* Simplify VAROP knowing that we will be only looking at some of the
8569 bits in it.
8571 Note by passing in CONSTOP, we guarantee that the bits not set in
8572 CONSTOP are not significant and will never be examined. We must
8573 ensure that is the case by explicitly masking out those bits
8574 before returning. */
8575 varop = force_to_mode (varop, mode, constop, 0);
8577 /* If VAROP is a CLOBBER, we will fail so return it. */
8578 if (GET_CODE (varop) == CLOBBER)
8579 return varop;
8581 /* If VAROP is a CONST_INT, then we need to apply the mask in CONSTOP
8582 to VAROP and return the new constant. */
8583 if (GET_CODE (varop) == CONST_INT)
8584 return gen_int_mode (INTVAL (varop) & constop, mode);
8586 /* See what bits may be nonzero in VAROP. Unlike the general case of
8587 a call to nonzero_bits, here we don't care about bits outside
8588 MODE. */
8590 nonzero = nonzero_bits (varop, mode) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
8592 /* Turn off all bits in the constant that are known to already be zero.
8593 Thus, if the AND isn't needed at all, we will have CONSTOP == NONZERO_BITS
8594 which is tested below. */
8596 constop &= nonzero;
8598 /* If we don't have any bits left, return zero. */
8599 if (constop == 0)
8600 return const0_rtx;
8602 /* If VAROP is a NEG of something known to be zero or 1 and CONSTOP is
8603 a power of two, we can replace this with an ASHIFT. */
8604 if (GET_CODE (varop) == NEG && nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), mode) == 1
8605 && (i = exact_log2 (constop)) >= 0)
8606 return simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, mode, XEXP (varop, 0), i);
8608 /* If VAROP is an IOR or XOR, apply the AND to both branches of the IOR
8609 or XOR, then try to apply the distributive law. This may eliminate
8610 operations if either branch can be simplified because of the AND.
8611 It may also make some cases more complex, but those cases probably
8612 won't match a pattern either with or without this. */
8614 if (GET_CODE (varop) == IOR || GET_CODE (varop) == XOR)
8615 return
8616 gen_lowpart
8617 (mode,
8618 apply_distributive_law
8619 (simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (varop), GET_MODE (varop),
8620 simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX,
8621 GET_MODE (varop),
8622 XEXP (varop, 0),
8623 constop),
8624 simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX,
8625 GET_MODE (varop),
8626 XEXP (varop, 1),
8627 constop))));
8629 /* If VAROP is PLUS, and the constant is a mask of low bits, distribute
8630 the AND and see if one of the operands simplifies to zero. If so, we
8631 may eliminate it. */
8633 if (GET_CODE (varop) == PLUS
8634 && exact_log2 (constop + 1) >= 0)
8636 rtx o0, o1;
8638 o0 = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (varop, 0), constop);
8639 o1 = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (varop, 1), constop);
8640 if (o0 == const0_rtx)
8641 return o1;
8642 if (o1 == const0_rtx)
8643 return o0;
8646 /* Make a SUBREG if necessary. If we can't make it, fail. */
8647 varop = gen_lowpart (mode, varop);
8648 if (varop == NULL_RTX || GET_CODE (varop) == CLOBBER)
8649 return NULL_RTX;
8651 /* If we are only masking insignificant bits, return VAROP. */
8652 if (constop == nonzero)
8653 return varop;
8655 if (varop == orig_varop && constop == orig_constop)
8656 return NULL_RTX;
8658 /* Otherwise, return an AND. */
8659 return simplify_gen_binary (AND, mode, varop, gen_int_mode (constop, mode));
8663 /* We have X, a logical `and' of VAROP with the constant CONSTOP, to be done
8664 in MODE.
8666 Return an equivalent form, if different from X. Otherwise, return X. If
8667 X is zero, we are to always construct the equivalent form. */
8669 static rtx
8670 simplify_and_const_int (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, rtx varop,
8671 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT constop)
8673 rtx tem = simplify_and_const_int_1 (mode, varop, constop);
8674 if (tem)
8675 return tem;
8677 if (!x)
8678 x = simplify_gen_binary (AND, GET_MODE (varop), varop,
8679 gen_int_mode (constop, mode));
8680 if (GET_MODE (x) != mode)
8681 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
8682 return x;
8685 /* Given a REG, X, compute which bits in X can be nonzero.
8686 We don't care about bits outside of those defined in MODE.
8688 For most X this is simply GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (MODE)), but if X is
8689 a shift, AND, or zero_extract, we can do better. */
8691 static rtx
8692 reg_nonzero_bits_for_combine (const_rtx x, enum machine_mode mode,
8693 const_rtx known_x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8694 enum machine_mode known_mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8695 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT known_ret ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8696 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *nonzero)
8698 rtx tem;
8699 reg_stat_type *rsp;
8701 /* If X is a register whose nonzero bits value is current, use it.
8702 Otherwise, if X is a register whose value we can find, use that
8703 value. Otherwise, use the previously-computed global nonzero bits
8704 for this register. */
8706 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, REGNO (x));
8707 if (rsp->last_set_value != 0
8708 && (rsp->last_set_mode == mode
8709 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (rsp->last_set_mode) == MODE_INT
8710 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT))
8711 && ((rsp->last_set_label >= label_tick_ebb_start
8712 && rsp->last_set_label < label_tick)
8713 || (rsp->last_set_label == label_tick
8714 && DF_INSN_LUID (rsp->last_set) < subst_low_luid)
8715 || (REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8716 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (x)) == 1
8717 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P
8718 (DF_LR_IN (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb), REGNO (x)))))
8720 *nonzero &= rsp->last_set_nonzero_bits;
8721 return NULL;
8724 tem = get_last_value (x);
8726 if (tem)
8728 #ifdef SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
8729 /* If X is narrower than MODE and TEM is a non-negative
8730 constant that would appear negative in the mode of X,
8731 sign-extend it for use in reg_nonzero_bits because some
8732 machines (maybe most) will actually do the sign-extension
8733 and this is the conservative approach.
8735 ??? For 2.5, try to tighten up the MD files in this regard
8736 instead of this kludge. */
8738 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
8739 && GET_CODE (tem) == CONST_INT
8740 && INTVAL (tem) > 0
8741 && 0 != (INTVAL (tem)
8742 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
8743 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) - 1))))
8744 tem = GEN_INT (INTVAL (tem)
8745 | ((HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1)
8746 << GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x))));
8747 #endif
8748 return tem;
8750 else if (nonzero_sign_valid && rsp->nonzero_bits)
8752 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = rsp->nonzero_bits;
8754 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
8755 /* We don't know anything about the upper bits. */
8756 mask |= GET_MODE_MASK (mode) ^ GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (x));
8757 *nonzero &= mask;
8760 return NULL;
8763 /* Return the number of bits at the high-order end of X that are known to
8764 be equal to the sign bit. X will be used in mode MODE; if MODE is
8765 VOIDmode, X will be used in its own mode. The returned value will always
8766 be between 1 and the number of bits in MODE. */
8768 static rtx
8769 reg_num_sign_bit_copies_for_combine (const_rtx x, enum machine_mode mode,
8770 const_rtx known_x ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8771 enum machine_mode known_mode
8772 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8773 unsigned int known_ret ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
8774 unsigned int *result)
8776 rtx tem;
8777 reg_stat_type *rsp;
8779 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, REGNO (x));
8780 if (rsp->last_set_value != 0
8781 && rsp->last_set_mode == mode
8782 && ((rsp->last_set_label >= label_tick_ebb_start
8783 && rsp->last_set_label < label_tick)
8784 || (rsp->last_set_label == label_tick
8785 && DF_INSN_LUID (rsp->last_set) < subst_low_luid)
8786 || (REGNO (x) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8787 && REG_N_SETS (REGNO (x)) == 1
8788 && !REGNO_REG_SET_P
8789 (DF_LR_IN (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb), REGNO (x)))))
8791 *result = rsp->last_set_sign_bit_copies;
8792 return NULL;
8795 tem = get_last_value (x);
8796 if (tem != 0)
8797 return tem;
8799 if (nonzero_sign_valid && rsp->sign_bit_copies != 0
8800 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
8801 *result = rsp->sign_bit_copies;
8803 return NULL;
8806 /* Return the number of "extended" bits there are in X, when interpreted
8807 as a quantity in MODE whose signedness is indicated by UNSIGNEDP. For
8808 unsigned quantities, this is the number of high-order zero bits.
8809 For signed quantities, this is the number of copies of the sign bit
8810 minus 1. In both case, this function returns the number of "spare"
8811 bits. For example, if two quantities for which this function returns
8812 at least 1 are added, the addition is known not to overflow.
8814 This function will always return 0 unless called during combine, which
8815 implies that it must be called from a define_split. */
8817 unsigned int
8818 extended_count (const_rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, int unsignedp)
8820 if (nonzero_sign_valid == 0)
8821 return 0;
8823 return (unsignedp
8824 ? (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8825 ? (unsigned int) (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1
8826 - floor_log2 (nonzero_bits (x, mode)))
8827 : 0)
8828 : num_sign_bit_copies (x, mode) - 1);
8831 /* This function is called from `simplify_shift_const' to merge two
8832 outer operations. Specifically, we have already found that we need
8833 to perform operation *POP0 with constant *PCONST0 at the outermost
8834 position. We would now like to also perform OP1 with constant CONST1
8835 (with *POP0 being done last).
8837 Return 1 if we can do the operation and update *POP0 and *PCONST0 with
8838 the resulting operation. *PCOMP_P is set to 1 if we would need to
8839 complement the innermost operand, otherwise it is unchanged.
8841 MODE is the mode in which the operation will be done. No bits outside
8842 the width of this mode matter. It is assumed that the width of this mode
8843 is smaller than or equal to HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT.
8845 If *POP0 or OP1 are UNKNOWN, it means no operation is required. Only NEG, PLUS,
8846 IOR, XOR, and AND are supported. We may set *POP0 to SET if the proper
8847 result is simply *PCONST0.
8849 If the resulting operation cannot be expressed as one operation, we
8850 return 0 and do not change *POP0, *PCONST0, and *PCOMP_P. */
8852 static int
8853 merge_outer_ops (enum rtx_code *pop0, HOST_WIDE_INT *pconst0, enum rtx_code op1, HOST_WIDE_INT const1, enum machine_mode mode, int *pcomp_p)
8855 enum rtx_code op0 = *pop0;
8856 HOST_WIDE_INT const0 = *pconst0;
8858 const0 &= GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
8859 const1 &= GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
8861 /* If OP0 is an AND, clear unimportant bits in CONST1. */
8862 if (op0 == AND)
8863 const1 &= const0;
8865 /* If OP0 or OP1 is UNKNOWN, this is easy. Similarly if they are the same or
8866 if OP0 is SET. */
8868 if (op1 == UNKNOWN || op0 == SET)
8869 return 1;
8871 else if (op0 == UNKNOWN)
8872 op0 = op1, const0 = const1;
8874 else if (op0 == op1)
8876 switch (op0)
8878 case AND:
8879 const0 &= const1;
8880 break;
8881 case IOR:
8882 const0 |= const1;
8883 break;
8884 case XOR:
8885 const0 ^= const1;
8886 break;
8887 case PLUS:
8888 const0 += const1;
8889 break;
8890 case NEG:
8891 op0 = UNKNOWN;
8892 break;
8893 default:
8894 break;
8898 /* Otherwise, if either is a PLUS or NEG, we can't do anything. */
8899 else if (op0 == PLUS || op1 == PLUS || op0 == NEG || op1 == NEG)
8900 return 0;
8902 /* If the two constants aren't the same, we can't do anything. The
8903 remaining six cases can all be done. */
8904 else if (const0 != const1)
8905 return 0;
8907 else
8908 switch (op0)
8910 case IOR:
8911 if (op1 == AND)
8912 /* (a & b) | b == b */
8913 op0 = SET;
8914 else /* op1 == XOR */
8915 /* (a ^ b) | b == a | b */
8917 break;
8919 case XOR:
8920 if (op1 == AND)
8921 /* (a & b) ^ b == (~a) & b */
8922 op0 = AND, *pcomp_p = 1;
8923 else /* op1 == IOR */
8924 /* (a | b) ^ b == a & ~b */
8925 op0 = AND, const0 = ~const0;
8926 break;
8928 case AND:
8929 if (op1 == IOR)
8930 /* (a | b) & b == b */
8931 op0 = SET;
8932 else /* op1 == XOR */
8933 /* (a ^ b) & b) == (~a) & b */
8934 *pcomp_p = 1;
8935 break;
8936 default:
8937 break;
8940 /* Check for NO-OP cases. */
8941 const0 &= GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
8942 if (const0 == 0
8943 && (op0 == IOR || op0 == XOR || op0 == PLUS))
8944 op0 = UNKNOWN;
8945 else if (const0 == 0 && op0 == AND)
8946 op0 = SET;
8947 else if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const0 == GET_MODE_MASK (mode)
8948 && op0 == AND)
8949 op0 = UNKNOWN;
8951 /* ??? Slightly redundant with the above mask, but not entirely.
8952 Moving this above means we'd have to sign-extend the mode mask
8953 for the final test. */
8954 const0 = trunc_int_for_mode (const0, mode);
8956 *pop0 = op0;
8957 *pconst0 = const0;
8959 return 1;
8962 /* Simplify a shift of VAROP by COUNT bits. CODE says what kind of shift.
8963 The result of the shift is RESULT_MODE. Return NULL_RTX if we cannot
8964 simplify it. Otherwise, return a simplified value.
8966 The shift is normally computed in the widest mode we find in VAROP, as
8967 long as it isn't a different number of words than RESULT_MODE. Exceptions
8968 are ASHIFTRT and ROTATE, which are always done in their original mode. */
8970 static rtx
8971 simplify_shift_const_1 (enum rtx_code code, enum machine_mode result_mode,
8972 rtx varop, int orig_count)
8974 enum rtx_code orig_code = code;
8975 rtx orig_varop = varop;
8976 int count;
8977 enum machine_mode mode = result_mode;
8978 enum machine_mode shift_mode, tmode;
8979 unsigned int mode_words
8980 = (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
8981 /* We form (outer_op (code varop count) (outer_const)). */
8982 enum rtx_code outer_op = UNKNOWN;
8983 HOST_WIDE_INT outer_const = 0;
8984 int complement_p = 0;
8985 rtx new, x;
8987 /* Make sure and truncate the "natural" shift on the way in. We don't
8988 want to do this inside the loop as it makes it more difficult to
8989 combine shifts. */
8990 if (SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED)
8991 orig_count &= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1;
8993 /* If we were given an invalid count, don't do anything except exactly
8994 what was requested. */
8996 if (orig_count < 0 || orig_count >= (int) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
8997 return NULL_RTX;
8999 count = orig_count;
9001 /* Unless one of the branches of the `if' in this loop does a `continue',
9002 we will `break' the loop after the `if'. */
9004 while (count != 0)
9006 /* If we have an operand of (clobber (const_int 0)), fail. */
9007 if (GET_CODE (varop) == CLOBBER)
9008 return NULL_RTX;
9010 /* If we discovered we had to complement VAROP, leave. Making a NOT
9011 here would cause an infinite loop. */
9012 if (complement_p)
9013 break;
9015 /* Convert ROTATERT to ROTATE. */
9016 if (code == ROTATERT)
9018 unsigned int bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode);;
9019 code = ROTATE;
9020 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (result_mode))
9021 count = bitsize / GET_MODE_NUNITS (result_mode) - count;
9022 else
9023 count = bitsize - count;
9026 /* We need to determine what mode we will do the shift in. If the
9027 shift is a right shift or a ROTATE, we must always do it in the mode
9028 it was originally done in. Otherwise, we can do it in MODE, the
9029 widest mode encountered. */
9030 shift_mode
9031 = (code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT || code == ROTATE
9032 ? result_mode : mode);
9034 /* Handle cases where the count is greater than the size of the mode
9035 minus 1. For ASHIFT, use the size minus one as the count (this can
9036 occur when simplifying (lshiftrt (ashiftrt ..))). For rotates,
9037 take the count modulo the size. For other shifts, the result is
9038 zero.
9040 Since these shifts are being produced by the compiler by combining
9041 multiple operations, each of which are defined, we know what the
9042 result is supposed to be. */
9044 if (count > (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) - 1))
9046 if (code == ASHIFTRT)
9047 count = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) - 1;
9048 else if (code == ROTATE || code == ROTATERT)
9049 count %= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode);
9050 else
9052 /* We can't simply return zero because there may be an
9053 outer op. */
9054 varop = const0_rtx;
9055 count = 0;
9056 break;
9060 /* An arithmetic right shift of a quantity known to be -1 or 0
9061 is a no-op. */
9062 if (code == ASHIFTRT
9063 && (num_sign_bit_copies (varop, shift_mode)
9064 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode)))
9066 count = 0;
9067 break;
9070 /* If we are doing an arithmetic right shift and discarding all but
9071 the sign bit copies, this is equivalent to doing a shift by the
9072 bitsize minus one. Convert it into that shift because it will often
9073 allow other simplifications. */
9075 if (code == ASHIFTRT
9076 && (count + num_sign_bit_copies (varop, shift_mode)
9077 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode)))
9078 count = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) - 1;
9080 /* We simplify the tests below and elsewhere by converting
9081 ASHIFTRT to LSHIFTRT if we know the sign bit is clear.
9082 `make_compound_operation' will convert it to an ASHIFTRT for
9083 those machines (such as VAX) that don't have an LSHIFTRT. */
9084 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9085 && code == ASHIFTRT
9086 && ((nonzero_bits (varop, shift_mode)
9087 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) - 1)))
9088 == 0))
9089 code = LSHIFTRT;
9091 if (((code == LSHIFTRT
9092 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9093 && !(nonzero_bits (varop, shift_mode) >> count))
9094 || (code == ASHIFT
9095 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (shift_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9096 && !((nonzero_bits (varop, shift_mode) << count)
9097 & GET_MODE_MASK (shift_mode))))
9098 && !side_effects_p (varop))
9099 varop = const0_rtx;
9101 switch (GET_CODE (varop))
9103 case SIGN_EXTEND:
9104 case ZERO_EXTEND:
9105 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
9106 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
9107 new = expand_compound_operation (varop);
9108 if (new != varop)
9110 varop = new;
9111 continue;
9113 break;
9115 case MEM:
9116 /* If we have (xshiftrt (mem ...) C) and C is MODE_WIDTH
9117 minus the width of a smaller mode, we can do this with a
9118 SIGN_EXTEND or ZERO_EXTEND from the narrower memory location. */
9119 if ((code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT)
9120 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (varop, 0))
9121 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (varop)
9122 && (tmode = mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - count,
9123 MODE_INT, 1)) != BLKmode)
9125 new = adjust_address_nv (varop, tmode,
9126 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? 0
9127 : count / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9129 varop = gen_rtx_fmt_e (code == ASHIFTRT ? SIGN_EXTEND
9130 : ZERO_EXTEND, mode, new);
9131 count = 0;
9132 continue;
9134 break;
9136 case SUBREG:
9137 /* If VAROP is a SUBREG, strip it as long as the inner operand has
9138 the same number of words as what we've seen so far. Then store
9139 the widest mode in MODE. */
9140 if (subreg_lowpart_p (varop)
9141 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (varop)))
9142 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (varop)))
9143 && (unsigned int) ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (varop)))
9144 + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
9145 == mode_words)
9147 varop = SUBREG_REG (varop);
9148 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (varop)) > GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
9149 mode = GET_MODE (varop);
9150 continue;
9152 break;
9154 case MULT:
9155 /* Some machines use MULT instead of ASHIFT because MULT
9156 is cheaper. But it is still better on those machines to
9157 merge two shifts into one. */
9158 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9159 && exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1))) >= 0)
9161 varop
9162 = simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFT, GET_MODE (varop),
9163 XEXP (varop, 0),
9164 GEN_INT (exact_log2 (
9165 INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)))));
9166 continue;
9168 break;
9170 case UDIV:
9171 /* Similar, for when divides are cheaper. */
9172 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9173 && exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1))) >= 0)
9175 varop
9176 = simplify_gen_binary (LSHIFTRT, GET_MODE (varop),
9177 XEXP (varop, 0),
9178 GEN_INT (exact_log2 (
9179 INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)))));
9180 continue;
9182 break;
9184 case ASHIFTRT:
9185 /* If we are extracting just the sign bit of an arithmetic
9186 right shift, that shift is not needed. However, the sign
9187 bit of a wider mode may be different from what would be
9188 interpreted as the sign bit in a narrower mode, so, if
9189 the result is narrower, don't discard the shift. */
9190 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9191 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) - 1)
9192 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode)
9193 >= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop))))
9195 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9196 continue;
9199 /* ... fall through ... */
9201 case LSHIFTRT:
9202 case ASHIFT:
9203 case ROTATE:
9204 /* Here we have two nested shifts. The result is usually the
9205 AND of a new shift with a mask. We compute the result below. */
9206 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9207 && INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)) >= 0
9208 && INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop))
9209 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9210 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9211 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (result_mode))
9213 enum rtx_code first_code = GET_CODE (varop);
9214 unsigned int first_count = INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1));
9215 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask;
9216 rtx mask_rtx;
9218 /* We have one common special case. We can't do any merging if
9219 the inner code is an ASHIFTRT of a smaller mode. However, if
9220 we have (ashift:M1 (subreg:M1 (ashiftrt:M2 FOO C1) 0) C2)
9221 with C2 == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (M1) - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (M2),
9222 we can convert it to
9223 (ashiftrt:M1 (ashift:M1 (and:M1 (subreg:M1 FOO 0 C2) C3) C1).
9224 This simplifies certain SIGN_EXTEND operations. */
9225 if (code == ASHIFT && first_code == ASHIFTRT
9226 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode)
9227 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop))))
9229 /* C3 has the low-order C1 bits zero. */
9231 mask = (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)
9232 & ~(((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << first_count) - 1));
9234 varop = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, result_mode,
9235 XEXP (varop, 0), mask);
9236 varop = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, ASHIFT, result_mode,
9237 varop, count);
9238 count = first_count;
9239 code = ASHIFTRT;
9240 continue;
9243 /* If this was (ashiftrt (ashift foo C1) C2) and FOO has more
9244 than C1 high-order bits equal to the sign bit, we can convert
9245 this to either an ASHIFT or an ASHIFTRT depending on the
9246 two counts.
9248 We cannot do this if VAROP's mode is not SHIFT_MODE. */
9250 if (code == ASHIFTRT && first_code == ASHIFT
9251 && GET_MODE (varop) == shift_mode
9252 && (num_sign_bit_copies (XEXP (varop, 0), shift_mode)
9253 > first_count))
9255 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9256 count -= first_count;
9257 if (count < 0)
9259 count = -count;
9260 code = ASHIFT;
9263 continue;
9266 /* There are some cases we can't do. If CODE is ASHIFTRT,
9267 we can only do this if FIRST_CODE is also ASHIFTRT.
9269 We can't do the case when CODE is ROTATE and FIRST_CODE is
9270 ASHIFTRT.
9272 If the mode of this shift is not the mode of the outer shift,
9273 we can't do this if either shift is a right shift or ROTATE.
9275 Finally, we can't do any of these if the mode is too wide
9276 unless the codes are the same.
9278 Handle the case where the shift codes are the same
9279 first. */
9281 if (code == first_code)
9283 if (GET_MODE (varop) != result_mode
9284 && (code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT
9285 || code == ROTATE))
9286 break;
9288 count += first_count;
9289 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9290 continue;
9293 if (code == ASHIFTRT
9294 || (code == ROTATE && first_code == ASHIFTRT)
9295 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9296 || (GET_MODE (varop) != result_mode
9297 && (first_code == ASHIFTRT || first_code == LSHIFTRT
9298 || first_code == ROTATE
9299 || code == ROTATE)))
9300 break;
9302 /* To compute the mask to apply after the shift, shift the
9303 nonzero bits of the inner shift the same way the
9304 outer shift will. */
9306 mask_rtx = GEN_INT (nonzero_bits (varop, GET_MODE (varop)));
9308 mask_rtx
9309 = simplify_const_binary_operation (code, result_mode, mask_rtx,
9310 GEN_INT (count));
9312 /* Give up if we can't compute an outer operation to use. */
9313 if (mask_rtx == 0
9314 || GET_CODE (mask_rtx) != CONST_INT
9315 || ! merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, AND,
9316 INTVAL (mask_rtx),
9317 result_mode, &complement_p))
9318 break;
9320 /* If the shifts are in the same direction, we add the
9321 counts. Otherwise, we subtract them. */
9322 if ((code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT)
9323 == (first_code == ASHIFTRT || first_code == LSHIFTRT))
9324 count += first_count;
9325 else
9326 count -= first_count;
9328 /* If COUNT is positive, the new shift is usually CODE,
9329 except for the two exceptions below, in which case it is
9330 FIRST_CODE. If the count is negative, FIRST_CODE should
9331 always be used */
9332 if (count > 0
9333 && ((first_code == ROTATE && code == ASHIFT)
9334 || (first_code == ASHIFTRT && code == LSHIFTRT)))
9335 code = first_code;
9336 else if (count < 0)
9337 code = first_code, count = -count;
9339 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9340 continue;
9343 /* If we have (A << B << C) for any shift, we can convert this to
9344 (A << C << B). This wins if A is a constant. Only try this if
9345 B is not a constant. */
9347 else if (GET_CODE (varop) == code
9348 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 0)) == CONST_INT
9349 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) != CONST_INT)
9351 rtx new = simplify_const_binary_operation (code, mode,
9352 XEXP (varop, 0),
9353 GEN_INT (count));
9354 varop = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (code, mode, new, XEXP (varop, 1));
9355 count = 0;
9356 continue;
9358 break;
9360 case NOT:
9361 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode))
9362 break;
9364 /* Make this fit the case below. */
9365 varop = gen_rtx_XOR (mode, XEXP (varop, 0),
9366 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)));
9367 continue;
9369 case IOR:
9370 case AND:
9371 case XOR:
9372 /* If we have (xshiftrt (ior (plus X (const_int -1)) X) C)
9373 with C the size of VAROP - 1 and the shift is logical if
9374 STORE_FLAG_VALUE is 1 and arithmetic if STORE_FLAG_VALUE is -1,
9375 we have an (le X 0) operation. If we have an arithmetic shift
9376 and STORE_FLAG_VALUE is 1 or we have a logical shift with
9377 STORE_FLAG_VALUE of -1, we have a (neg (le X 0)) operation. */
9379 if (GET_CODE (varop) == IOR && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 0)) == PLUS
9380 && XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 1) == constm1_rtx
9381 && (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 || STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
9382 && (code == LSHIFTRT || code == ASHIFTRT)
9383 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop)) - 1)
9384 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 0), XEXP (varop, 1)))
9386 count = 0;
9387 varop = gen_rtx_LE (GET_MODE (varop), XEXP (varop, 1),
9388 const0_rtx);
9390 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 ? code == ASHIFTRT : code == LSHIFTRT)
9391 varop = gen_rtx_NEG (GET_MODE (varop), varop);
9393 continue;
9396 /* If we have (shift (logical)), move the logical to the outside
9397 to allow it to possibly combine with another logical and the
9398 shift to combine with another shift. This also canonicalizes to
9399 what a ZERO_EXTRACT looks like. Also, some machines have
9400 (and (shift)) insns. */
9402 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9403 /* We can't do this if we have (ashiftrt (xor)) and the
9404 constant has its sign bit set in shift_mode. */
9405 && !(code == ASHIFTRT && GET_CODE (varop) == XOR
9406 && 0 > trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)),
9407 shift_mode))
9408 && (new = simplify_const_binary_operation (code, result_mode,
9409 XEXP (varop, 1),
9410 GEN_INT (count))) != 0
9411 && GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT
9412 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, GET_CODE (varop),
9413 INTVAL (new), result_mode, &complement_p))
9415 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9416 continue;
9419 /* If we can't do that, try to simplify the shift in each arm of the
9420 logical expression, make a new logical expression, and apply
9421 the inverse distributive law. This also can't be done
9422 for some (ashiftrt (xor)). */
9423 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9424 && !(code == ASHIFTRT && GET_CODE (varop) == XOR
9425 && 0 > trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (XEXP (varop, 1)),
9426 shift_mode)))
9428 rtx lhs = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, code, shift_mode,
9429 XEXP (varop, 0), count);
9430 rtx rhs = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, code, shift_mode,
9431 XEXP (varop, 1), count);
9433 varop = simplify_gen_binary (GET_CODE (varop), shift_mode,
9434 lhs, rhs);
9435 varop = apply_distributive_law (varop);
9437 count = 0;
9438 continue;
9440 break;
9442 case EQ:
9443 /* Convert (lshiftrt (eq FOO 0) C) to (xor FOO 1) if STORE_FLAG_VALUE
9444 says that the sign bit can be tested, FOO has mode MODE, C is
9445 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (MODE) - 1, and FOO has only its low-order bit
9446 that may be nonzero. */
9447 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9448 && XEXP (varop, 1) == const0_rtx
9449 && GET_MODE (XEXP (varop, 0)) == result_mode
9450 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) - 1)
9451 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9452 && STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1
9453 && nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode) == 1
9454 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, XOR,
9455 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1, result_mode,
9456 &complement_p))
9458 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9459 count = 0;
9460 continue;
9462 break;
9464 case NEG:
9465 /* (lshiftrt (neg A) C) where A is either 0 or 1 and C is one less
9466 than the number of bits in the mode is equivalent to A. */
9467 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9468 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) - 1)
9469 && nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode) == 1)
9471 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9472 count = 0;
9473 continue;
9476 /* NEG commutes with ASHIFT since it is multiplication. Move the
9477 NEG outside to allow shifts to combine. */
9478 if (code == ASHIFT
9479 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, NEG,
9480 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, result_mode,
9481 &complement_p))
9483 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9484 continue;
9486 break;
9488 case PLUS:
9489 /* (lshiftrt (plus A -1) C) where A is either 0 or 1 and C
9490 is one less than the number of bits in the mode is
9491 equivalent to (xor A 1). */
9492 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9493 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) - 1)
9494 && XEXP (varop, 1) == constm1_rtx
9495 && nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode) == 1
9496 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, XOR,
9497 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1, result_mode,
9498 &complement_p))
9500 count = 0;
9501 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9502 continue;
9505 /* If we have (xshiftrt (plus FOO BAR) C), and the only bits
9506 that might be nonzero in BAR are those being shifted out and those
9507 bits are known zero in FOO, we can replace the PLUS with FOO.
9508 Similarly in the other operand order. This code occurs when
9509 we are computing the size of a variable-size array. */
9511 if ((code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT)
9512 && count < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9513 && nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 1), result_mode) >> count == 0
9514 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 1), result_mode)
9515 & nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode)) == 0)
9517 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9518 continue;
9520 else if ((code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT)
9521 && count < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9522 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
9523 && 0 == (nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode)
9524 >> count)
9525 && 0 == (nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 0), result_mode)
9526 & nonzero_bits (XEXP (varop, 1),
9527 result_mode)))
9529 varop = XEXP (varop, 1);
9530 continue;
9533 /* (ashift (plus foo C) N) is (plus (ashift foo N) C'). */
9534 if (code == ASHIFT
9535 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9536 && (new = simplify_const_binary_operation (ASHIFT, result_mode,
9537 XEXP (varop, 1),
9538 GEN_INT (count))) != 0
9539 && GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT
9540 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, PLUS,
9541 INTVAL (new), result_mode, &complement_p))
9543 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9544 continue;
9547 /* Check for 'PLUS signbit', which is the canonical form of 'XOR
9548 signbit', and attempt to change the PLUS to an XOR and move it to
9549 the outer operation as is done above in the AND/IOR/XOR case
9550 leg for shift(logical). See details in logical handling above
9551 for reasoning in doing so. */
9552 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9553 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 1)) == CONST_INT
9554 && mode_signbit_p (result_mode, XEXP (varop, 1))
9555 && (new = simplify_const_binary_operation (code, result_mode,
9556 XEXP (varop, 1),
9557 GEN_INT (count))) != 0
9558 && GET_CODE (new) == CONST_INT
9559 && merge_outer_ops (&outer_op, &outer_const, XOR,
9560 INTVAL (new), result_mode, &complement_p))
9562 varop = XEXP (varop, 0);
9563 continue;
9566 break;
9568 case MINUS:
9569 /* If we have (xshiftrt (minus (ashiftrt X C)) X) C)
9570 with C the size of VAROP - 1 and the shift is logical if
9571 STORE_FLAG_VALUE is 1 and arithmetic if STORE_FLAG_VALUE is -1,
9572 we have a (gt X 0) operation. If the shift is arithmetic with
9573 STORE_FLAG_VALUE of 1 or logical with STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1,
9574 we have a (neg (gt X 0)) operation. */
9576 if ((STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 || STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
9577 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 0)) == ASHIFTRT
9578 && count == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop)) - 1)
9579 && (code == LSHIFTRT || code == ASHIFTRT)
9580 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
9581 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 1)) == count
9582 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 0), XEXP (varop, 1)))
9584 count = 0;
9585 varop = gen_rtx_GT (GET_MODE (varop), XEXP (varop, 1),
9586 const0_rtx);
9588 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 ? code == ASHIFTRT : code == LSHIFTRT)
9589 varop = gen_rtx_NEG (GET_MODE (varop), varop);
9591 continue;
9593 break;
9595 case TRUNCATE:
9596 /* Change (lshiftrt (truncate (lshiftrt))) to (truncate (lshiftrt))
9597 if the truncate does not affect the value. */
9598 if (code == LSHIFTRT
9599 && GET_CODE (XEXP (varop, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
9600 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
9601 && (INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (varop, 0), 1))
9602 >= (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (varop, 0)))
9603 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (varop)))))
9605 rtx varop_inner = XEXP (varop, 0);
9607 varop_inner
9608 = gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (GET_MODE (varop_inner),
9609 XEXP (varop_inner, 0),
9610 GEN_INT
9611 (count + INTVAL (XEXP (varop_inner, 1))));
9612 varop = gen_rtx_TRUNCATE (GET_MODE (varop), varop_inner);
9613 count = 0;
9614 continue;
9616 break;
9618 default:
9619 break;
9622 break;
9625 /* We need to determine what mode to do the shift in. If the shift is
9626 a right shift or ROTATE, we must always do it in the mode it was
9627 originally done in. Otherwise, we can do it in MODE, the widest mode
9628 encountered. The code we care about is that of the shift that will
9629 actually be done, not the shift that was originally requested. */
9630 shift_mode
9631 = (code == ASHIFTRT || code == LSHIFTRT || code == ROTATE
9632 ? result_mode : mode);
9634 /* We have now finished analyzing the shift. The result should be
9635 a shift of type CODE with SHIFT_MODE shifting VAROP COUNT places. If
9636 OUTER_OP is non-UNKNOWN, it is an operation that needs to be applied
9637 to the result of the shift. OUTER_CONST is the relevant constant,
9638 but we must turn off all bits turned off in the shift. */
9640 if (outer_op == UNKNOWN
9641 && orig_code == code && orig_count == count
9642 && varop == orig_varop
9643 && shift_mode == GET_MODE (varop))
9644 return NULL_RTX;
9646 /* Make a SUBREG if necessary. If we can't make it, fail. */
9647 varop = gen_lowpart (shift_mode, varop);
9648 if (varop == NULL_RTX || GET_CODE (varop) == CLOBBER)
9649 return NULL_RTX;
9651 /* If we have an outer operation and we just made a shift, it is
9652 possible that we could have simplified the shift were it not
9653 for the outer operation. So try to do the simplification
9654 recursively. */
9656 if (outer_op != UNKNOWN)
9657 x = simplify_shift_const_1 (code, shift_mode, varop, count);
9658 else
9659 x = NULL_RTX;
9661 if (x == NULL_RTX)
9662 x = simplify_gen_binary (code, shift_mode, varop, GEN_INT (count));
9664 /* If we were doing an LSHIFTRT in a wider mode than it was originally,
9665 turn off all the bits that the shift would have turned off. */
9666 if (orig_code == LSHIFTRT && result_mode != shift_mode)
9667 x = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, shift_mode, x,
9668 GET_MODE_MASK (result_mode) >> orig_count);
9670 /* Do the remainder of the processing in RESULT_MODE. */
9671 x = gen_lowpart_or_truncate (result_mode, x);
9673 /* If COMPLEMENT_P is set, we have to complement X before doing the outer
9674 operation. */
9675 if (complement_p)
9676 x = simplify_gen_unary (NOT, result_mode, x, result_mode);
9678 if (outer_op != UNKNOWN)
9680 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (result_mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
9681 outer_const = trunc_int_for_mode (outer_const, result_mode);
9683 if (outer_op == AND)
9684 x = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, result_mode, x, outer_const);
9685 else if (outer_op == SET)
9687 /* This means that we have determined that the result is
9688 equivalent to a constant. This should be rare. */
9689 if (!side_effects_p (x))
9690 x = GEN_INT (outer_const);
9692 else if (GET_RTX_CLASS (outer_op) == RTX_UNARY)
9693 x = simplify_gen_unary (outer_op, result_mode, x, result_mode);
9694 else
9695 x = simplify_gen_binary (outer_op, result_mode, x,
9696 GEN_INT (outer_const));
9699 return x;
9702 /* Simplify a shift of VAROP by COUNT bits. CODE says what kind of shift.
9703 The result of the shift is RESULT_MODE. If we cannot simplify it,
9704 return X or, if it is NULL, synthesize the expression with
9705 simplify_gen_binary. Otherwise, return a simplified value.
9707 The shift is normally computed in the widest mode we find in VAROP, as
9708 long as it isn't a different number of words than RESULT_MODE. Exceptions
9709 are ASHIFTRT and ROTATE, which are always done in their original mode. */
9711 static rtx
9712 simplify_shift_const (rtx x, enum rtx_code code, enum machine_mode result_mode,
9713 rtx varop, int count)
9715 rtx tem = simplify_shift_const_1 (code, result_mode, varop, count);
9716 if (tem)
9717 return tem;
9719 if (!x)
9720 x = simplify_gen_binary (code, GET_MODE (varop), varop, GEN_INT (count));
9721 if (GET_MODE (x) != result_mode)
9722 x = gen_lowpart (result_mode, x);
9723 return x;
9727 /* Like recog, but we receive the address of a pointer to a new pattern.
9728 We try to match the rtx that the pointer points to.
9729 If that fails, we may try to modify or replace the pattern,
9730 storing the replacement into the same pointer object.
9732 Modifications include deletion or addition of CLOBBERs.
9734 PNOTES is a pointer to a location where any REG_UNUSED notes added for
9735 the CLOBBERs are placed.
9737 The value is the final insn code from the pattern ultimately matched,
9738 or -1. */
9740 static int
9741 recog_for_combine (rtx *pnewpat, rtx insn, rtx *pnotes)
9743 rtx pat = *pnewpat;
9744 int insn_code_number;
9745 int num_clobbers_to_add = 0;
9746 int i;
9747 rtx notes = 0;
9748 rtx old_notes, old_pat;
9750 /* If PAT is a PARALLEL, check to see if it contains the CLOBBER
9751 we use to indicate that something didn't match. If we find such a
9752 thing, force rejection. */
9753 if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
9754 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
9755 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, i)) == CLOBBER
9756 && XEXP (XVECEXP (pat, 0, i), 0) == const0_rtx)
9757 return -1;
9759 old_pat = PATTERN (insn);
9760 old_notes = REG_NOTES (insn);
9761 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
9762 REG_NOTES (insn) = 0;
9764 insn_code_number = recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers_to_add);
9765 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9767 if (insn_code_number < 0)
9768 fputs ("Failed to match this instruction:\n", dump_file);
9769 else
9770 fputs ("Successfully matched this instruction:\n", dump_file);
9771 print_rtl_single (dump_file, pat);
9774 /* If it isn't, there is the possibility that we previously had an insn
9775 that clobbered some register as a side effect, but the combined
9776 insn doesn't need to do that. So try once more without the clobbers
9777 unless this represents an ASM insn. */
9779 if (insn_code_number < 0 && ! check_asm_operands (pat)
9780 && GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
9782 int pos;
9784 for (pos = 0, i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
9785 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (pat, 0, i)) != CLOBBER)
9787 if (i != pos)
9788 SUBST (XVECEXP (pat, 0, pos), XVECEXP (pat, 0, i));
9789 pos++;
9792 SUBST_INT (XVECLEN (pat, 0), pos);
9794 if (pos == 1)
9795 pat = XVECEXP (pat, 0, 0);
9797 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
9798 insn_code_number = recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers_to_add);
9799 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
9801 if (insn_code_number < 0)
9802 fputs ("Failed to match this instruction:\n", dump_file);
9803 else
9804 fputs ("Successfully matched this instruction:\n", dump_file);
9805 print_rtl_single (dump_file, pat);
9808 PATTERN (insn) = old_pat;
9809 REG_NOTES (insn) = old_notes;
9811 /* Recognize all noop sets, these will be killed by followup pass. */
9812 if (insn_code_number < 0 && GET_CODE (pat) == SET && set_noop_p (pat))
9813 insn_code_number = NOOP_MOVE_INSN_CODE, num_clobbers_to_add = 0;
9815 /* If we had any clobbers to add, make a new pattern than contains
9816 them. Then check to make sure that all of them are dead. */
9817 if (num_clobbers_to_add)
9819 rtx newpat = gen_rtx_PARALLEL (VOIDmode,
9820 rtvec_alloc (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL
9821 ? (XVECLEN (pat, 0)
9822 + num_clobbers_to_add)
9823 : num_clobbers_to_add + 1));
9825 if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
9826 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (pat, 0); i++)
9827 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i) = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
9828 else
9829 XVECEXP (newpat, 0, 0) = pat;
9831 add_clobbers (newpat, insn_code_number);
9833 for (i = XVECLEN (newpat, 0) - num_clobbers_to_add;
9834 i < XVECLEN (newpat, 0); i++)
9836 if (REG_P (XEXP (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i), 0))
9837 && ! reg_dead_at_p (XEXP (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i), 0), insn))
9838 return -1;
9839 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i), 0)) != SCRATCH)
9841 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i), 0)));
9842 notes = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_UNUSED,
9843 XEXP (XVECEXP (newpat, 0, i), 0), notes);
9846 pat = newpat;
9849 *pnewpat = pat;
9850 *pnotes = notes;
9852 return insn_code_number;
9855 /* Like gen_lowpart_general but for use by combine. In combine it
9856 is not possible to create any new pseudoregs. However, it is
9857 safe to create invalid memory addresses, because combine will
9858 try to recognize them and all they will do is make the combine
9859 attempt fail.
9861 If for some reason this cannot do its job, an rtx
9862 (clobber (const_int 0)) is returned.
9863 An insn containing that will not be recognized. */
9865 static rtx
9866 gen_lowpart_for_combine (enum machine_mode omode, rtx x)
9868 enum machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (x);
9869 unsigned int osize = GET_MODE_SIZE (omode);
9870 unsigned int isize = GET_MODE_SIZE (imode);
9871 rtx result;
9873 if (omode == imode)
9874 return x;
9876 /* Return identity if this is a CONST or symbolic reference. */
9877 if (omode == Pmode
9878 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST
9879 || GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
9880 || GET_CODE (x) == LABEL_REF))
9881 return x;
9883 /* We can only support MODE being wider than a word if X is a
9884 constant integer or has a mode the same size. */
9885 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (omode) > UNITS_PER_WORD
9886 && ! ((imode == VOIDmode
9887 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
9888 || GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE))
9889 || isize == osize))
9890 goto fail;
9892 /* X might be a paradoxical (subreg (mem)). In that case, gen_lowpart
9893 won't know what to do. So we will strip off the SUBREG here and
9894 process normally. */
9895 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (x)))
9897 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
9899 /* For use in case we fall down into the address adjustments
9900 further below, we need to adjust the known mode and size of
9901 x; imode and isize, since we just adjusted x. */
9902 imode = GET_MODE (x);
9904 if (imode == omode)
9905 return x;
9907 isize = GET_MODE_SIZE (imode);
9910 result = gen_lowpart_common (omode, x);
9912 if (result)
9913 return result;
9915 if (MEM_P (x))
9917 int offset = 0;
9919 /* Refuse to work on a volatile memory ref or one with a mode-dependent
9920 address. */
9921 if (MEM_VOLATILE_P (x) || mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (x, 0)))
9922 goto fail;
9924 /* If we want to refer to something bigger than the original memref,
9925 generate a paradoxical subreg instead. That will force a reload
9926 of the original memref X. */
9927 if (isize < osize)
9928 return gen_rtx_SUBREG (omode, x, 0);
9930 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9931 offset = MAX (isize, UNITS_PER_WORD) - MAX (osize, UNITS_PER_WORD);
9933 /* Adjust the address so that the address-after-the-data is
9934 unchanged. */
9935 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
9936 offset -= MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, osize) - MIN (UNITS_PER_WORD, isize);
9938 return adjust_address_nv (x, omode, offset);
9941 /* If X is a comparison operator, rewrite it in a new mode. This
9942 probably won't match, but may allow further simplifications. */
9943 else if (COMPARISON_P (x))
9944 return gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (x), omode, XEXP (x, 0), XEXP (x, 1));
9946 /* If we couldn't simplify X any other way, just enclose it in a
9947 SUBREG. Normally, this SUBREG won't match, but some patterns may
9948 include an explicit SUBREG or we may simplify it further in combine. */
9949 else
9951 int offset = 0;
9952 rtx res;
9954 offset = subreg_lowpart_offset (omode, imode);
9955 if (imode == VOIDmode)
9957 imode = int_mode_for_mode (omode);
9958 x = gen_lowpart_common (imode, x);
9959 if (x == NULL)
9960 goto fail;
9962 res = simplify_gen_subreg (omode, x, imode, offset);
9963 if (res)
9964 return res;
9967 fail:
9968 return gen_rtx_CLOBBER (imode, const0_rtx);
9971 /* Simplify a comparison between *POP0 and *POP1 where CODE is the
9972 comparison code that will be tested.
9974 The result is a possibly different comparison code to use. *POP0 and
9975 *POP1 may be updated.
9977 It is possible that we might detect that a comparison is either always
9978 true or always false. However, we do not perform general constant
9979 folding in combine, so this knowledge isn't useful. Such tautologies
9980 should have been detected earlier. Hence we ignore all such cases. */
9982 static enum rtx_code
9983 simplify_comparison (enum rtx_code code, rtx *pop0, rtx *pop1)
9985 rtx op0 = *pop0;
9986 rtx op1 = *pop1;
9987 rtx tem, tem1;
9988 int i;
9989 enum machine_mode mode, tmode;
9991 /* Try a few ways of applying the same transformation to both operands. */
9992 while (1)
9994 #ifndef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
9995 /* The test below this one won't handle SIGN_EXTENDs on these machines,
9996 so check specially. */
9997 if (code != GTU && code != GEU && code != LTU && code != LEU
9998 && GET_CODE (op0) == ASHIFTRT && GET_CODE (op1) == ASHIFTRT
9999 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ASHIFT
10000 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 0)) == ASHIFT
10001 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
10002 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 0)) == SUBREG
10003 && (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0)))
10004 == GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 0))))
10005 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10006 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (op1, 1)
10007 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)
10008 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 1)
10009 && (INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))
10010 == (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
10011 - (GET_MODE_BITSIZE
10012 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0))))))))
10014 op0 = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0));
10015 op1 = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (XEXP (op1, 0), 0));
10017 #endif
10019 /* If both operands are the same constant shift, see if we can ignore the
10020 shift. We can if the shift is a rotate or if the bits shifted out of
10021 this shift are known to be zero for both inputs and if the type of
10022 comparison is compatible with the shift. */
10023 if (GET_CODE (op0) == GET_CODE (op1)
10024 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10025 && ((GET_CODE (op0) == ROTATE && (code == NE || code == EQ))
10026 || ((GET_CODE (op0) == LSHIFTRT || GET_CODE (op0) == ASHIFT)
10027 && (code != GT && code != LT && code != GE && code != LE))
10028 || (GET_CODE (op0) == ASHIFTRT
10029 && (code != GTU && code != LTU
10030 && code != GEU && code != LEU)))
10031 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10032 && INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) >= 0
10033 && INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10034 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (op1, 1))
10036 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (op0);
10037 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
10038 int shift_count = INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1));
10040 if (GET_CODE (op0) == LSHIFTRT || GET_CODE (op0) == ASHIFTRT)
10041 mask &= (mask >> shift_count) << shift_count;
10042 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == ASHIFT)
10043 mask = (mask & (mask << shift_count)) >> shift_count;
10045 if ((nonzero_bits (XEXP (op0, 0), mode) & ~mask) == 0
10046 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (op1, 0), mode) & ~mask) == 0)
10047 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0), op1 = XEXP (op1, 0);
10048 else
10049 break;
10052 /* If both operands are AND's of a paradoxical SUBREG by constant, the
10053 SUBREGs are of the same mode, and, in both cases, the AND would
10054 be redundant if the comparison was done in the narrower mode,
10055 do the comparison in the narrower mode (e.g., we are AND'ing with 1
10056 and the operand's possibly nonzero bits are 0xffffff01; in that case
10057 if we only care about QImode, we don't need the AND). This case
10058 occurs if the output mode of an scc insn is not SImode and
10059 STORE_FLAG_VALUE == 1 (e.g., the 386).
10061 Similarly, check for a case where the AND's are ZERO_EXTEND
10062 operations from some narrower mode even though a SUBREG is not
10063 present. */
10065 else if (GET_CODE (op0) == AND && GET_CODE (op1) == AND
10066 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10067 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op1, 1)) == CONST_INT)
10069 rtx inner_op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10070 rtx inner_op1 = XEXP (op1, 0);
10071 HOST_WIDE_INT c0 = INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1));
10072 HOST_WIDE_INT c1 = INTVAL (XEXP (op1, 1));
10073 int changed = 0;
10075 if (GET_CODE (inner_op0) == SUBREG && GET_CODE (inner_op1) == SUBREG
10076 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (inner_op0))
10077 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op0))))
10078 && (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op0))
10079 == GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op1)))
10080 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op0)))
10081 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10082 && (0 == ((~c0) & nonzero_bits (SUBREG_REG (inner_op0),
10083 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op0)))))
10084 && (0 == ((~c1) & nonzero_bits (SUBREG_REG (inner_op1),
10085 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (inner_op1))))))
10087 op0 = SUBREG_REG (inner_op0);
10088 op1 = SUBREG_REG (inner_op1);
10090 /* The resulting comparison is always unsigned since we masked
10091 off the original sign bit. */
10092 code = unsigned_condition (code);
10094 changed = 1;
10097 else if (c0 == c1)
10098 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE
10099 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)));
10100 tmode != GET_MODE (op0); tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
10101 if ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) c0 == GET_MODE_MASK (tmode))
10103 op0 = gen_lowpart (tmode, inner_op0);
10104 op1 = gen_lowpart (tmode, inner_op1);
10105 code = unsigned_condition (code);
10106 changed = 1;
10107 break;
10110 if (! changed)
10111 break;
10114 /* If both operands are NOT, we can strip off the outer operation
10115 and adjust the comparison code for swapped operands; similarly for
10116 NEG, except that this must be an equality comparison. */
10117 else if ((GET_CODE (op0) == NOT && GET_CODE (op1) == NOT)
10118 || (GET_CODE (op0) == NEG && GET_CODE (op1) == NEG
10119 && (code == EQ || code == NE)))
10120 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0), op1 = XEXP (op1, 0), code = swap_condition (code);
10122 else
10123 break;
10126 /* If the first operand is a constant, swap the operands and adjust the
10127 comparison code appropriately, but don't do this if the second operand
10128 is already a constant integer. */
10129 if (swap_commutative_operands_p (op0, op1))
10131 tem = op0, op0 = op1, op1 = tem;
10132 code = swap_condition (code);
10135 /* We now enter a loop during which we will try to simplify the comparison.
10136 For the most part, we only are concerned with comparisons with zero,
10137 but some things may really be comparisons with zero but not start
10138 out looking that way. */
10140 while (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
10142 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (op0);
10143 unsigned int mode_width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
10144 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
10145 int equality_comparison_p;
10146 int sign_bit_comparison_p;
10147 int unsigned_comparison_p;
10148 HOST_WIDE_INT const_op;
10150 /* We only want to handle integral modes. This catches VOIDmode,
10151 CCmode, and the floating-point modes. An exception is that we
10152 can handle VOIDmode if OP0 is a COMPARE or a comparison
10153 operation. */
10155 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
10156 && ! (mode == VOIDmode
10157 && (GET_CODE (op0) == COMPARE || COMPARISON_P (op0))))
10158 break;
10160 /* Get the constant we are comparing against and turn off all bits
10161 not on in our mode. */
10162 const_op = INTVAL (op1);
10163 if (mode != VOIDmode)
10164 const_op = trunc_int_for_mode (const_op, mode);
10165 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10167 /* If we are comparing against a constant power of two and the value
10168 being compared can only have that single bit nonzero (e.g., it was
10169 `and'ed with that bit), we can replace this with a comparison
10170 with zero. */
10171 if (const_op
10172 && (code == EQ || code == NE || code == GE || code == GEU
10173 || code == LT || code == LTU)
10174 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10175 && exact_log2 (const_op) >= 0
10176 && nonzero_bits (op0, mode) == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op)
10178 code = (code == EQ || code == GE || code == GEU ? NE : EQ);
10179 op1 = const0_rtx, const_op = 0;
10182 /* Similarly, if we are comparing a value known to be either -1 or
10183 0 with -1, change it to the opposite comparison against zero. */
10185 if (const_op == -1
10186 && (code == EQ || code == NE || code == GT || code == LE
10187 || code == GEU || code == LTU)
10188 && num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode) == mode_width)
10190 code = (code == EQ || code == LE || code == GEU ? NE : EQ);
10191 op1 = const0_rtx, const_op = 0;
10194 /* Do some canonicalizations based on the comparison code. We prefer
10195 comparisons against zero and then prefer equality comparisons.
10196 If we can reduce the size of a constant, we will do that too. */
10198 switch (code)
10200 case LT:
10201 /* < C is equivalent to <= (C - 1) */
10202 if (const_op > 0)
10204 const_op -= 1;
10205 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10206 code = LE;
10207 /* ... fall through to LE case below. */
10209 else
10210 break;
10212 case LE:
10213 /* <= C is equivalent to < (C + 1); we do this for C < 0 */
10214 if (const_op < 0)
10216 const_op += 1;
10217 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10218 code = LT;
10221 /* If we are doing a <= 0 comparison on a value known to have
10222 a zero sign bit, we can replace this with == 0. */
10223 else if (const_op == 0
10224 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10225 && (nonzero_bits (op0, mode)
10226 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1))) == 0)
10227 code = EQ;
10228 break;
10230 case GE:
10231 /* >= C is equivalent to > (C - 1). */
10232 if (const_op > 0)
10234 const_op -= 1;
10235 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10236 code = GT;
10237 /* ... fall through to GT below. */
10239 else
10240 break;
10242 case GT:
10243 /* > C is equivalent to >= (C + 1); we do this for C < 0. */
10244 if (const_op < 0)
10246 const_op += 1;
10247 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10248 code = GE;
10251 /* If we are doing a > 0 comparison on a value known to have
10252 a zero sign bit, we can replace this with != 0. */
10253 else if (const_op == 0
10254 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10255 && (nonzero_bits (op0, mode)
10256 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1))) == 0)
10257 code = NE;
10258 break;
10260 case LTU:
10261 /* < C is equivalent to <= (C - 1). */
10262 if (const_op > 0)
10264 const_op -= 1;
10265 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10266 code = LEU;
10267 /* ... fall through ... */
10270 /* (unsigned) < 0x80000000 is equivalent to >= 0. */
10271 else if ((mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10272 && (const_op == (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)))
10274 const_op = 0, op1 = const0_rtx;
10275 code = GE;
10276 break;
10278 else
10279 break;
10281 case LEU:
10282 /* unsigned <= 0 is equivalent to == 0 */
10283 if (const_op == 0)
10284 code = EQ;
10286 /* (unsigned) <= 0x7fffffff is equivalent to >= 0. */
10287 else if ((mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10288 && (const_op == ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)) - 1))
10290 const_op = 0, op1 = const0_rtx;
10291 code = GE;
10293 break;
10295 case GEU:
10296 /* >= C is equivalent to > (C - 1). */
10297 if (const_op > 1)
10299 const_op -= 1;
10300 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
10301 code = GTU;
10302 /* ... fall through ... */
10305 /* (unsigned) >= 0x80000000 is equivalent to < 0. */
10306 else if ((mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10307 && (const_op == (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)))
10309 const_op = 0, op1 = const0_rtx;
10310 code = LT;
10311 break;
10313 else
10314 break;
10316 case GTU:
10317 /* unsigned > 0 is equivalent to != 0 */
10318 if (const_op == 0)
10319 code = NE;
10321 /* (unsigned) > 0x7fffffff is equivalent to < 0. */
10322 else if ((mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10323 && (const_op == ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)) - 1))
10325 const_op = 0, op1 = const0_rtx;
10326 code = LT;
10328 break;
10330 default:
10331 break;
10334 /* Compute some predicates to simplify code below. */
10336 equality_comparison_p = (code == EQ || code == NE);
10337 sign_bit_comparison_p = ((code == LT || code == GE) && const_op == 0);
10338 unsigned_comparison_p = (code == LTU || code == LEU || code == GTU
10339 || code == GEU);
10341 /* If this is a sign bit comparison and we can do arithmetic in
10342 MODE, say that we will only be needing the sign bit of OP0. */
10343 if (sign_bit_comparison_p
10344 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10345 op0 = force_to_mode (op0, mode,
10346 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10347 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1)),
10350 /* Now try cases based on the opcode of OP0. If none of the cases
10351 does a "continue", we exit this loop immediately after the
10352 switch. */
10354 switch (GET_CODE (op0))
10356 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
10357 /* If we are extracting a single bit from a variable position in
10358 a constant that has only a single bit set and are comparing it
10359 with zero, we can convert this into an equality comparison
10360 between the position and the location of the single bit. */
10361 /* Except we can't if SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED is set, since we might
10362 have already reduced the shift count modulo the word size. */
10363 if (!SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10364 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == CONST_INT
10365 && XEXP (op0, 1) == const1_rtx
10366 && equality_comparison_p && const_op == 0
10367 && (i = exact_log2 (INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 0)))) >= 0)
10369 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10371 enum machine_mode new_mode
10372 = mode_for_extraction (EP_extzv, 1);
10373 if (new_mode == MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
10374 i = BITS_PER_WORD - 1 - i;
10375 else
10377 mode = new_mode;
10378 i = (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1 - i);
10382 op0 = XEXP (op0, 2);
10383 op1 = GEN_INT (i);
10384 const_op = i;
10386 /* Result is nonzero iff shift count is equal to I. */
10387 code = reverse_condition (code);
10388 continue;
10391 /* ... fall through ... */
10393 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
10394 tem = expand_compound_operation (op0);
10395 if (tem != op0)
10397 op0 = tem;
10398 continue;
10400 break;
10402 case NOT:
10403 /* If testing for equality, we can take the NOT of the constant. */
10404 if (equality_comparison_p
10405 && (tem = simplify_unary_operation (NOT, mode, op1, mode)) != 0)
10407 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10408 op1 = tem;
10409 continue;
10412 /* If just looking at the sign bit, reverse the sense of the
10413 comparison. */
10414 if (sign_bit_comparison_p)
10416 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10417 code = (code == GE ? LT : GE);
10418 continue;
10420 break;
10422 case NEG:
10423 /* If testing for equality, we can take the NEG of the constant. */
10424 if (equality_comparison_p
10425 && (tem = simplify_unary_operation (NEG, mode, op1, mode)) != 0)
10427 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10428 op1 = tem;
10429 continue;
10432 /* The remaining cases only apply to comparisons with zero. */
10433 if (const_op != 0)
10434 break;
10436 /* When X is ABS or is known positive,
10437 (neg X) is < 0 if and only if X != 0. */
10439 if (sign_bit_comparison_p
10440 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ABS
10441 || (mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10442 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (op0, 0), mode)
10443 & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1))) == 0)))
10445 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10446 code = (code == LT ? NE : EQ);
10447 continue;
10450 /* If we have NEG of something whose two high-order bits are the
10451 same, we know that "(-a) < 0" is equivalent to "a > 0". */
10452 if (num_sign_bit_copies (op0, mode) >= 2)
10454 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10455 code = swap_condition (code);
10456 continue;
10458 break;
10460 case ROTATE:
10461 /* If we are testing equality and our count is a constant, we
10462 can perform the inverse operation on our RHS. */
10463 if (equality_comparison_p && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10464 && (tem = simplify_binary_operation (ROTATERT, mode,
10465 op1, XEXP (op0, 1))) != 0)
10467 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10468 op1 = tem;
10469 continue;
10472 /* If we are doing a < 0 or >= 0 comparison, it means we are testing
10473 a particular bit. Convert it to an AND of a constant of that
10474 bit. This will be converted into a ZERO_EXTRACT. */
10475 if (const_op == 0 && sign_bit_comparison_p
10476 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10477 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10479 op0 = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
10480 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10481 << (mode_width - 1
10482 - INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)))));
10483 code = (code == LT ? NE : EQ);
10484 continue;
10487 /* Fall through. */
10489 case ABS:
10490 /* ABS is ignorable inside an equality comparison with zero. */
10491 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p)
10493 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10494 continue;
10496 break;
10498 case SIGN_EXTEND:
10499 /* Can simplify (compare (zero/sign_extend FOO) CONST) to
10500 (compare FOO CONST) if CONST fits in FOO's mode and we
10501 are either testing inequality or have an unsigned
10502 comparison with ZERO_EXTEND or a signed comparison with
10503 SIGN_EXTEND. But don't do it if we don't have a compare
10504 insn of the given mode, since we'd have to revert it
10505 later on, and then we wouldn't know whether to sign- or
10506 zero-extend. */
10507 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0));
10508 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10509 && ! unsigned_comparison_p
10510 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10511 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op
10512 < (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10513 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1))))
10514 && optab_handler (cmp_optab, mode)->insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10516 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10517 continue;
10519 break;
10521 case SUBREG:
10522 /* Check for the case where we are comparing A - C1 with C2, that is
10524 (subreg:MODE (plus (A) (-C1))) op (C2)
10526 with C1 a constant, and try to lift the SUBREG, i.e. to do the
10527 comparison in the wider mode. One of the following two conditions
10528 must be true in order for this to be valid:
10530 1. The mode extension results in the same bit pattern being added
10531 on both sides and the comparison is equality or unsigned. As
10532 C2 has been truncated to fit in MODE, the pattern can only be
10533 all 0s or all 1s.
10535 2. The mode extension results in the sign bit being copied on
10536 each side.
10538 The difficulty here is that we have predicates for A but not for
10539 (A - C1) so we need to check that C1 is within proper bounds so
10540 as to perturbate A as little as possible. */
10542 if (mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10543 && subreg_lowpart_p (op0)
10544 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0))) > mode_width
10545 && GET_CODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)) == PLUS
10546 && GET_CODE (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (op0), 1)) == CONST_INT)
10548 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0));
10549 rtx a = XEXP (SUBREG_REG (op0), 0);
10550 HOST_WIDE_INT c1 = -INTVAL (XEXP (SUBREG_REG (op0), 1));
10552 if ((c1 > 0
10553 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) c1
10554 < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)
10555 && (equality_comparison_p || unsigned_comparison_p)
10556 /* (A - C1) zero-extends if it is positive and sign-extends
10557 if it is negative, C2 both zero- and sign-extends. */
10558 && ((0 == (nonzero_bits (a, inner_mode)
10559 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
10560 && const_op >= 0)
10561 /* (A - C1) sign-extends if it is positive and 1-extends
10562 if it is negative, C2 both sign- and 1-extends. */
10563 || (num_sign_bit_copies (a, inner_mode)
10564 > (unsigned int) (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode)
10565 - mode_width)
10566 && const_op < 0)))
10567 || ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) c1
10568 < (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 2)
10569 /* (A - C1) always sign-extends, like C2. */
10570 && num_sign_bit_copies (a, inner_mode)
10571 > (unsigned int) (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (inner_mode)
10572 - (mode_width - 1))))
10574 op0 = SUBREG_REG (op0);
10575 continue;
10579 /* If the inner mode is narrower and we are extracting the low part,
10580 we can treat the SUBREG as if it were a ZERO_EXTEND. */
10581 if (subreg_lowpart_p (op0)
10582 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0))) < mode_width)
10583 /* Fall through */ ;
10584 else
10585 break;
10587 /* ... fall through ... */
10589 case ZERO_EXTEND:
10590 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0));
10591 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
10592 && (unsigned_comparison_p || equality_comparison_p)
10593 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10594 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op < GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
10595 && optab_handler (cmp_optab, mode)->insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
10597 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10598 continue;
10600 break;
10602 case PLUS:
10603 /* (eq (plus X A) B) -> (eq X (minus B A)). We can only do
10604 this for equality comparisons due to pathological cases involving
10605 overflows. */
10606 if (equality_comparison_p
10607 && 0 != (tem = simplify_binary_operation (MINUS, mode,
10608 op1, XEXP (op0, 1))))
10610 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10611 op1 = tem;
10612 continue;
10615 /* (plus (abs X) (const_int -1)) is < 0 if and only if X == 0. */
10616 if (const_op == 0 && XEXP (op0, 1) == constm1_rtx
10617 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ABS && sign_bit_comparison_p)
10619 op0 = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0);
10620 code = (code == LT ? EQ : NE);
10621 continue;
10623 break;
10625 case MINUS:
10626 /* We used to optimize signed comparisons against zero, but that
10627 was incorrect. Unsigned comparisons against zero (GTU, LEU)
10628 arrive here as equality comparisons, or (GEU, LTU) are
10629 optimized away. No need to special-case them. */
10631 /* (eq (minus A B) C) -> (eq A (plus B C)) or
10632 (eq B (minus A C)), whichever simplifies. We can only do
10633 this for equality comparisons due to pathological cases involving
10634 overflows. */
10635 if (equality_comparison_p
10636 && 0 != (tem = simplify_binary_operation (PLUS, mode,
10637 XEXP (op0, 1), op1)))
10639 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10640 op1 = tem;
10641 continue;
10644 if (equality_comparison_p
10645 && 0 != (tem = simplify_binary_operation (MINUS, mode,
10646 XEXP (op0, 0), op1)))
10648 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10649 op1 = tem;
10650 continue;
10653 /* The sign bit of (minus (ashiftrt X C) X), where C is the number
10654 of bits in X minus 1, is one iff X > 0. */
10655 if (sign_bit_comparison_p && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ASHIFTRT
10656 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
10657 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1))
10658 == mode_width - 1
10659 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), XEXP (op0, 1)))
10661 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10662 code = (code == GE ? LE : GT);
10663 continue;
10665 break;
10667 case XOR:
10668 /* (eq (xor A B) C) -> (eq A (xor B C)). This is a simplification
10669 if C is zero or B is a constant. */
10670 if (equality_comparison_p
10671 && 0 != (tem = simplify_binary_operation (XOR, mode,
10672 XEXP (op0, 1), op1)))
10674 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10675 op1 = tem;
10676 continue;
10678 break;
10680 case EQ: case NE:
10681 case UNEQ: case LTGT:
10682 case LT: case LTU: case UNLT: case LE: case LEU: case UNLE:
10683 case GT: case GTU: case UNGT: case GE: case GEU: case UNGE:
10684 case UNORDERED: case ORDERED:
10685 /* We can't do anything if OP0 is a condition code value, rather
10686 than an actual data value. */
10687 if (const_op != 0
10688 || CC0_P (XEXP (op0, 0))
10689 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0))) == MODE_CC)
10690 break;
10692 /* Get the two operands being compared. */
10693 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == COMPARE)
10694 tem = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), tem1 = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1);
10695 else
10696 tem = XEXP (op0, 0), tem1 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10698 /* Check for the cases where we simply want the result of the
10699 earlier test or the opposite of that result. */
10700 if (code == NE || code == EQ
10701 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10702 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
10703 && (STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10704 & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10705 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)) - 1))))
10706 && (code == LT || code == GE)))
10708 enum rtx_code new_code;
10709 if (code == LT || code == NE)
10710 new_code = GET_CODE (op0);
10711 else
10712 new_code = reversed_comparison_code (op0, NULL);
10714 if (new_code != UNKNOWN)
10716 code = new_code;
10717 op0 = tem;
10718 op1 = tem1;
10719 continue;
10722 break;
10724 case IOR:
10725 /* The sign bit of (ior (plus X (const_int -1)) X) is nonzero
10726 iff X <= 0. */
10727 if (sign_bit_comparison_p && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == PLUS
10728 && XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1) == constm1_rtx
10729 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), XEXP (op0, 1)))
10731 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
10732 code = (code == GE ? GT : LE);
10733 continue;
10735 break;
10737 case AND:
10738 /* Convert (and (xshift 1 X) Y) to (and (lshiftrt Y X) 1). This
10739 will be converted to a ZERO_EXTRACT later. */
10740 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p
10741 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ASHIFT
10742 && XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0) == const1_rtx)
10744 op0 = simplify_and_const_int
10745 (NULL_RTX, mode, gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode,
10746 XEXP (op0, 1),
10747 XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)),
10748 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1);
10749 continue;
10752 /* If we are comparing (and (lshiftrt X C1) C2) for equality with
10753 zero and X is a comparison and C1 and C2 describe only bits set
10754 in STORE_FLAG_VALUE, we can compare with X. */
10755 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p
10756 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10757 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10758 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == LSHIFTRT
10759 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
10760 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)) >= 0
10761 && INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10763 mask = ((INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
10764 << INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)));
10765 if ((~STORE_FLAG_VALUE & mask) == 0
10766 && (COMPARISON_P (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0))
10767 || ((tem = get_last_value (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0))) != 0
10768 && COMPARISON_P (tem))))
10770 op0 = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0);
10771 continue;
10775 /* If we are doing an equality comparison of an AND of a bit equal
10776 to the sign bit, replace this with a LT or GE comparison of
10777 the underlying value. */
10778 if (equality_comparison_p
10779 && const_op == 0
10780 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10781 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10782 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
10783 == (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (mode_width - 1)))
10785 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10786 code = (code == EQ ? GE : LT);
10787 continue;
10790 /* If this AND operation is really a ZERO_EXTEND from a narrower
10791 mode, the constant fits within that mode, and this is either an
10792 equality or unsigned comparison, try to do this comparison in
10793 the narrower mode.
10795 Note that in:
10797 (ne:DI (and:DI (reg:DI 4) (const_int 0xffffffff)) (const_int 0))
10798 -> (ne:DI (reg:SI 4) (const_int 0))
10800 unless TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION allows it or the register is
10801 known to hold a value of the required mode the
10802 transformation is invalid. */
10803 if ((equality_comparison_p || unsigned_comparison_p)
10804 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10805 && (i = exact_log2 ((INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))
10806 & GET_MODE_MASK (mode))
10807 + 1)) >= 0
10808 && const_op >> i == 0
10809 && (tmode = mode_for_size (i, MODE_INT, 1)) != BLKmode
10810 && (TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode),
10811 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
10812 || (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0))
10813 && reg_truncated_to_mode (tmode, XEXP (op0, 0)))))
10815 op0 = gen_lowpart (tmode, XEXP (op0, 0));
10816 continue;
10819 /* If this is (and:M1 (subreg:M2 X 0) (const_int C1)) where C1
10820 fits in both M1 and M2 and the SUBREG is either paradoxical
10821 or represents the low part, permute the SUBREG and the AND
10822 and try again. */
10823 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == SUBREG)
10825 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c1;
10826 tmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (XEXP (op0, 0)));
10827 /* Require an integral mode, to avoid creating something like
10828 (AND:SF ...). */
10829 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (tmode)
10830 /* It is unsafe to commute the AND into the SUBREG if the
10831 SUBREG is paradoxical and WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS is
10832 not defined. As originally written the upper bits
10833 have a defined value due to the AND operation.
10834 However, if we commute the AND inside the SUBREG then
10835 they no longer have defined values and the meaning of
10836 the code has been changed. */
10837 && (0
10838 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10839 || (mode_width > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode)
10840 && mode_width <= BITS_PER_WORD)
10841 #endif
10842 || (mode_width <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode)
10843 && subreg_lowpart_p (XEXP (op0, 0))))
10844 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10845 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10846 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10847 && ((c1 = INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))) & ~mask) == 0
10848 && (c1 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (tmode)) == 0
10849 && c1 != mask
10850 && c1 != GET_MODE_MASK (tmode))
10852 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (AND, tmode,
10853 SUBREG_REG (XEXP (op0, 0)),
10854 gen_int_mode (c1, tmode));
10855 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
10856 continue;
10860 /* Convert (ne (and (not X) 1) 0) to (eq (and X 1) 0). */
10861 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p
10862 && XEXP (op0, 1) == const1_rtx
10863 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == NOT)
10865 op0 = simplify_and_const_int
10866 (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1);
10867 code = (code == NE ? EQ : NE);
10868 continue;
10871 /* Convert (ne (and (lshiftrt (not X)) 1) 0) to
10872 (eq (and (lshiftrt X) 1) 0).
10873 Also handle the case where (not X) is expressed using xor. */
10874 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p
10875 && XEXP (op0, 1) == const1_rtx
10876 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == LSHIFTRT)
10878 rtx shift_op = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0);
10879 rtx shift_count = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1);
10881 if (GET_CODE (shift_op) == NOT
10882 || (GET_CODE (shift_op) == XOR
10883 && GET_CODE (XEXP (shift_op, 1)) == CONST_INT
10884 && GET_CODE (shift_count) == CONST_INT
10885 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10886 && (INTVAL (XEXP (shift_op, 1))
10887 == (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (shift_count))))
10889 op0 = simplify_and_const_int
10890 (NULL_RTX, mode,
10891 gen_rtx_LSHIFTRT (mode, XEXP (shift_op, 0), shift_count),
10892 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1);
10893 code = (code == NE ? EQ : NE);
10894 continue;
10897 break;
10899 case ASHIFT:
10900 /* If we have (compare (ashift FOO N) (const_int C)) and
10901 the high order N bits of FOO (N+1 if an inequality comparison)
10902 are known to be zero, we can do this by comparing FOO with C
10903 shifted right N bits so long as the low-order N bits of C are
10904 zero. */
10905 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10906 && INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) >= 0
10907 && ((INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) + ! equality_comparison_p)
10908 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10909 && ((const_op
10910 & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))) - 1)) == 0)
10911 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10912 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (op0, 0), mode)
10913 & ~(mask >> (INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))
10914 + ! equality_comparison_p))) == 0)
10916 /* We must perform a logical shift, not an arithmetic one,
10917 as we want the top N bits of C to be zero. */
10918 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT temp = const_op & GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
10920 temp >>= INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1));
10921 op1 = gen_int_mode (temp, mode);
10922 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
10923 continue;
10926 /* If we are doing a sign bit comparison, it means we are testing
10927 a particular bit. Convert it to the appropriate AND. */
10928 if (sign_bit_comparison_p && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10929 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10931 op0 = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
10932 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
10933 << (mode_width - 1
10934 - INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)))));
10935 code = (code == LT ? NE : EQ);
10936 continue;
10939 /* If this an equality comparison with zero and we are shifting
10940 the low bit to the sign bit, we can convert this to an AND of the
10941 low-order bit. */
10942 if (const_op == 0 && equality_comparison_p
10943 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10944 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))
10945 == mode_width - 1)
10947 op0 = simplify_and_const_int (NULL_RTX, mode, XEXP (op0, 0),
10948 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 1);
10949 continue;
10951 break;
10953 case ASHIFTRT:
10954 /* If this is an equality comparison with zero, we can do this
10955 as a logical shift, which might be much simpler. */
10956 if (equality_comparison_p && const_op == 0
10957 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT)
10959 op0 = simplify_shift_const (NULL_RTX, LSHIFTRT, mode,
10960 XEXP (op0, 0),
10961 INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)));
10962 continue;
10965 /* If OP0 is a sign extension and CODE is not an unsigned comparison,
10966 do the comparison in a narrower mode. */
10967 if (! unsigned_comparison_p
10968 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10969 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == ASHIFT
10970 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)
10971 && (tmode = mode_for_size (mode_width - INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)),
10972 MODE_INT, 1)) != BLKmode
10973 && (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op
10974 + (GET_MODE_MASK (tmode) >> 1) + 1)
10975 <= GET_MODE_MASK (tmode)))
10977 op0 = gen_lowpart (tmode, XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0));
10978 continue;
10981 /* Likewise if OP0 is a PLUS of a sign extension with a
10982 constant, which is usually represented with the PLUS
10983 between the shifts. */
10984 if (! unsigned_comparison_p
10985 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
10986 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) == PLUS
10987 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
10988 && GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0)) == ASHIFT
10989 && XEXP (op0, 1) == XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), 1)
10990 && (tmode = mode_for_size (mode_width - INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)),
10991 MODE_INT, 1)) != BLKmode
10992 && (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op
10993 + (GET_MODE_MASK (tmode) >> 1) + 1)
10994 <= GET_MODE_MASK (tmode)))
10996 rtx inner = XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 0), 0);
10997 rtx add_const = XEXP (XEXP (op0, 0), 1);
10998 rtx new_const = simplify_gen_binary (ASHIFTRT, GET_MODE (op0),
10999 add_const, XEXP (op0, 1));
11001 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode,
11002 gen_lowpart (tmode, inner),
11003 new_const);
11004 continue;
11007 /* ... fall through ... */
11008 case LSHIFTRT:
11009 /* If we have (compare (xshiftrt FOO N) (const_int C)) and
11010 the low order N bits of FOO are known to be zero, we can do this
11011 by comparing FOO with C shifted left N bits so long as no
11012 overflow occurs. */
11013 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
11014 && INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) >= 0
11015 && INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11016 && mode_width <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11017 && (nonzero_bits (XEXP (op0, 0), mode)
11018 & (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))) - 1)) == 0
11019 && (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) const_op
11020 + (GET_CODE (op0) != LSHIFTRT
11021 ? ((GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1)) >> 1)
11022 + 1)
11023 : 0))
11024 <= GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))))
11026 /* If the shift was logical, then we must make the condition
11027 unsigned. */
11028 if (GET_CODE (op0) == LSHIFTRT)
11029 code = unsigned_condition (code);
11031 const_op <<= INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1));
11032 op1 = GEN_INT (const_op);
11033 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
11034 continue;
11037 /* If we are using this shift to extract just the sign bit, we
11038 can replace this with an LT or GE comparison. */
11039 if (const_op == 0
11040 && (equality_comparison_p || sign_bit_comparison_p)
11041 && GET_CODE (XEXP (op0, 1)) == CONST_INT
11042 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (op0, 1))
11043 == mode_width - 1)
11045 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
11046 code = (code == NE || code == GT ? LT : GE);
11047 continue;
11049 break;
11051 default:
11052 break;
11055 break;
11058 /* Now make any compound operations involved in this comparison. Then,
11059 check for an outmost SUBREG on OP0 that is not doing anything or is
11060 paradoxical. The latter transformation must only be performed when
11061 it is known that the "extra" bits will be the same in op0 and op1 or
11062 that they don't matter. There are three cases to consider:
11064 1. SUBREG_REG (op0) is a register. In this case the bits are don't
11065 care bits and we can assume they have any convenient value. So
11066 making the transformation is safe.
11068 2. SUBREG_REG (op0) is a memory and LOAD_EXTEND_OP is not defined.
11069 In this case the upper bits of op0 are undefined. We should not make
11070 the simplification in that case as we do not know the contents of
11071 those bits.
11073 3. SUBREG_REG (op0) is a memory and LOAD_EXTEND_OP is defined and not
11074 UNKNOWN. In that case we know those bits are zeros or ones. We must
11075 also be sure that they are the same as the upper bits of op1.
11077 We can never remove a SUBREG for a non-equality comparison because
11078 the sign bit is in a different place in the underlying object. */
11080 op0 = make_compound_operation (op0, op1 == const0_rtx ? COMPARE : SET);
11081 op1 = make_compound_operation (op1, SET);
11083 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG && subreg_lowpart_p (op0)
11084 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
11085 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0))) == MODE_INT
11086 && (code == NE || code == EQ))
11088 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
11089 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0))))
11091 /* For paradoxical subregs, allow case 1 as above. Case 3 isn't
11092 implemented. */
11093 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (op0)))
11095 op0 = SUBREG_REG (op0);
11096 op1 = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (op0), op1);
11099 else if ((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)))
11100 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11101 && (nonzero_bits (SUBREG_REG (op0),
11102 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)))
11103 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0))) == 0)
11105 tem = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)), op1);
11107 if ((nonzero_bits (tem, GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op0)))
11108 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (op0))) == 0)
11109 op0 = SUBREG_REG (op0), op1 = tem;
11113 /* We now do the opposite procedure: Some machines don't have compare
11114 insns in all modes. If OP0's mode is an integer mode smaller than a
11115 word and we can't do a compare in that mode, see if there is a larger
11116 mode for which we can do the compare. There are a number of cases in
11117 which we can use the wider mode. */
11119 mode = GET_MODE (op0);
11120 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11121 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < UNITS_PER_WORD
11122 && ! have_insn_for (COMPARE, mode))
11123 for (tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode);
11124 (tmode != VOIDmode
11125 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
11126 tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
11127 if (have_insn_for (COMPARE, tmode))
11129 int zero_extended;
11131 /* If the only nonzero bits in OP0 and OP1 are those in the
11132 narrower mode and this is an equality or unsigned comparison,
11133 we can use the wider mode. Similarly for sign-extended
11134 values, in which case it is true for all comparisons. */
11135 zero_extended = ((code == EQ || code == NE
11136 || code == GEU || code == GTU
11137 || code == LEU || code == LTU)
11138 && (nonzero_bits (op0, tmode)
11139 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == 0
11140 && ((GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT
11141 || (nonzero_bits (op1, tmode)
11142 & ~GET_MODE_MASK (mode)) == 0)));
11144 if (zero_extended
11145 || ((num_sign_bit_copies (op0, tmode)
11146 > (unsigned int) (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode)
11147 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))
11148 && (num_sign_bit_copies (op1, tmode)
11149 > (unsigned int) (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (tmode)
11150 - GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)))))
11152 /* If OP0 is an AND and we don't have an AND in MODE either,
11153 make a new AND in the proper mode. */
11154 if (GET_CODE (op0) == AND
11155 && !have_insn_for (AND, mode))
11156 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (AND, tmode,
11157 gen_lowpart (tmode,
11158 XEXP (op0, 0)),
11159 gen_lowpart (tmode,
11160 XEXP (op0, 1)));
11162 op0 = gen_lowpart (tmode, op0);
11163 if (zero_extended && GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
11164 op1 = GEN_INT (INTVAL (op1) & GET_MODE_MASK (mode));
11165 op1 = gen_lowpart (tmode, op1);
11166 break;
11169 /* If this is a test for negative, we can make an explicit
11170 test of the sign bit. */
11172 if (op1 == const0_rtx && (code == LT || code == GE)
11173 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11175 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (AND, tmode,
11176 gen_lowpart (tmode, op0),
11177 GEN_INT ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
11178 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
11179 - 1)));
11180 code = (code == LT) ? NE : EQ;
11181 break;
11185 #ifdef CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON
11186 /* If this machine only supports a subset of valid comparisons, see if we
11187 can convert an unsupported one into a supported one. */
11188 CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (code, op0, op1);
11189 #endif
11191 *pop0 = op0;
11192 *pop1 = op1;
11194 return code;
11197 /* Utility function for record_value_for_reg. Count number of
11198 rtxs in X. */
11199 static int
11200 count_rtxs (rtx x)
11202 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
11203 const char *fmt;
11204 int i, ret = 1;
11206 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == '2'
11207 || GET_RTX_CLASS (code) == 'c')
11209 rtx x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
11210 rtx x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
11212 if (x0 == x1)
11213 return 1 + 2 * count_rtxs (x0);
11215 if ((GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x1)) == '2'
11216 || GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x1)) == 'c')
11217 && (x0 == XEXP (x1, 0) || x0 == XEXP (x1, 1)))
11218 return 2 + 2 * count_rtxs (x0)
11219 + count_rtxs (x == XEXP (x1, 0)
11220 ? XEXP (x1, 1) : XEXP (x1, 0));
11222 if ((GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x0)) == '2'
11223 || GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (x0)) == 'c')
11224 && (x1 == XEXP (x0, 0) || x1 == XEXP (x0, 1)))
11225 return 2 + 2 * count_rtxs (x1)
11226 + count_rtxs (x == XEXP (x0, 0)
11227 ? XEXP (x0, 1) : XEXP (x0, 0));
11230 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
11231 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11232 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
11233 ret += count_rtxs (XEXP (x, i));
11235 return ret;
11238 /* Utility function for following routine. Called when X is part of a value
11239 being stored into last_set_value. Sets last_set_table_tick
11240 for each register mentioned. Similar to mention_regs in cse.c */
11242 static void
11243 update_table_tick (rtx x)
11245 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
11246 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
11247 int i;
11249 if (code == REG)
11251 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
11252 unsigned int endregno = END_REGNO (x);
11253 unsigned int r;
11255 for (r = regno; r < endregno; r++)
11257 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, r);
11258 rsp->last_set_table_tick = label_tick;
11261 return;
11264 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11265 /* Note that we can't have an "E" in values stored; see
11266 get_last_value_validate. */
11267 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
11269 /* Check for identical subexpressions. If x contains
11270 identical subexpression we only have to traverse one of
11271 them. */
11272 if (i == 0 && ARITHMETIC_P (x))
11274 /* Note that at this point x1 has already been
11275 processed. */
11276 rtx x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
11277 rtx x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
11279 /* If x0 and x1 are identical then there is no need to
11280 process x0. */
11281 if (x0 == x1)
11282 break;
11284 /* If x0 is identical to a subexpression of x1 then while
11285 processing x1, x0 has already been processed. Thus we
11286 are done with x. */
11287 if (ARITHMETIC_P (x1)
11288 && (x0 == XEXP (x1, 0) || x0 == XEXP (x1, 1)))
11289 break;
11291 /* If x1 is identical to a subexpression of x0 then we
11292 still have to process the rest of x0. */
11293 if (ARITHMETIC_P (x0)
11294 && (x1 == XEXP (x0, 0) || x1 == XEXP (x0, 1)))
11296 update_table_tick (XEXP (x0, x1 == XEXP (x0, 0) ? 1 : 0));
11297 break;
11301 update_table_tick (XEXP (x, i));
11305 /* Record that REG is set to VALUE in insn INSN. If VALUE is zero, we
11306 are saying that the register is clobbered and we no longer know its
11307 value. If INSN is zero, don't update reg_stat[].last_set; this is
11308 only permitted with VALUE also zero and is used to invalidate the
11309 register. */
11311 static void
11312 record_value_for_reg (rtx reg, rtx insn, rtx value)
11314 unsigned int regno = REGNO (reg);
11315 unsigned int endregno = END_REGNO (reg);
11316 unsigned int i;
11317 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11319 /* If VALUE contains REG and we have a previous value for REG, substitute
11320 the previous value. */
11321 if (value && insn && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, value))
11323 rtx tem;
11325 /* Set things up so get_last_value is allowed to see anything set up to
11326 our insn. */
11327 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (insn);
11328 tem = get_last_value (reg);
11330 /* If TEM is simply a binary operation with two CLOBBERs as operands,
11331 it isn't going to be useful and will take a lot of time to process,
11332 so just use the CLOBBER. */
11334 if (tem)
11336 if (ARITHMETIC_P (tem)
11337 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tem, 0)) == CLOBBER
11338 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tem, 1)) == CLOBBER)
11339 tem = XEXP (tem, 0);
11340 else if (count_occurrences (value, reg, 1) >= 2)
11342 /* If there are two or more occurrences of REG in VALUE,
11343 prevent the value from growing too much. */
11344 if (count_rtxs (tem) > MAX_LAST_VALUE_RTL)
11345 tem = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (tem), const0_rtx);
11348 value = replace_rtx (copy_rtx (value), reg, tem);
11352 /* For each register modified, show we don't know its value, that
11353 we don't know about its bitwise content, that its value has been
11354 updated, and that we don't know the location of the death of the
11355 register. */
11356 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
11358 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, i);
11360 if (insn)
11361 rsp->last_set = insn;
11363 rsp->last_set_value = 0;
11364 rsp->last_set_mode = 0;
11365 rsp->last_set_nonzero_bits = 0;
11366 rsp->last_set_sign_bit_copies = 0;
11367 rsp->last_death = 0;
11368 rsp->truncated_to_mode = 0;
11371 /* Mark registers that are being referenced in this value. */
11372 if (value)
11373 update_table_tick (value);
11375 /* Now update the status of each register being set.
11376 If someone is using this register in this block, set this register
11377 to invalid since we will get confused between the two lives in this
11378 basic block. This makes using this register always invalid. In cse, we
11379 scan the table to invalidate all entries using this register, but this
11380 is too much work for us. */
11382 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
11384 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, i);
11385 rsp->last_set_label = label_tick;
11386 if (!insn
11387 || (value && rsp->last_set_table_tick >= label_tick_ebb_start))
11388 rsp->last_set_invalid = 1;
11389 else
11390 rsp->last_set_invalid = 0;
11393 /* The value being assigned might refer to X (like in "x++;"). In that
11394 case, we must replace it with (clobber (const_int 0)) to prevent
11395 infinite loops. */
11396 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno);
11397 if (value && ! get_last_value_validate (&value, insn,
11398 rsp->last_set_label, 0))
11400 value = copy_rtx (value);
11401 if (! get_last_value_validate (&value, insn,
11402 rsp->last_set_label, 1))
11403 value = 0;
11406 /* For the main register being modified, update the value, the mode, the
11407 nonzero bits, and the number of sign bit copies. */
11409 rsp->last_set_value = value;
11411 if (value)
11413 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (reg);
11414 subst_low_luid = DF_INSN_LUID (insn);
11415 rsp->last_set_mode = mode;
11416 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
11417 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11418 mode = nonzero_bits_mode;
11419 rsp->last_set_nonzero_bits = nonzero_bits (value, mode);
11420 rsp->last_set_sign_bit_copies
11421 = num_sign_bit_copies (value, GET_MODE (reg));
11425 /* Called via note_stores from record_dead_and_set_regs to handle one
11426 SET or CLOBBER in an insn. DATA is the instruction in which the
11427 set is occurring. */
11429 static void
11430 record_dead_and_set_regs_1 (rtx dest, const_rtx setter, void *data)
11432 rtx record_dead_insn = (rtx) data;
11434 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
11435 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
11437 if (!record_dead_insn)
11439 if (REG_P (dest))
11440 record_value_for_reg (dest, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
11441 return;
11444 if (REG_P (dest))
11446 /* If we are setting the whole register, we know its value. Otherwise
11447 show that we don't know the value. We can handle SUBREG in
11448 some cases. */
11449 if (GET_CODE (setter) == SET && dest == SET_DEST (setter))
11450 record_value_for_reg (dest, record_dead_insn, SET_SRC (setter));
11451 else if (GET_CODE (setter) == SET
11452 && GET_CODE (SET_DEST (setter)) == SUBREG
11453 && SUBREG_REG (SET_DEST (setter)) == dest
11454 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (dest)) <= BITS_PER_WORD
11455 && subreg_lowpart_p (SET_DEST (setter)))
11456 record_value_for_reg (dest, record_dead_insn,
11457 gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (dest),
11458 SET_SRC (setter)));
11459 else
11460 record_value_for_reg (dest, record_dead_insn, NULL_RTX);
11462 else if (MEM_P (dest)
11463 /* Ignore pushes, they clobber nothing. */
11464 && ! push_operand (dest, GET_MODE (dest)))
11465 mem_last_set = DF_INSN_LUID (record_dead_insn);
11468 /* Update the records of when each REG was most recently set or killed
11469 for the things done by INSN. This is the last thing done in processing
11470 INSN in the combiner loop.
11472 We update reg_stat[], in particular fields last_set, last_set_value,
11473 last_set_mode, last_set_nonzero_bits, last_set_sign_bit_copies,
11474 last_death, and also the similar information mem_last_set (which insn
11475 most recently modified memory) and last_call_luid (which insn was the
11476 most recent subroutine call). */
11478 static void
11479 record_dead_and_set_regs (rtx insn)
11481 rtx link;
11482 unsigned int i;
11484 for (link = REG_NOTES (insn); link; link = XEXP (link, 1))
11486 if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_DEAD
11487 && REG_P (XEXP (link, 0)))
11489 unsigned int regno = REGNO (XEXP (link, 0));
11490 unsigned int endregno = END_REGNO (XEXP (link, 0));
11492 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
11494 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11496 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, i);
11497 rsp->last_death = insn;
11500 else if (REG_NOTE_KIND (link) == REG_INC)
11501 record_value_for_reg (XEXP (link, 0), insn, NULL_RTX);
11504 if (CALL_P (insn))
11506 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
11507 if (TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (regs_invalidated_by_call, i))
11509 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11511 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, i);
11512 rsp->last_set_invalid = 1;
11513 rsp->last_set = insn;
11514 rsp->last_set_value = 0;
11515 rsp->last_set_mode = 0;
11516 rsp->last_set_nonzero_bits = 0;
11517 rsp->last_set_sign_bit_copies = 0;
11518 rsp->last_death = 0;
11519 rsp->truncated_to_mode = 0;
11522 last_call_luid = mem_last_set = DF_INSN_LUID (insn);
11524 /* We can't combine into a call pattern. Remember, though, that
11525 the return value register is set at this LUID. We could
11526 still replace a register with the return value from the
11527 wrong subroutine call! */
11528 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), record_dead_and_set_regs_1, NULL_RTX);
11530 else
11531 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), record_dead_and_set_regs_1, insn);
11534 /* If a SUBREG has the promoted bit set, it is in fact a property of the
11535 register present in the SUBREG, so for each such SUBREG go back and
11536 adjust nonzero and sign bit information of the registers that are
11537 known to have some zero/sign bits set.
11539 This is needed because when combine blows the SUBREGs away, the
11540 information on zero/sign bits is lost and further combines can be
11541 missed because of that. */
11543 static void
11544 record_promoted_value (rtx insn, rtx subreg)
11546 rtx links, set;
11547 unsigned int regno = REGNO (SUBREG_REG (subreg));
11548 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (subreg);
11550 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11551 return;
11553 for (links = LOG_LINKS (insn); links;)
11555 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11557 insn = XEXP (links, 0);
11558 set = single_set (insn);
11560 if (! set || !REG_P (SET_DEST (set))
11561 || REGNO (SET_DEST (set)) != regno
11562 || GET_MODE (SET_DEST (set)) != GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (subreg)))
11564 links = XEXP (links, 1);
11565 continue;
11568 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno);
11569 if (rsp->last_set == insn)
11571 if (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (subreg) > 0)
11572 rsp->last_set_nonzero_bits &= GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
11575 if (REG_P (SET_SRC (set)))
11577 regno = REGNO (SET_SRC (set));
11578 links = LOG_LINKS (insn);
11580 else
11581 break;
11585 /* Check if X, a register, is known to contain a value already
11586 truncated to MODE. In this case we can use a subreg to refer to
11587 the truncated value even though in the generic case we would need
11588 an explicit truncation. */
11590 static bool
11591 reg_truncated_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, const_rtx x)
11593 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, REGNO (x));
11594 enum machine_mode truncated = rsp->truncated_to_mode;
11596 if (truncated == 0
11597 || rsp->truncation_label < label_tick_ebb_start)
11598 return false;
11599 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (truncated) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
11600 return true;
11601 if (TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
11602 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (truncated)))
11603 return true;
11604 return false;
11607 /* X is a REG or a SUBREG. If X is some sort of a truncation record
11608 it. For non-TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION targets we might be able to turn
11609 a truncate into a subreg using this information. */
11611 static void
11612 record_truncated_value (rtx x)
11614 enum machine_mode truncated_mode;
11615 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11617 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x)))
11619 enum machine_mode original_mode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x));
11620 truncated_mode = GET_MODE (x);
11622 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (original_mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (truncated_mode))
11623 return;
11625 if (TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (truncated_mode),
11626 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (original_mode)))
11627 return;
11629 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
11631 /* ??? For hard-regs we now record everything. We might be able to
11632 optimize this using last_set_mode. */
11633 else if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11634 truncated_mode = GET_MODE (x);
11635 else
11636 return;
11638 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, REGNO (x));
11639 if (rsp->truncated_to_mode == 0
11640 || rsp->truncation_label < label_tick_ebb_start
11641 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (truncated_mode)
11642 < GET_MODE_SIZE (rsp->truncated_to_mode)))
11644 rsp->truncated_to_mode = truncated_mode;
11645 rsp->truncation_label = label_tick;
11649 /* Scan X for promoted SUBREGs and truncated REGs. For each one
11650 found, note what it implies to the registers used in it. */
11652 static void
11653 check_conversions (rtx insn, rtx x)
11655 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG || REG_P (x))
11657 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
11658 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
11659 && REG_P (SUBREG_REG (x)))
11660 record_promoted_value (insn, x);
11662 record_truncated_value (x);
11664 else
11666 const char *format = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
11667 int i, j;
11669 for (i = 0; i < GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x)); i++)
11670 switch (format[i])
11672 case 'e':
11673 check_conversions (insn, XEXP (x, i));
11674 break;
11675 case 'V':
11676 case 'E':
11677 if (XVEC (x, i) != 0)
11678 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
11679 check_conversions (insn, XVECEXP (x, i, j));
11680 break;
11685 /* Utility routine for the following function. Verify that all the registers
11686 mentioned in *LOC are valid when *LOC was part of a value set when
11687 label_tick == TICK. Return 0 if some are not.
11689 If REPLACE is nonzero, replace the invalid reference with
11690 (clobber (const_int 0)) and return 1. This replacement is useful because
11691 we often can get useful information about the form of a value (e.g., if
11692 it was produced by a shift that always produces -1 or 0) even though
11693 we don't know exactly what registers it was produced from. */
11695 static int
11696 get_last_value_validate (rtx *loc, rtx insn, int tick, int replace)
11698 rtx x = *loc;
11699 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (GET_CODE (x));
11700 int len = GET_RTX_LENGTH (GET_CODE (x));
11701 int i;
11703 if (REG_P (x))
11705 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
11706 unsigned int endregno = END_REGNO (x);
11707 unsigned int j;
11709 for (j = regno; j < endregno; j++)
11711 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, j);
11712 if (rsp->last_set_invalid
11713 /* If this is a pseudo-register that was only set once and not
11714 live at the beginning of the function, it is always valid. */
11715 || (! (regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
11716 && REG_N_SETS (regno) == 1
11717 && (!REGNO_REG_SET_P
11718 (DF_LR_IN (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb), regno)))
11719 && rsp->last_set_label > tick))
11721 if (replace)
11722 *loc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (x), const0_rtx);
11723 return replace;
11727 return 1;
11729 /* If this is a memory reference, make sure that there were
11730 no stores after it that might have clobbered the value. We don't
11731 have alias info, so we assume any store invalidates it. */
11732 else if (MEM_P (x) && !MEM_READONLY_P (x)
11733 && DF_INSN_LUID (insn) <= mem_last_set)
11735 if (replace)
11736 *loc = gen_rtx_CLOBBER (GET_MODE (x), const0_rtx);
11737 return replace;
11740 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
11742 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
11744 /* Check for identical subexpressions. If x contains
11745 identical subexpression we only have to traverse one of
11746 them. */
11747 if (i == 1 && ARITHMETIC_P (x))
11749 /* Note that at this point x0 has already been checked
11750 and found valid. */
11751 rtx x0 = XEXP (x, 0);
11752 rtx x1 = XEXP (x, 1);
11754 /* If x0 and x1 are identical then x is also valid. */
11755 if (x0 == x1)
11756 return 1;
11758 /* If x1 is identical to a subexpression of x0 then
11759 while checking x0, x1 has already been checked. Thus
11760 it is valid and so as x. */
11761 if (ARITHMETIC_P (x0)
11762 && (x1 == XEXP (x0, 0) || x1 == XEXP (x0, 1)))
11763 return 1;
11765 /* If x0 is identical to a subexpression of x1 then x is
11766 valid iff the rest of x1 is valid. */
11767 if (ARITHMETIC_P (x1)
11768 && (x0 == XEXP (x1, 0) || x0 == XEXP (x1, 1)))
11769 return
11770 get_last_value_validate (&XEXP (x1,
11771 x0 == XEXP (x1, 0) ? 1 : 0),
11772 insn, tick, replace);
11775 if (get_last_value_validate (&XEXP (x, i), insn, tick,
11776 replace) == 0)
11777 return 0;
11779 /* Don't bother with these. They shouldn't occur anyway. */
11780 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
11781 return 0;
11784 /* If we haven't found a reason for it to be invalid, it is valid. */
11785 return 1;
11788 /* Get the last value assigned to X, if known. Some registers
11789 in the value may be replaced with (clobber (const_int 0)) if their value
11790 is known longer known reliably. */
11792 static rtx
11793 get_last_value (const_rtx x)
11795 unsigned int regno;
11796 rtx value;
11797 reg_stat_type *rsp;
11799 /* If this is a non-paradoxical SUBREG, get the value of its operand and
11800 then convert it to the desired mode. If this is a paradoxical SUBREG,
11801 we cannot predict what values the "extra" bits might have. */
11802 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG
11803 && subreg_lowpart_p (x)
11804 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))
11805 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))))
11806 && (value = get_last_value (SUBREG_REG (x))) != 0)
11807 return gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (x), value);
11809 if (!REG_P (x))
11810 return 0;
11812 regno = REGNO (x);
11813 rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno);
11814 value = rsp->last_set_value;
11816 /* If we don't have a value, or if it isn't for this basic block and
11817 it's either a hard register, set more than once, or it's a live
11818 at the beginning of the function, return 0.
11820 Because if it's not live at the beginning of the function then the reg
11821 is always set before being used (is never used without being set).
11822 And, if it's set only once, and it's always set before use, then all
11823 uses must have the same last value, even if it's not from this basic
11824 block. */
11826 if (value == 0
11827 || (rsp->last_set_label < label_tick_ebb_start
11828 && (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
11829 || REG_N_SETS (regno) != 1
11830 || REGNO_REG_SET_P
11831 (DF_LR_IN (ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb), regno))))
11832 return 0;
11834 /* If the value was set in a later insn than the ones we are processing,
11835 we can't use it even if the register was only set once. */
11836 if (rsp->last_set_label == label_tick
11837 && DF_INSN_LUID (rsp->last_set) >= subst_low_luid)
11838 return 0;
11840 /* If the value has all its registers valid, return it. */
11841 if (get_last_value_validate (&value, rsp->last_set,
11842 rsp->last_set_label, 0))
11843 return value;
11845 /* Otherwise, make a copy and replace any invalid register with
11846 (clobber (const_int 0)). If that fails for some reason, return 0. */
11848 value = copy_rtx (value);
11849 if (get_last_value_validate (&value, rsp->last_set,
11850 rsp->last_set_label, 1))
11851 return value;
11853 return 0;
11856 /* Return nonzero if expression X refers to a REG or to memory
11857 that is set in an instruction more recent than FROM_LUID. */
11859 static int
11860 use_crosses_set_p (const_rtx x, int from_luid)
11862 const char *fmt;
11863 int i;
11864 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
11866 if (code == REG)
11868 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
11869 unsigned endreg = END_REGNO (x);
11871 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
11872 /* Don't allow uses of the stack pointer to be moved,
11873 because we don't know whether the move crosses a push insn. */
11874 if (regno == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM && PUSH_ARGS)
11875 return 1;
11876 #endif
11877 for (; regno < endreg; regno++)
11879 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno);
11880 if (rsp->last_set
11881 && rsp->last_set_label == label_tick
11882 && DF_INSN_LUID (rsp->last_set) > from_luid)
11883 return 1;
11885 return 0;
11888 if (code == MEM && mem_last_set > from_luid)
11889 return 1;
11891 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
11893 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11895 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
11897 int j;
11898 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
11899 if (use_crosses_set_p (XVECEXP (x, i, j), from_luid))
11900 return 1;
11902 else if (fmt[i] == 'e'
11903 && use_crosses_set_p (XEXP (x, i), from_luid))
11904 return 1;
11906 return 0;
11909 /* Define three variables used for communication between the following
11910 routines. */
11912 static unsigned int reg_dead_regno, reg_dead_endregno;
11913 static int reg_dead_flag;
11915 /* Function called via note_stores from reg_dead_at_p.
11917 If DEST is within [reg_dead_regno, reg_dead_endregno), set
11918 reg_dead_flag to 1 if X is a CLOBBER and to -1 it is a SET. */
11920 static void
11921 reg_dead_at_p_1 (rtx dest, const_rtx x, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11923 unsigned int regno, endregno;
11925 if (!REG_P (dest))
11926 return;
11928 regno = REGNO (dest);
11929 endregno = END_REGNO (dest);
11930 if (reg_dead_endregno > regno && reg_dead_regno < endregno)
11931 reg_dead_flag = (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER) ? 1 : -1;
11934 /* Return nonzero if REG is known to be dead at INSN.
11936 We scan backwards from INSN. If we hit a REG_DEAD note or a CLOBBER
11937 referencing REG, it is dead. If we hit a SET referencing REG, it is
11938 live. Otherwise, see if it is live or dead at the start of the basic
11939 block we are in. Hard regs marked as being live in NEWPAT_USED_REGS
11940 must be assumed to be always live. */
11942 static int
11943 reg_dead_at_p (rtx reg, rtx insn)
11945 basic_block block;
11946 unsigned int i;
11948 /* Set variables for reg_dead_at_p_1. */
11949 reg_dead_regno = REGNO (reg);
11950 reg_dead_endregno = END_REGNO (reg);
11952 reg_dead_flag = 0;
11954 /* Check that reg isn't mentioned in NEWPAT_USED_REGS. For fixed registers
11955 we allow the machine description to decide whether use-and-clobber
11956 patterns are OK. */
11957 if (reg_dead_regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
11959 for (i = reg_dead_regno; i < reg_dead_endregno; i++)
11960 if (!fixed_regs[i] && TEST_HARD_REG_BIT (newpat_used_regs, i))
11961 return 0;
11964 /* Scan backwards until we find a REG_DEAD note, SET, CLOBBER, label, or
11965 beginning of function. */
11966 for (; insn && !LABEL_P (insn) && !BARRIER_P (insn);
11967 insn = prev_nonnote_insn (insn))
11969 note_stores (PATTERN (insn), reg_dead_at_p_1, NULL);
11970 if (reg_dead_flag)
11971 return reg_dead_flag == 1 ? 1 : 0;
11973 if (find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, reg_dead_regno))
11974 return 1;
11977 /* Get the basic block that we were in. */
11978 if (insn == 0)
11979 block = ENTRY_BLOCK_PTR->next_bb;
11980 else
11982 FOR_EACH_BB (block)
11983 if (insn == BB_HEAD (block))
11984 break;
11986 if (block == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR)
11987 return 0;
11990 for (i = reg_dead_regno; i < reg_dead_endregno; i++)
11991 if (REGNO_REG_SET_P (df_get_live_in (block), i))
11992 return 0;
11994 return 1;
11997 /* Note hard registers in X that are used. */
11999 static void
12000 mark_used_regs_combine (rtx x)
12002 RTX_CODE code = GET_CODE (x);
12003 unsigned int regno;
12004 int i;
12006 switch (code)
12008 case LABEL_REF:
12009 case SYMBOL_REF:
12010 case CONST_INT:
12011 case CONST:
12012 case CONST_DOUBLE:
12013 case CONST_VECTOR:
12014 case PC:
12015 case ADDR_VEC:
12016 case ADDR_DIFF_VEC:
12017 case ASM_INPUT:
12018 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
12019 /* CC0 must die in the insn after it is set, so we don't need to take
12020 special note of it here. */
12021 case CC0:
12022 #endif
12023 return;
12025 case CLOBBER:
12026 /* If we are clobbering a MEM, mark any hard registers inside the
12027 address as used. */
12028 if (MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
12029 mark_used_regs_combine (XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0));
12030 return;
12032 case REG:
12033 regno = REGNO (x);
12034 /* A hard reg in a wide mode may really be multiple registers.
12035 If so, mark all of them just like the first. */
12036 if (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12038 /* None of this applies to the stack, frame or arg pointers. */
12039 if (regno == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
12040 #if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12041 || regno == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12042 #endif
12043 #if FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM != ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
12044 || (regno == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM && fixed_regs[regno])
12045 #endif
12046 || regno == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
12047 return;
12049 add_to_hard_reg_set (&newpat_used_regs, GET_MODE (x), regno);
12051 return;
12053 case SET:
12055 /* If setting a MEM, or a SUBREG of a MEM, then note any hard regs in
12056 the address. */
12057 rtx testreg = SET_DEST (x);
12059 while (GET_CODE (testreg) == SUBREG
12060 || GET_CODE (testreg) == ZERO_EXTRACT
12061 || GET_CODE (testreg) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
12062 testreg = XEXP (testreg, 0);
12064 if (MEM_P (testreg))
12065 mark_used_regs_combine (XEXP (testreg, 0));
12067 mark_used_regs_combine (SET_SRC (x));
12069 return;
12071 default:
12072 break;
12075 /* Recursively scan the operands of this expression. */
12078 const char *fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
12080 for (i = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
12082 if (fmt[i] == 'e')
12083 mark_used_regs_combine (XEXP (x, i));
12084 else if (fmt[i] == 'E')
12086 int j;
12088 for (j = 0; j < XVECLEN (x, i); j++)
12089 mark_used_regs_combine (XVECEXP (x, i, j));
12095 /* Remove register number REGNO from the dead registers list of INSN.
12097 Return the note used to record the death, if there was one. */
12100 remove_death (unsigned int regno, rtx insn)
12102 rtx note = find_regno_note (insn, REG_DEAD, regno);
12104 if (note)
12105 remove_note (insn, note);
12107 return note;
12110 /* For each register (hardware or pseudo) used within expression X, if its
12111 death is in an instruction with luid between FROM_LUID (inclusive) and
12112 TO_INSN (exclusive), put a REG_DEAD note for that register in the
12113 list headed by PNOTES.
12115 That said, don't move registers killed by maybe_kill_insn.
12117 This is done when X is being merged by combination into TO_INSN. These
12118 notes will then be distributed as needed. */
12120 static void
12121 move_deaths (rtx x, rtx maybe_kill_insn, int from_luid, rtx to_insn,
12122 rtx *pnotes)
12124 const char *fmt;
12125 int len, i;
12126 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (x);
12128 if (code == REG)
12130 unsigned int regno = REGNO (x);
12131 rtx where_dead = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno)->last_death;
12133 /* Don't move the register if it gets killed in between from and to. */
12134 if (maybe_kill_insn && reg_set_p (x, maybe_kill_insn)
12135 && ! reg_referenced_p (x, maybe_kill_insn))
12136 return;
12138 if (where_dead
12139 && DF_INSN_LUID (where_dead) >= from_luid
12140 && DF_INSN_LUID (where_dead) < DF_INSN_LUID (to_insn))
12142 rtx note = remove_death (regno, where_dead);
12144 /* It is possible for the call above to return 0. This can occur
12145 when last_death points to I2 or I1 that we combined with.
12146 In that case make a new note.
12148 We must also check for the case where X is a hard register
12149 and NOTE is a death note for a range of hard registers
12150 including X. In that case, we must put REG_DEAD notes for
12151 the remaining registers in place of NOTE. */
12153 if (note != 0 && regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12154 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (note, 0)))
12155 > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x))))
12157 unsigned int deadregno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
12158 unsigned int deadend = END_HARD_REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
12159 unsigned int ourend = END_HARD_REGNO (x);
12160 unsigned int i;
12162 for (i = deadregno; i < deadend; i++)
12163 if (i < regno || i >= ourend)
12164 REG_NOTES (where_dead)
12165 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD,
12166 regno_reg_rtx[i],
12167 REG_NOTES (where_dead));
12170 /* If we didn't find any note, or if we found a REG_DEAD note that
12171 covers only part of the given reg, and we have a multi-reg hard
12172 register, then to be safe we must check for REG_DEAD notes
12173 for each register other than the first. They could have
12174 their own REG_DEAD notes lying around. */
12175 else if ((note == 0
12176 || (note != 0
12177 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (note, 0)))
12178 < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))
12179 && regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12180 && hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (x)] > 1)
12182 unsigned int ourend = END_HARD_REGNO (x);
12183 unsigned int i, offset;
12184 rtx oldnotes = 0;
12186 if (note)
12187 offset = hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (XEXP (note, 0))];
12188 else
12189 offset = 1;
12191 for (i = regno + offset; i < ourend; i++)
12192 move_deaths (regno_reg_rtx[i],
12193 maybe_kill_insn, from_luid, to_insn, &oldnotes);
12196 if (note != 0 && GET_MODE (XEXP (note, 0)) == GET_MODE (x))
12198 XEXP (note, 1) = *pnotes;
12199 *pnotes = note;
12201 else
12202 *pnotes = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, x, *pnotes);
12205 return;
12208 else if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
12210 rtx dest = SET_DEST (x);
12212 move_deaths (SET_SRC (x), maybe_kill_insn, from_luid, to_insn, pnotes);
12214 /* In the case of a ZERO_EXTRACT, a STRICT_LOW_PART, or a SUBREG
12215 that accesses one word of a multi-word item, some
12216 piece of everything register in the expression is used by
12217 this insn, so remove any old death. */
12218 /* ??? So why do we test for equality of the sizes? */
12220 if (GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT
12221 || GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
12222 || (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG
12223 && (((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest))
12224 + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD)
12225 == ((GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (dest)))
12226 + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD))))
12228 move_deaths (dest, maybe_kill_insn, from_luid, to_insn, pnotes);
12229 return;
12232 /* If this is some other SUBREG, we know it replaces the entire
12233 value, so use that as the destination. */
12234 if (GET_CODE (dest) == SUBREG)
12235 dest = SUBREG_REG (dest);
12237 /* If this is a MEM, adjust deaths of anything used in the address.
12238 For a REG (the only other possibility), the entire value is
12239 being replaced so the old value is not used in this insn. */
12241 if (MEM_P (dest))
12242 move_deaths (XEXP (dest, 0), maybe_kill_insn, from_luid,
12243 to_insn, pnotes);
12244 return;
12247 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CLOBBER)
12248 return;
12250 len = GET_RTX_LENGTH (code);
12251 fmt = GET_RTX_FORMAT (code);
12253 for (i = 0; i < len; i++)
12255 if (fmt[i] == 'E')
12257 int j;
12258 for (j = XVECLEN (x, i) - 1; j >= 0; j--)
12259 move_deaths (XVECEXP (x, i, j), maybe_kill_insn, from_luid,
12260 to_insn, pnotes);
12262 else if (fmt[i] == 'e')
12263 move_deaths (XEXP (x, i), maybe_kill_insn, from_luid, to_insn, pnotes);
12267 /* Return 1 if X is the target of a bit-field assignment in BODY, the
12268 pattern of an insn. X must be a REG. */
12270 static int
12271 reg_bitfield_target_p (rtx x, rtx body)
12273 int i;
12275 if (GET_CODE (body) == SET)
12277 rtx dest = SET_DEST (body);
12278 rtx target;
12279 unsigned int regno, tregno, endregno, endtregno;
12281 if (GET_CODE (dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT)
12282 target = XEXP (dest, 0);
12283 else if (GET_CODE (dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
12284 target = SUBREG_REG (XEXP (dest, 0));
12285 else
12286 return 0;
12288 if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG)
12289 target = SUBREG_REG (target);
12291 if (!REG_P (target))
12292 return 0;
12294 tregno = REGNO (target), regno = REGNO (x);
12295 if (tregno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER || regno >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12296 return target == x;
12298 endtregno = end_hard_regno (GET_MODE (target), tregno);
12299 endregno = end_hard_regno (GET_MODE (x), regno);
12301 return endregno > tregno && regno < endtregno;
12304 else if (GET_CODE (body) == PARALLEL)
12305 for (i = XVECLEN (body, 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
12306 if (reg_bitfield_target_p (x, XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
12307 return 1;
12309 return 0;
12312 /* Given a chain of REG_NOTES originally from FROM_INSN, try to place them
12313 as appropriate. I3 and I2 are the insns resulting from the combination
12314 insns including FROM (I2 may be zero).
12316 ELIM_I2 and ELIM_I1 are either zero or registers that we know will
12317 not need REG_DEAD notes because they are being substituted for. This
12318 saves searching in the most common cases.
12320 Each note in the list is either ignored or placed on some insns, depending
12321 on the type of note. */
12323 static void
12324 distribute_notes (rtx notes, rtx from_insn, rtx i3, rtx i2, rtx elim_i2,
12325 rtx elim_i1)
12327 rtx note, next_note;
12328 rtx tem;
12330 for (note = notes; note; note = next_note)
12332 rtx place = 0, place2 = 0;
12334 next_note = XEXP (note, 1);
12335 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
12337 case REG_BR_PROB:
12338 case REG_BR_PRED:
12339 /* Doesn't matter much where we put this, as long as it's somewhere.
12340 It is preferable to keep these notes on branches, which is most
12341 likely to be i3. */
12342 place = i3;
12343 break;
12345 case REG_VALUE_PROFILE:
12346 /* Just get rid of this note, as it is unused later anyway. */
12347 break;
12349 case REG_NON_LOCAL_GOTO:
12350 if (JUMP_P (i3))
12351 place = i3;
12352 else
12354 gcc_assert (i2 && JUMP_P (i2));
12355 place = i2;
12357 break;
12359 case REG_EH_REGION:
12360 /* These notes must remain with the call or trapping instruction. */
12361 if (CALL_P (i3))
12362 place = i3;
12363 else if (i2 && CALL_P (i2))
12364 place = i2;
12365 else
12367 gcc_assert (flag_non_call_exceptions);
12368 if (may_trap_p (i3))
12369 place = i3;
12370 else if (i2 && may_trap_p (i2))
12371 place = i2;
12372 /* ??? Otherwise assume we've combined things such that we
12373 can now prove that the instructions can't trap. Drop the
12374 note in this case. */
12376 break;
12378 case REG_NORETURN:
12379 case REG_SETJMP:
12380 /* These notes must remain with the call. It should not be
12381 possible for both I2 and I3 to be a call. */
12382 if (CALL_P (i3))
12383 place = i3;
12384 else
12386 gcc_assert (i2 && CALL_P (i2));
12387 place = i2;
12389 break;
12391 case REG_UNUSED:
12392 /* Any clobbers for i3 may still exist, and so we must process
12393 REG_UNUSED notes from that insn.
12395 Any clobbers from i2 or i1 can only exist if they were added by
12396 recog_for_combine. In that case, recog_for_combine created the
12397 necessary REG_UNUSED notes. Trying to keep any original
12398 REG_UNUSED notes from these insns can cause incorrect output
12399 if it is for the same register as the original i3 dest.
12400 In that case, we will notice that the register is set in i3,
12401 and then add a REG_UNUSED note for the destination of i3, which
12402 is wrong. However, it is possible to have REG_UNUSED notes from
12403 i2 or i1 for register which were both used and clobbered, so
12404 we keep notes from i2 or i1 if they will turn into REG_DEAD
12405 notes. */
12407 /* If this register is set or clobbered in I3, put the note there
12408 unless there is one already. */
12409 if (reg_set_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i3)))
12411 if (from_insn != i3)
12412 break;
12414 if (! (REG_P (XEXP (note, 0))
12415 ? find_regno_note (i3, REG_UNUSED, REGNO (XEXP (note, 0)))
12416 : find_reg_note (i3, REG_UNUSED, XEXP (note, 0))))
12417 place = i3;
12419 /* Otherwise, if this register is used by I3, then this register
12420 now dies here, so we must put a REG_DEAD note here unless there
12421 is one already. */
12422 else if (reg_referenced_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i3))
12423 && ! (REG_P (XEXP (note, 0))
12424 ? find_regno_note (i3, REG_DEAD,
12425 REGNO (XEXP (note, 0)))
12426 : find_reg_note (i3, REG_DEAD, XEXP (note, 0))))
12428 PUT_REG_NOTE_KIND (note, REG_DEAD);
12429 place = i3;
12431 break;
12433 case REG_EQUAL:
12434 case REG_EQUIV:
12435 case REG_NOALIAS:
12436 /* These notes say something about results of an insn. We can
12437 only support them if they used to be on I3 in which case they
12438 remain on I3. Otherwise they are ignored.
12440 If the note refers to an expression that is not a constant, we
12441 must also ignore the note since we cannot tell whether the
12442 equivalence is still true. It might be possible to do
12443 slightly better than this (we only have a problem if I2DEST
12444 or I1DEST is present in the expression), but it doesn't
12445 seem worth the trouble. */
12447 if (from_insn == i3
12448 && (XEXP (note, 0) == 0 || CONSTANT_P (XEXP (note, 0))))
12449 place = i3;
12450 break;
12452 case REG_INC:
12453 case REG_NO_CONFLICT:
12454 /* These notes say something about how a register is used. They must
12455 be present on any use of the register in I2 or I3. */
12456 if (reg_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i3)))
12457 place = i3;
12459 if (i2 && reg_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i2)))
12461 if (place)
12462 place2 = i2;
12463 else
12464 place = i2;
12466 break;
12468 case REG_LABEL_TARGET:
12469 case REG_LABEL_OPERAND:
12470 /* This can show up in several ways -- either directly in the
12471 pattern, or hidden off in the constant pool with (or without?)
12472 a REG_EQUAL note. */
12473 /* ??? Ignore the without-reg_equal-note problem for now. */
12474 if (reg_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i3))
12475 || ((tem = find_reg_note (i3, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
12476 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tem, 0)) == LABEL_REF
12477 && XEXP (XEXP (tem, 0), 0) == XEXP (note, 0)))
12478 place = i3;
12480 if (i2
12481 && (reg_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i2))
12482 || ((tem = find_reg_note (i2, REG_EQUAL, NULL_RTX))
12483 && GET_CODE (XEXP (tem, 0)) == LABEL_REF
12484 && XEXP (XEXP (tem, 0), 0) == XEXP (note, 0))))
12486 if (place)
12487 place2 = i2;
12488 else
12489 place = i2;
12492 /* For REG_LABEL_TARGET on a JUMP_P, we prefer to put the note
12493 as a JUMP_LABEL or decrement LABEL_NUSES if it's already
12494 there. */
12495 if (place && JUMP_P (place)
12496 && REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_LABEL_TARGET
12497 && (JUMP_LABEL (place) == NULL
12498 || JUMP_LABEL (place) == XEXP (note, 0)))
12500 rtx label = JUMP_LABEL (place);
12502 if (!label)
12503 JUMP_LABEL (place) = XEXP (note, 0);
12504 else if (LABEL_P (label))
12505 LABEL_NUSES (label)--;
12508 if (place2 && JUMP_P (place2)
12509 && REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_LABEL_TARGET
12510 && (JUMP_LABEL (place2) == NULL
12511 || JUMP_LABEL (place2) == XEXP (note, 0)))
12513 rtx label = JUMP_LABEL (place2);
12515 if (!label)
12516 JUMP_LABEL (place2) = XEXP (note, 0);
12517 else if (LABEL_P (label))
12518 LABEL_NUSES (label)--;
12519 place2 = 0;
12521 break;
12523 case REG_NONNEG:
12524 /* This note says something about the value of a register prior
12525 to the execution of an insn. It is too much trouble to see
12526 if the note is still correct in all situations. It is better
12527 to simply delete it. */
12528 break;
12530 case REG_RETVAL:
12531 /* If the insn previously containing this note still exists,
12532 put it back where it was. Otherwise move it to the previous
12533 insn. Adjust the corresponding REG_LIBCALL note. */
12534 if (!NOTE_P (from_insn))
12535 place = from_insn;
12536 else
12538 tem = find_reg_note (XEXP (note, 0), REG_LIBCALL, NULL_RTX);
12539 place = prev_real_insn (from_insn);
12540 if (tem && place)
12541 XEXP (tem, 0) = place;
12542 /* If we're deleting the last remaining instruction of a
12543 libcall sequence, don't add the notes. */
12544 else if (XEXP (note, 0) == from_insn)
12545 tem = place = 0;
12546 /* Don't add the dangling REG_RETVAL note. */
12547 else if (! tem)
12548 place = 0;
12550 break;
12552 case REG_LIBCALL:
12553 /* This is handled similarly to REG_RETVAL. */
12554 if (!NOTE_P (from_insn))
12555 place = from_insn;
12556 else
12558 tem = find_reg_note (XEXP (note, 0), REG_RETVAL, NULL_RTX);
12559 place = next_real_insn (from_insn);
12560 if (tem && place)
12561 XEXP (tem, 0) = place;
12562 /* If we're deleting the last remaining instruction of a
12563 libcall sequence, don't add the notes. */
12564 else if (XEXP (note, 0) == from_insn)
12565 tem = place = 0;
12566 /* Don't add the dangling REG_LIBCALL note. */
12567 else if (! tem)
12568 place = 0;
12570 break;
12572 case REG_DEAD:
12573 /* If we replaced the right hand side of FROM_INSN with a
12574 REG_EQUAL note, the original use of the dying register
12575 will not have been combined into I3 and I2. In such cases,
12576 FROM_INSN is guaranteed to be the first of the combined
12577 instructions, so we simply need to search back before
12578 FROM_INSN for the previous use or set of this register,
12579 then alter the notes there appropriately.
12581 If the register is used as an input in I3, it dies there.
12582 Similarly for I2, if it is nonzero and adjacent to I3.
12584 If the register is not used as an input in either I3 or I2
12585 and it is not one of the registers we were supposed to eliminate,
12586 there are two possibilities. We might have a non-adjacent I2
12587 or we might have somehow eliminated an additional register
12588 from a computation. For example, we might have had A & B where
12589 we discover that B will always be zero. In this case we will
12590 eliminate the reference to A.
12592 In both cases, we must search to see if we can find a previous
12593 use of A and put the death note there. */
12595 if (from_insn
12596 && from_insn == i2mod
12597 && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0), i2mod_new_rhs))
12598 tem = from_insn;
12599 else
12601 if (from_insn
12602 && CALL_P (from_insn)
12603 && find_reg_fusage (from_insn, USE, XEXP (note, 0)))
12604 place = from_insn;
12605 else if (reg_referenced_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i3)))
12606 place = i3;
12607 else if (i2 != 0 && next_nonnote_insn (i2) == i3
12608 && reg_referenced_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i2)))
12609 place = i2;
12610 else if ((rtx_equal_p (XEXP (note, 0), elim_i2)
12611 && !(i2mod
12612 && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (XEXP (note, 0),
12613 i2mod_old_rhs)))
12614 || rtx_equal_p (XEXP (note, 0), elim_i1))
12615 break;
12616 tem = i3;
12619 if (place == 0)
12621 basic_block bb = this_basic_block;
12623 for (tem = PREV_INSN (tem); place == 0; tem = PREV_INSN (tem))
12625 if (! INSN_P (tem))
12627 if (tem == BB_HEAD (bb))
12628 break;
12629 continue;
12632 /* If the register is being set at TEM, see if that is all
12633 TEM is doing. If so, delete TEM. Otherwise, make this
12634 into a REG_UNUSED note instead. Don't delete sets to
12635 global register vars. */
12636 if ((REGNO (XEXP (note, 0)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12637 || !global_regs[REGNO (XEXP (note, 0))])
12638 && reg_set_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (tem)))
12640 rtx set = single_set (tem);
12641 rtx inner_dest = 0;
12642 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
12643 rtx cc0_setter = NULL_RTX;
12644 #endif
12646 if (set != 0)
12647 for (inner_dest = SET_DEST (set);
12648 (GET_CODE (inner_dest) == STRICT_LOW_PART
12649 || GET_CODE (inner_dest) == SUBREG
12650 || GET_CODE (inner_dest) == ZERO_EXTRACT);
12651 inner_dest = XEXP (inner_dest, 0))
12654 /* Verify that it was the set, and not a clobber that
12655 modified the register.
12657 CC0 targets must be careful to maintain setter/user
12658 pairs. If we cannot delete the setter due to side
12659 effects, mark the user with an UNUSED note instead
12660 of deleting it. */
12662 if (set != 0 && ! side_effects_p (SET_SRC (set))
12663 && rtx_equal_p (XEXP (note, 0), inner_dest)
12664 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
12665 && (! reg_mentioned_p (cc0_rtx, SET_SRC (set))
12666 || ((cc0_setter = prev_cc0_setter (tem)) != NULL
12667 && sets_cc0_p (PATTERN (cc0_setter)) > 0))
12668 #endif
12671 /* Move the notes and links of TEM elsewhere.
12672 This might delete other dead insns recursively.
12673 First set the pattern to something that won't use
12674 any register. */
12675 rtx old_notes = REG_NOTES (tem);
12677 PATTERN (tem) = pc_rtx;
12678 REG_NOTES (tem) = NULL;
12680 distribute_notes (old_notes, tem, tem, NULL_RTX,
12681 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
12682 distribute_links (LOG_LINKS (tem));
12684 SET_INSN_DELETED (tem);
12686 #ifdef HAVE_cc0
12687 /* Delete the setter too. */
12688 if (cc0_setter)
12690 PATTERN (cc0_setter) = pc_rtx;
12691 old_notes = REG_NOTES (cc0_setter);
12692 REG_NOTES (cc0_setter) = NULL;
12694 distribute_notes (old_notes, cc0_setter,
12695 cc0_setter, NULL_RTX,
12696 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
12697 distribute_links (LOG_LINKS (cc0_setter));
12699 SET_INSN_DELETED (cc0_setter);
12701 #endif
12703 else
12705 PUT_REG_NOTE_KIND (note, REG_UNUSED);
12707 /* If there isn't already a REG_UNUSED note, put one
12708 here. Do not place a REG_DEAD note, even if
12709 the register is also used here; that would not
12710 match the algorithm used in lifetime analysis
12711 and can cause the consistency check in the
12712 scheduler to fail. */
12713 if (! find_regno_note (tem, REG_UNUSED,
12714 REGNO (XEXP (note, 0))))
12715 place = tem;
12716 break;
12719 else if (reg_referenced_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (tem))
12720 || (CALL_P (tem)
12721 && find_reg_fusage (tem, USE, XEXP (note, 0))))
12723 place = tem;
12725 /* If we are doing a 3->2 combination, and we have a
12726 register which formerly died in i3 and was not used
12727 by i2, which now no longer dies in i3 and is used in
12728 i2 but does not die in i2, and place is between i2
12729 and i3, then we may need to move a link from place to
12730 i2. */
12731 if (i2 && DF_INSN_LUID (place) > DF_INSN_LUID (i2)
12732 && from_insn
12733 && DF_INSN_LUID (from_insn) > DF_INSN_LUID (i2)
12734 && reg_referenced_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (i2)))
12736 rtx links = LOG_LINKS (place);
12737 LOG_LINKS (place) = 0;
12738 distribute_links (links);
12740 break;
12743 if (tem == BB_HEAD (bb))
12744 break;
12749 /* If the register is set or already dead at PLACE, we needn't do
12750 anything with this note if it is still a REG_DEAD note.
12751 We check here if it is set at all, not if is it totally replaced,
12752 which is what `dead_or_set_p' checks, so also check for it being
12753 set partially. */
12755 if (place && REG_NOTE_KIND (note) == REG_DEAD)
12757 unsigned int regno = REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
12758 reg_stat_type *rsp = VEC_index (reg_stat_type, reg_stat, regno);
12760 if (dead_or_set_p (place, XEXP (note, 0))
12761 || reg_bitfield_target_p (XEXP (note, 0), PATTERN (place)))
12763 /* Unless the register previously died in PLACE, clear
12764 last_death. [I no longer understand why this is
12765 being done.] */
12766 if (rsp->last_death != place)
12767 rsp->last_death = 0;
12768 place = 0;
12770 else
12771 rsp->last_death = place;
12773 /* If this is a death note for a hard reg that is occupying
12774 multiple registers, ensure that we are still using all
12775 parts of the object. If we find a piece of the object
12776 that is unused, we must arrange for an appropriate REG_DEAD
12777 note to be added for it. However, we can't just emit a USE
12778 and tag the note to it, since the register might actually
12779 be dead; so we recourse, and the recursive call then finds
12780 the previous insn that used this register. */
12782 if (place && regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12783 && hard_regno_nregs[regno][GET_MODE (XEXP (note, 0))] > 1)
12785 unsigned int endregno = END_HARD_REGNO (XEXP (note, 0));
12786 int all_used = 1;
12787 unsigned int i;
12789 for (i = regno; i < endregno; i++)
12790 if ((! refers_to_regno_p (i, i + 1, PATTERN (place), 0)
12791 && ! find_regno_fusage (place, USE, i))
12792 || dead_or_set_regno_p (place, i))
12793 all_used = 0;
12795 if (! all_used)
12797 /* Put only REG_DEAD notes for pieces that are
12798 not already dead or set. */
12800 for (i = regno; i < endregno;
12801 i += hard_regno_nregs[i][reg_raw_mode[i]])
12803 rtx piece = regno_reg_rtx[i];
12804 basic_block bb = this_basic_block;
12806 if (! dead_or_set_p (place, piece)
12807 && ! reg_bitfield_target_p (piece,
12808 PATTERN (place)))
12810 rtx new_note
12811 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_DEAD, piece, NULL_RTX);
12813 distribute_notes (new_note, place, place,
12814 NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
12816 else if (! refers_to_regno_p (i, i + 1,
12817 PATTERN (place), 0)
12818 && ! find_regno_fusage (place, USE, i))
12819 for (tem = PREV_INSN (place); ;
12820 tem = PREV_INSN (tem))
12822 if (! INSN_P (tem))
12824 if (tem == BB_HEAD (bb))
12825 break;
12826 continue;
12828 if (dead_or_set_p (tem, piece)
12829 || reg_bitfield_target_p (piece,
12830 PATTERN (tem)))
12832 REG_NOTES (tem)
12833 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (REG_UNUSED, piece,
12834 REG_NOTES (tem));
12835 break;
12841 place = 0;
12845 break;
12847 default:
12848 /* Any other notes should not be present at this point in the
12849 compilation. */
12850 gcc_unreachable ();
12853 if (place)
12855 XEXP (note, 1) = REG_NOTES (place);
12856 REG_NOTES (place) = note;
12859 if (place2)
12860 REG_NOTES (place2)
12861 = gen_rtx_fmt_ee (GET_CODE (note), REG_NOTE_KIND (note),
12862 XEXP (note, 0), REG_NOTES (place2));
12866 /* Similarly to above, distribute the LOG_LINKS that used to be present on
12867 I3, I2, and I1 to new locations. This is also called to add a link
12868 pointing at I3 when I3's destination is changed. */
12870 static void
12871 distribute_links (rtx links)
12873 rtx link, next_link;
12875 for (link = links; link; link = next_link)
12877 rtx place = 0;
12878 rtx insn;
12879 rtx set, reg;
12881 next_link = XEXP (link, 1);
12883 /* If the insn that this link points to is a NOTE or isn't a single
12884 set, ignore it. In the latter case, it isn't clear what we
12885 can do other than ignore the link, since we can't tell which
12886 register it was for. Such links wouldn't be used by combine
12887 anyway.
12889 It is not possible for the destination of the target of the link to
12890 have been changed by combine. The only potential of this is if we
12891 replace I3, I2, and I1 by I3 and I2. But in that case the
12892 destination of I2 also remains unchanged. */
12894 if (NOTE_P (XEXP (link, 0))
12895 || (set = single_set (XEXP (link, 0))) == 0)
12896 continue;
12898 reg = SET_DEST (set);
12899 while (GET_CODE (reg) == SUBREG || GET_CODE (reg) == ZERO_EXTRACT
12900 || GET_CODE (reg) == STRICT_LOW_PART)
12901 reg = XEXP (reg, 0);
12903 /* A LOG_LINK is defined as being placed on the first insn that uses
12904 a register and points to the insn that sets the register. Start
12905 searching at the next insn after the target of the link and stop
12906 when we reach a set of the register or the end of the basic block.
12908 Note that this correctly handles the link that used to point from
12909 I3 to I2. Also note that not much searching is typically done here
12910 since most links don't point very far away. */
12912 for (insn = NEXT_INSN (XEXP (link, 0));
12913 (insn && (this_basic_block->next_bb == EXIT_BLOCK_PTR
12914 || BB_HEAD (this_basic_block->next_bb) != insn));
12915 insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
12916 if (INSN_P (insn) && reg_overlap_mentioned_p (reg, PATTERN (insn)))
12918 if (reg_referenced_p (reg, PATTERN (insn)))
12919 place = insn;
12920 break;
12922 else if (CALL_P (insn)
12923 && find_reg_fusage (insn, USE, reg))
12925 place = insn;
12926 break;
12928 else if (INSN_P (insn) && reg_set_p (reg, insn))
12929 break;
12931 /* If we found a place to put the link, place it there unless there
12932 is already a link to the same insn as LINK at that point. */
12934 if (place)
12936 rtx link2;
12938 for (link2 = LOG_LINKS (place); link2; link2 = XEXP (link2, 1))
12939 if (XEXP (link2, 0) == XEXP (link, 0))
12940 break;
12942 if (link2 == 0)
12944 XEXP (link, 1) = LOG_LINKS (place);
12945 LOG_LINKS (place) = link;
12947 /* Set added_links_insn to the earliest insn we added a
12948 link to. */
12949 if (added_links_insn == 0
12950 || DF_INSN_LUID (added_links_insn) > DF_INSN_LUID (place))
12951 added_links_insn = place;
12957 /* Subroutine of unmentioned_reg_p and callback from for_each_rtx.
12958 Check whether the expression pointer to by LOC is a register or
12959 memory, and if so return 1 if it isn't mentioned in the rtx EXPR.
12960 Otherwise return zero. */
12962 static int
12963 unmentioned_reg_p_1 (rtx *loc, void *expr)
12965 rtx x = *loc;
12967 if (x != NULL_RTX
12968 && (REG_P (x) || MEM_P (x))
12969 && ! reg_mentioned_p (x, (rtx) expr))
12970 return 1;
12971 return 0;
12974 /* Check for any register or memory mentioned in EQUIV that is not
12975 mentioned in EXPR. This is used to restrict EQUIV to "specializations"
12976 of EXPR where some registers may have been replaced by constants. */
12978 static bool
12979 unmentioned_reg_p (rtx equiv, rtx expr)
12981 return for_each_rtx (&equiv, unmentioned_reg_p_1, expr);
12984 void
12985 dump_combine_stats (FILE *file)
12987 fprintf
12988 (file,
12989 ";; Combiner statistics: %d attempts, %d substitutions (%d requiring new space),\n;; %d successes.\n\n",
12990 combine_attempts, combine_merges, combine_extras, combine_successes);
12993 void
12994 dump_combine_total_stats (FILE *file)
12996 fprintf
12997 (file,
12998 "\n;; Combiner totals: %d attempts, %d substitutions (%d requiring new space),\n;; %d successes.\n",
12999 total_attempts, total_merges, total_extras, total_successes);
13002 static bool
13003 gate_handle_combine (void)
13005 return (optimize > 0);
13008 /* Try combining insns through substitution. */
13009 static unsigned int
13010 rest_of_handle_combine (void)
13012 int rebuild_jump_labels_after_combine;
13014 df_set_flags (DF_LR_RUN_DCE + DF_DEFER_INSN_RESCAN);
13015 df_note_add_problem ();
13016 df_analyze ();
13018 regstat_init_n_sets_and_refs ();
13020 rebuild_jump_labels_after_combine
13021 = combine_instructions (get_insns (), max_reg_num ());
13023 /* Combining insns may have turned an indirect jump into a
13024 direct jump. Rebuild the JUMP_LABEL fields of jumping
13025 instructions. */
13026 if (rebuild_jump_labels_after_combine)
13028 timevar_push (TV_JUMP);
13029 rebuild_jump_labels (get_insns ());
13030 cleanup_cfg (0);
13031 timevar_pop (TV_JUMP);
13034 regstat_free_n_sets_and_refs ();
13035 return 0;
13038 struct tree_opt_pass pass_combine =
13040 "combine", /* name */
13041 gate_handle_combine, /* gate */
13042 rest_of_handle_combine, /* execute */
13043 NULL, /* sub */
13044 NULL, /* next */
13045 0, /* static_pass_number */
13046 TV_COMBINE, /* tv_id */
13047 0, /* properties_required */
13048 0, /* properties_provided */
13049 0, /* properties_destroyed */
13050 0, /* todo_flags_start */
13051 TODO_dump_func |
13052 TODO_df_finish | TODO_verify_rtl_sharing |
13053 TODO_ggc_collect, /* todo_flags_finish */
13054 'c' /* letter */